Sei sulla pagina 1di 601

Cambium PTP 810 Series User Guide

System Release 810-01-00

Accuracy
While reasonable efforts have been made to assure the accuracy of this document, Cambium Networks assumes no liability resulting from any inaccuracies or omissions in this document, or from use of the information obtained herein. Cambium reserves the right to make changes to any products described herein to improve reliability, function, or design, and reserves the right to revise this document and to make changes from time to time in content hereof with no obligation to notify any person of revisions or changes. Cambium does not assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product, software, or circuit described herein; neither does it convey license under its patent rights or the rights of others. It is possible that this publication may contain references to, or information about Cambium products (machines and programs), programming, or services that are not announced in your country. Such references or information must not be construed to mean that Cambium intends to announce such Cambium products, programming, or services in your country.

Copyrights
This document, Cambium products, and 3rd Party software products described in this document may include or describe copyrighted Cambium and other 3rd Party supplied computer programs stored in semiconductor memories or other media. Laws in the United States and other countries preserve for Cambium, its licensors, and other 3rd Party supplied software certain exclusive rights for copyrighted material, including the exclusive right to copy, reproduce in any form, distribute and make derivative works of the copyrighted material. Accordingly, any copyrighted material of Cambium, its licensors, or the 3rd Party software supplied material contained in the Cambium products described in this document may not be copied, reproduced, reverse engineered, distributed, merged or modified in any manner without the express written permission of Cambium. Furthermore, the purchase of Cambium products shall not be deemed to grant either directly or by implication, estoppel, or otherwise, any license under the copyrights, patents or patent applications of Cambium or other 3rd Party supplied software, except for the normal non-exclusive, royalty free license to use that arises by operation of law in the sale of a product.

Restrictions
Software and documentation are copyrighted materials. Making unauthorized copies is prohibited by law. No part of the software or documentation may be reproduced, transmitted, transcribed, stored in a retrieval system, or translated into any language or computer language, in any form or by any means, without prior written permission of Cambium.

License Agreements
The software described in this document is the property of Cambium and its licensors. It is furnished by express license agreement only and may be used only in accordance with the terms of such an agreement.

High Risk Materials


Components, units, or 3rd Party products used in the product described herein are NOT faulttolerant and are NOT designed, manufactured, or intended for use as on-line control equipment in the following hazardous environments requiring fail-safe controls: the operation of Nuclear Facilities, Aircraft Navigation or Aircraft Communication Systems, Air Traffic Control, Life Support, or Weapons Systems (High Risk Activities). Cambium and its supplier(s) specifically disclaim any expressed or implied warranty of fitness for such High Risk Activities. 2012 Cambium Networks Limited. All Rights Reserved.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Important safety information


This section describes important safety guidelines that must be observed by personnel installing or operating PTP 810 equipment.

To prevent loss of life or physical injury, observe the safety guidelines in this section.

Power lines
Exercise extreme care when working near power lines.

Working at heights
Exercise extreme care when working at heights.

Grounding and protective earth


The outdoor unit (ODU) and modular modem unit (MMU) for the PTP 810 must be properly grounded. It is the users responsibility to install the equipment in accordance with national regulations. In the USA, follow Section 810 of the National Electric Code, ANSI/NFPA No.70-1984 (USA). In Canada, follow Section 54 of the Canadian Electrical Code. These codes describe correct installation procedures for grounding the ODU, MMU, mast, lead-in wire and discharge unit, size of grounding conductors and connection requirements for grounding electrodes. Other regulations may apply in different countries and therefore it is recommended that installation of the outdoor unit be contracted to a professional installer. The ODU and MMU must be grounded to a protective earth in accordance with the Local Electrical Regulations.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Important safety information

Electrical safety
The power cable connections must meet International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) safety standards. Always power down and unplug the equipment before servicing. When using alternative DC supplies, such as battery-backed DC power source, the supply must be SELV rated.

Primary disconnect device


The power supply must include a primary disconnect device with appropriate fusing.

External cables
Safety may be compromised if outdoor rated cables are not used for connections that will be exposed to the weather.

RF exposure near the antenna


Strong radio frequency (RF) fields will be present close to the antenna when the transmitter is on. Always mute the transmitter before undertaking maintenance activities in front of the antenna. Ensure that people cannot stand or walk in front of the antenna within 10 degrees of the antenna axis and within the minimum distances listed in Table 220 (ETSI) or Table 221 (FCC). The minimum distances in these tables have been calculated using worst-case assumptions. Reduced separation distances may be appropriate under some circumstances. Further details are provided in Radiation hazard assessment on page 4-83.

II

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Contents
Important safety information ........................................................................................... I About This User Guide ..................................................................................................... 1 General information ..................................................................................................................... 2 Version information................................................................................................................ 2 Contacting Cambium Networks ............................................................................................. 2 Problems and warranty ................................................................................................................ 4 Security advice ............................................................................................................................. 6 Warnings, cautions, and notes ..................................................................................................... 7 Caring for the environment.......................................................................................................... 8 Licensing requirements ............................................................................................................... 9 Operating license ................................................................................................................... 9 Cambium license agreement .................................................................................................. 9 Chapter 1: Product description .................................................................................. 1-1 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 1-2 Key features ........................................................................................................................ 1-2 Supported bands and frequencies ...................................................................................... 1-3 Typical users and applications ............................................................................................ 1-4 System components ............................................................................................................ 1-4 Link types ............................................................................................................................ 1-5 Dual 1+0 links ..................................................................................................................... 1-6 Wireless link aggregation ................................................................................................... 1-7 Modular modem unit (MMU) .................................................................................................... 1-8 MMU description ................................................................................................................ 1-8 Required modules ............................................................................................................... 1-8 Power Supply Module ......................................................................................................... 1-8 Control Module ................................................................................................................. 1-10 Modem Module ................................................................................................................. 1-11 Standard Master I/O module ............................................................................................. 1-12 GigE Master I/O module.................................................................................................... 1-13 Additional modules............................................................................................................ 1-14 Additional Power Supply Module ...................................................................................... 1-15
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Contents

Additional Modem Module ................................................................................................ 1-15 Expansion I/O: 16 E1/T1 ................................................................................................ 1-16 Further reading on the MMU ........................................................................................... 1-17 Outdoor unit (ODU)................................................................................................................. 1-18 ODU description................................................................................................................ 1-18 ODU interfaces.................................................................................................................. 1-19 Further reading on the ODU ............................................................................................. 1-23 Antennas and couplers ............................................................................................................ 1-24 Antennas ........................................................................................................................... 1-24 Remote mounting kits (RMKs) .......................................................................................... 1-26 Coupler mounting kits....................................................................................................... 1-27 Direct mount dual-polar antennas .................................................................................... 1-29 Further reading on antennas and couplers....................................................................... 1-30 Cabling and lightning protection ............................................................................................ 1-31 Lightning protection ......................................................................................................... 1-31 ODU to MMU connections ................................................................................................ 1-31 MMU to network connections ........................................................................................... 1-31 Cable grounding................................................................................................................ 1-31 Further reading on cabling and lightning protection ....................................................... 1-33 Wireless operation .................................................................................................................. 1-34 Channel separation ........................................................................................................... 1-34 Channel bandwidth ........................................................................................................... 1-34 Modulation modes ............................................................................................................. 1-35 Adaptive power control ..................................................................................................... 1-35 Maximum receive power ................................................................................................... 1-36 Maximum transmit power ................................................................................................. 1-36 XPIC .................................................................................................................................. 1-36 Further reading on wireless operation ............................................................................. 1-37 Ethernet bridging in the customer network ........................................................................... 1-38 Transparent Ethernet service ........................................................................................... 1-38 Internal Ethernet switch ................................................................................................... 1-39 Spanning tree operation ................................................................................................... 1-40 Pause frame operation ...................................................................................................... 1-41 Ethernet link aggregation ................................................................................................. 1-41 Transparent wireless link aggregation (GigE Master I/O module) ................................... 1-42 VLAN bridging of Ethernet Traffic.................................................................................... 1-42 Quality of service for bridged Ethernet traffic ................................................................. 1-45
ii

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless link down alert.................................................................................................... 1-45 Further reading on Ethernet bridging .............................................................................. 1-46 Ethernet bridging in the management network...................................................................... 1-47 Embedded management agent.......................................................................................... 1-47 Serial interface .................................................................................................................. 1-47 Ethernet interface ............................................................................................................. 1-47 Network management ....................................................................................................... 1-48 Spanning tree operation ................................................................................................... 1-49 Network management quality of service .......................................................................... 1-49 System management ............................................................................................................... 1-50 Protocol interfaces ............................................................................................................ 1-50 Web server ........................................................................................................................ 1-50 Command line interface .................................................................................................... 1-50 Identity-based user accounts ............................................................................................ 1-51 Link configuration wizard ................................................................................................. 1-52 Alarms ............................................................................................................................... 1-52 SNMP ................................................................................................................................ 1-53 Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP)............................................................................. 1-54 System logging (syslog) .................................................................................................... 1-54 Flexible capacity upgrades ............................................................................................... 1-54 Application software storage and upgrade ....................................................................... 1-55 Restore system defaults .................................................................................................... 1-56 Further reading on system management .......................................................................... 1-56 TDM bridging .......................................................................................................................... 1-57 E1/T1 capacity................................................................................................................... 1-57 E1/T1 clocking................................................................................................................... 1-58 Identification and mapping of E1/T1 circuits and ports ................................................... 1-59 E1/T1 switching in 1+0 and 1+1 link types ...................................................................... 1-59 Dual 1+0 links ................................................................................................................... 1-60 E1/T1 switching in 2+0 co-polar, 2+0 cross-polar and 2+0 XPIC link types ................... 1-61 Loopback ........................................................................................................................... 1-62 Further reading on TDM bridging .................................................................................... 1-62 Chapter 2: Planning considerations ........................................................................... 2-1 Link planning ............................................................................................................................ 2-2 Process ................................................................................................................................ 2-2 Site selection ....................................................................................................................... 2-3 Wind loading ....................................................................................................................... 2-3
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
iii

Contents

Maximum IF cable length ................................................................................................... 2-3 PTP LINKPlanner ................................................................................................................ 2-4 Grounding and lightning protection ......................................................................................... 2-7 The need for power surge protection ................................................................................. 2-7 Standards ............................................................................................................................ 2-7 Lightning Protection Zones ................................................................................................. 2-8 General protection requirements........................................................................................ 2-9 Protection requirements for a mast or tower installation................................................. 2-10 Protection requirements for the ODU on a high rise building .......................................... 2-12 Data network planning............................................................................................................ 2-16 IP interface........................................................................................................................ 2-16 Quality of service for bridged Ethernet traffic ................................................................. 2-16 Fast Ethernet port shutdown ............................................................................................ 2-18 TDM network planning ........................................................................................................... 2-19 E1/T1 termination points and pass-through ..................................................................... 2-19 Protection requirements ................................................................................................... 2-19 2+0 link failover preference ............................................................................................. 2-20 TDM and Ethernet traffic capacity tradeoffs .................................................................... 2-20 Planning 1+0 links .................................................................................................................. 2-22 Concept of a 1+0 link........................................................................................................ 2-22 Antenna, ODU and MMU configurations for 1+0 ............................................................. 2-22 Planning 1+1 links .................................................................................................................. 2-25 Concept of a 1+1 Hot Standby link .................................................................................. 2-25 Concept of a 1+1 Hot Standby Spatial Diversity link ....................................................... 2-25 Antenna, ODU and MMU configurations for 1+1 links .................................................... 2-26 Designating primary and secondary units ........................................................................ 2-30 Link planning for 1+1 Hot Standby links ......................................................................... 2-30 Link planning for Spatial Diversity ................................................................................... 2-30 Planning 2+0 links .................................................................................................................. 2-31 Concept of a 2+0 link........................................................................................................ 2-31 Antenna, ODU and MMU configurations for 2+0 ............................................................. 2-31 Frequency spacing ............................................................................................................ 2-36 Planning Dual 1+0 links.......................................................................................................... 2-37 BOM for ring and ribbon topologies ................................................................................. 2-37 1+0 Ribbon topology......................................................................................................... 2-37 1+0 Ring topology ............................................................................................................ 2-38 Ordering components ............................................................................................................. 2-39
iv

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering MMUs ................................................................................................................ 2-39 Ordering capacity upgrades and XPIC capability ............................................................. 2-40 Ordering antennas ............................................................................................................ 2-44 Ordering ODUs ................................................................................................................. 2-54 Ordering IF cable, grounding and LPUs ........................................................................... 2-65 Ordering RMKs and waveguides ....................................................................................... 2-70 Ordering coupler mounting kits ........................................................................................ 2-73 Ordering OMKs ................................................................................................................. 2-75 Ordering network connection components ....................................................................... 2-75 Chapter 3: Legal information ..................................................................................... 3-1 Cambium Networks end user license agreement ..................................................................... 3-2 Acceptance of this agreement ............................................................................................. 3-2 Definitions ........................................................................................................................... 3-2 Grant of license ................................................................................................................... 3-2 Conditions of use ................................................................................................................. 3-3 Title and restrictions ........................................................................................................... 3-4 Confidentiality ..................................................................................................................... 3-4 Right to use Cambiums name ............................................................................................ 3-5 Transfer ............................................................................................................................... 3-5 Updates ............................................................................................................................... 3-5 Maintenance........................................................................................................................ 3-5 Disclaimer ........................................................................................................................... 3-6 Limitation of liability ........................................................................................................... 3-6 U.S. government ................................................................................................................. 3-7 Term of license .................................................................................................................... 3-7 Governing law ..................................................................................................................... 3-7 Assignment .......................................................................................................................... 3-8 Survival of provisions .......................................................................................................... 3-8 Entire agreement ................................................................................................................ 3-8 Third party software ........................................................................................................... 3-8 Limit of liability ......................................................................................................................... 3-9 Chapter 4: Reference information .............................................................................. 4-1 Equipment specifications .......................................................................................................... 4-2 MMU specifications ............................................................................................................ 4-2 ODU specifications .............................................................................................................. 4-5 Flexible waveguide specifications ....................................................................................... 4-9 Coupler mounting kit specifications ................................................................................. 4-14
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
v

Contents

MMU front panel connectors ............................................................................................ 4-16 Wireless specifications ............................................................................................................ 4-23 General wireless specifications......................................................................................... 4-23 Frequency bands and channel separation ........................................................................ 4-24 Capacity license keys and frequency bands...................................................................... 4-25 Maximum E1/T1 circuit capacity ...................................................................................... 4-27 Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity .......................................................................... 4-29 Data network specifications .................................................................................................... 4-73 Fast Ethernet specifications ............................................................................................. 4-73 Gigabit Ethernet specifications ......................................................................................... 4-75 Network management specifications ...................................................................................... 4-77 Standard SNMP MIBs ....................................................................................................... 4-77 Electromagnetic compliance ................................................................................................... 4-79 Compliance testing ........................................................................................................... 4-79 Electrical safety compliance ............................................................................................. 4-79 European Union compliance ............................................................................................. 4-80 Canada compliance ........................................................................................................... 4-80 United States compliance ................................................................................................. 4-81 Notifications ...................................................................................................................... 4-82 Radiation hazard assessment .................................................................................................. 4-83 ETSI method ..................................................................................................................... 4-83 FCC method ...................................................................................................................... 4-85 Chapter 5: Installation .............................................................................................. 5-1 Preparing for installation .......................................................................................................... 5-2 Safety precautions during installation ................................................................................ 5-2 Grounding and lightning protection requirements ............................................................. 5-2 Selecting installation options .............................................................................................. 5-2 Preparing personnel............................................................................................................ 5-3 Preparing inventory ............................................................................................................ 5-3 Preparing tools .................................................................................................................... 5-3 Installing antennas and ODUs .................................................................................................. 5-5 Installing a direct mount antenna with one ODU ............................................................... 5-6 Installing a remote mount antenna with one ODU ........................................................... 5-10 Installing a direct mount antenna with two ODUs (via coupler) ...................................... 5-21 Installing a remote mount antenna with two ODUs (via coupler) .................................... 5-28 Installing a direct mount dual-polar antenna with two ODUs .......................................... 5-34 Installing the IF and ground cables ........................................................................................ 5-38
vi

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Preparing IF cables ........................................................................................................... 5-40 Fitting an N type or straight TNC connector .................................................................... 5-40 Fitting a right angle TNC connector ................................................................................. 5-44 Connecting the ODU to the top LPU ................................................................................. 5-44 Weatherproofing an N type connector .............................................................................. 5-47 Hoisting the main IF cable ................................................................................................ 5-52 Installing and grounding the main IF cable ...................................................................... 5-55 Making an IF cable ground point ...................................................................................... 5-57 Installing and grounding the IF cable at building entry ................................................... 5-61 Testing the ODU and IF cable ................................................................................................. 5-63 Recommended pre-power tests ......................................................................................... 5-63 Test equipment ................................................................................................................. 5-63 Test preparation ................................................................................................................ 5-64 Testing cable loss .............................................................................................................. 5-65 Measuring distance to fault .............................................................................................. 5-68 Installing the MMU ................................................................................................................. 5-71 Mounting the MMU ........................................................................................................... 5-71 Grounding the MMU ......................................................................................................... 5-72 Connecting the MMU to the IF cable................................................................................ 5-73 Connecting the MMU power supply ................................................................................. 5-73 Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links) ............................................................. 5-77 Installing an Ethernet data interface ................................................................................ 5-78 Installing a fiber data interface......................................................................................... 5-79 Installing a management interface ................................................................................... 5-82 Installing an E1/T1 interface ............................................................................................. 5-83 Installing an XPIC interface .............................................................................................. 5-85 Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment .................................................................... 6-1 Preparing for configuration and alignment .............................................................................. 6-2 Safety precautions during configuration and alignment .................................................... 6-2 Regulatory compliance during configuration and alignment .............................................. 6-2 Selecting configuration options .......................................................................................... 6-2 Purchasing license key ........................................................................................................ 6-2 Task 1: Connecting to the unit .................................................................................................. 6-3 Configuring the management PC ........................................................................................ 6-3 Updating the ARP table....................................................................................................... 6-6 Connecting to the PC and powering up .............................................................................. 6-7 Logging into the web interface ........................................................................................... 6-7
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
vii

Contents

Logging into the CLI interface ............................................................................................ 6-9 Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces ..................................................................... 6-14 Configuring the IP interface ............................................................................................. 6-14 Reconnecting to the management PC ............................................................................... 6-15 Configuring Serial Port ..................................................................................................... 6-15 Configuring Ethernet payload ........................................................................................... 6-16 Configuring Ethernet network management .................................................................... 6-21 Task 3: Configuring wireless interface ................................................................................... 6-24 Viewing the configuration summary ................................................................................. 6-24 Updating link configuration .............................................................................................. 6-25 Configuring the ODU ........................................................................................................ 6-33 Configuring APC and coupler loss compensation ............................................................. 6-34 Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces ..................................................................................... 6-38 Configuring channel mapping ........................................................................................... 6-38 Configuring E1/T1 ports ................................................................................................... 6-42 Configuring E1/T1 protection switching ........................................................................... 6-45 Task 5: Configuring data orderwire ........................................................................................ 6-48 Configuring orderwire ...................................................................................................... 6-48 Task 6: Configuring protection ............................................................................................... 6-50 Configuring protection ...................................................................................................... 6-50 Task 7: Setting up SNMP agent .............................................................................................. 6-54 Configuring SNMP agent .................................................................................................. 6-54 Task 8: Configuring alarms and messages ............................................................................. 6-57 Configuring generation of diagnostics alarms .................................................................. 6-57 Configuring alarm thresholds ........................................................................................... 6-59 Task 9: Configuring syslog ...................................................................................................... 6-62 Configuring system logging (syslog) ................................................................................. 6-62 Task 10: Configuring quality of service .................................................................................. 6-63 Setting QoS priority method ............................................................................................. 6-63 Setting QoS port priorities ................................................................................................ 6-66 Setting QoS VLAN p-bit tag priorities .............................................................................. 6-68 Setting QoS DiffServ DSCP priorities ............................................................................... 6-69 Setting QoS switch priorities ............................................................................................ 6-71 Task 11: Configuring VLAN .................................................................................................... 6-73 Configuring global VLAN options ..................................................................................... 6-73 Configuring static VLANs ................................................................................................. 6-75 Configuring port based VLANs ......................................................................................... 6-77
viii

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Example VLAN configurations .......................................................................................... 6-78 Configuring MSTPs ........................................................................................................... 6-88 Mapping VLANs to MSTP instances ................................................................................. 6-91 Task 12: LACP configuration .................................................................................................. 6-92 Configuring LACP ............................................................................................................. 6-92 Task 13: Connecting link to the network ................................................................................ 6-94 Connecting to the network................................................................................................ 6-94 Setting the real-time clock ................................................................................................ 6-95 Task 14: Aligning antennas ..................................................................................................... 6-98 Introduction to antenna alignment ................................................................................... 6-98 Prerequisites for alignment .............................................................................................. 6-99 Aligning protected antennas ............................................................................................. 6-99 Aligning dual-polar antennas ............................................................................................ 6-99 Aligning a pair of antennas ............................................................................................. 6-100 Starting antenna alignment ............................................................................................ 6-100 Aligning antennas ........................................................................................................... 6-100 Completing alignment ..................................................................................................... 6-103 Task 15: Reviewing configuration and performance ............................................................ 6-104 Reviewing system configuration attributes..................................................................... 6-104 Monitoring link performance .......................................................................................... 6-105 Chapter 7: Operation ................................................................................................. 7-1 Web-based management ........................................................................................................... 7-2 Accessing the web interface ............................................................................................... 7-2 Layout of the web interface ................................................................................................ 7-3 Viewing the system status................................................................................................... 7-4 Using the menu options ...................................................................................................... 7-9 Logging out ....................................................................................................................... 7-14 Managing alarms and events .................................................................................................. 7-15 Managing alarms .............................................................................................................. 7-15 Managing SNMP traps ...................................................................................................... 7-20 Managing event notification messages ............................................................................. 7-20 Disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU .............................................................. 7-21 Disabling the ODU ............................................................................................................ 7-21 Enabling the ODU ............................................................................................................. 7-22 Muting the ODU ................................................................................................................ 7-22 Unmuting the ODU ........................................................................................................... 7-22 Managing 1+1 Hot Standby links ........................................................................................... 7-23
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
ix

Contents

Forcing protection switches.............................................................................................. 7-23 Enabling revertive and non-revertive switching ............................................................... 7-23 Enabling and disabling fault protection ............................................................................ 7-24 Selecting preferred transmitting ODU ............................................................................. 7-24 Managing 2+0 Co-Polar, Cross-Polar & XPIC links ................................................................ 7-25 GigE Master I/O operation ................................................................................................ 7-25 Standard Master I/O operation ......................................................................................... 7-26 Link outage considerations ............................................................................................... 7-26 Managing user accounts and security .................................................................................... 7-27 Creating user accounts ..................................................................................................... 7-27 Deleting user accounts ..................................................................................................... 7-28 Changing a password ........................................................................................................ 7-29 Viewing event log of MMU access .................................................................................... 7-29 Configuring HTTP (SSL) ................................................................................................... 7-30 Managing performance ........................................................................................................... 7-31 Viewing wireless link performance ................................................................................... 7-31 Viewing Ethernet switch statistics .................................................................................... 7-42 Maintaining the system ..................................................................................................... 7-50 Saving, restoring and rebooting ............................................................................................. 7-51 Saving the system configuration ....................................................................................... 7-51 Restoring the system configuration .................................................................................. 7-52 Rebooting .......................................................................................................................... 7-53 Checking the recovery version ......................................................................................... 7-53 Restoring system defaults ....................................................................................................... 7-54 Power on reset to system defaults .................................................................................... 7-54 Restore system defaults page ........................................................................................... 7-54 System default parameter values ..................................................................................... 7-55 Viewing device information .................................................................................................... 7-57 General device information ............................................................................................... 7-57 Serial number information ................................................................................................ 7-58 Device name and owner information ................................................................................ 7-58 Upgrading the system ............................................................................................................. 7-60 Entering an authorization key........................................................................................... 7-60 Installing new software versions ...................................................................................... 7-63 Removing and installing modules ........................................................................................... 7-67 Preparing to remove and install a module ........................................................................ 7-67 Removing a module ........................................................................................................... 7-68
x

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing a module ............................................................................................................ 7-69 Installing dual modem upgrade kit ................................................................................... 7-69 Software images stored on MMU modules ....................................................................... 7-70 Chapter 8: Troubleshooting ....................................................................................... 8-1 Trouble connecting to the web management interface ............................................................ 8-2 Check the MMU power supply status LED ......................................................................... 8-2 Check the DC supply to the MMU ...................................................................................... 8-2 Check the MMU status indicators....................................................................................... 8-3 Check the NMS port Ethernet connection .......................................................................... 8-3 Check IP network connection ............................................................................................. 8-4 Check browser settings ....................................................................................................... 8-5 Using a serial port connection to set the IP address .......................................................... 8-5 Unable to access MMU using HTTPS ................................................................................. 8-6 Unable to access MMU using Telnet .................................................................................. 8-7 Unable to access MMU using SSH ..................................................................................... 8-7 Unable to access MMU using serial port ............................................................................ 8-7 Trouble establishing a wireless link .......................................................................................... 8-8 Connect to the web management interface ........................................................................ 8-8 Check for proper link configuration and connectivity ........................................................ 8-8 Transmitter status ............................................................................................................. 8-10 Antenna alignment ............................................................................................................ 8-10 Check transmit and receive frequencies ........................................................................... 8-11 Check waveguide and antennas ........................................................................................ 8-11 Check link status ............................................................................................................... 8-11 Trouble bridging Ethernet data traffic ................................................................................... 8-12 Trouble bridging E1/T1 traffic ................................................................................................ 8-15 Check for proper configuration and connectivity ............................................................. 8-15 Performing a loopback test ............................................................................................... 8-15 BERT mode........................................................................................................................ 8-18 Trouble managing remote unit ............................................................................................... 8-20 Glossary ........................................................................................................................... I Alarms ............................................................................................................................. V

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

xi

PTP 810 Series User Guide

List of Figures
Figure 1 Typical PTP 810 deployment .......................................................................................... 1-4 Figure 2 Example of a 1+0 ring configuration .............................................................................. 1-7 Figure 3 MMU module locations ................................................................................................... 1-8 Figure 4 MMU module Power Supply Module front panel ........................................................... 1-9 Figure 5 MMU Control Module front panel ................................................................................ 1-10 Figure 6 MMU Modem Module front panel ................................................................................ 1-11 Figure 7 MMU Standard Master I/O Module front panel ........................................................... 1-13 Figure 8 MMU GigE Master I/O Module front panel .................................................................. 1-14 Figure 9 MMU additional module locations ................................................................................ 1-15 Figure 10 MMU XPIC cable linking two Modem Modules ......................................................... 1-16 Figure 11 MMU expansion I/O: 16 E1/T1 front panel ............................................................. 1-16 Figure 12 ODU-A front view ........................................................................................................ 1-20 Figure 13 ODU-B front view ........................................................................................................ 1-20 Figure 14 ODU rear view ............................................................................................................ 1-21 Figure 15 ODU-A side view ......................................................................................................... 1-21 Figure 16 ODU-B side view ......................................................................................................... 1-22 Figure 17 Typical PTP 810 antenna with ODU (Cambium direct mount interface) .................... 1-24 Figure 18 Direct mount mechanical interface ............................................................................ 1-25 Figure 19 ODU clipped onto direct mount mechanical interface ............................................... 1-25 Figure 20 Remote mount antenna waveguide interface ............................................................. 1-25 Figure 21 RMK showing the ODU interface................................................................................ 1-26 Figure 22 RMK showing the waveguide interface ...................................................................... 1-27 Figure 23 ODU coupler mounting kit .......................................................................................... 1-28 Figure 24 Two ODUs and antenna mounted on a coupler .......................................................... 1-28 Figure 25 Orthogonal mode transducer ...................................................................................... 1-29 Figure 26 Cable grounding kit (Cambium part number 01010419001) ..................................... 1-32 Figure 27 LPU end kit (Cambium part number WB3657) ........................................................... 1-32 Figure 28 Internal Ethernet switch for the Standard Master I/O module .................................. 1-39 Figure 29 Internal Ethernet switch for the GigE Master I/O module ......................................... 1-40 Figure 30 Internal Ethernet switch for the management network ............................................. 1-48 Figure 31 Switching of E1/T1 circuits in 1+0 and 1+1 links ...................................................... 1-59

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

xii

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Figure 32 Supported loopback tests ........................................................................................... 1-62 Figure 33 LINKPlanner profile view ............................................................................................. 2-5 Figure 34 LINKPlanner configuration and performance details ................................................... 2-6 Figure 35 LINKPlanner Bill of Materials view .............................................................................. 2-6 Figure 36 Rolling sphere method to determine the lightning protection zones ........................... 2-8 Figure 37 Grounding and lightning protection on mast or tower ............................................... 2-11 Figure 38 Grounding and lightning protection on mast or tower (protected end) ..................... 2-12 Figure 39 Grounding and lightning protection on building ........................................................ 2-13 Figure 40 Grounding and lightning protection inside high building ........................................... 2-14 Figure 41 Grounding and lightning protection inside high building (protected end) ................. 2-15 Figure 42 PTP 810 MMU Ethernet QoS Priority Queue.............................................................. 2-17 Figure 43 Schematic view of 1+0 ODU direct mount link end ................................................... 2-23 Figure 44 Schematic view of 1+0 ODU remote mount link end ................................................. 2-24 Figure 45 ODUs coupled to single direct mount antenna (schematic) ....................................... 2-26 Figure 46 ODUs coupled to single remote mount antenna (schematic) ..................................... 2-27 Figure 47 ODUs with separate direct mount antennas (schematic) ........................................... 2-28 Figure 48 ODUs with separate remote mount antennas (schematic) ......................................... 2-29 Figure 49 ODUs coupled to single direct mount antenna - co-polar links (schematic) ............... 2-32 Figure 50 ODUs coupled to a single remote mount antenna - co-polar links (schematic) .......... 2-33 Figure 51 ODUs coupled to a single direct mount antenna - cross-polar links (schematic) ....... 2-34 Figure 52 ODUs connected to a dual polar remote mount antenna - cross-polar links (schematic) ................................................................................................................................................ 2-35 Figure 53 Location of chassis serial number on MMU enclosure ............................................... 2-42 Figure 54 Locations of waveguide flanges .................................................................................... 4-9 Figure 55 Waveguide flanges 6 GHz ........................................................................................ 4-11 Figure 56 Waveguide flanges 7 to 15 GHz ............................................................................... 4-12 Figure 57 Waveguide flanges 18 to 38 GHz ............................................................................. 4-13 Figure 58 Waveguide flanges 11 GHz tapered transition......................................................... 4-13 Figure 59 Molex LFH Matrix 50 Receptacle 100 /120 Balanced interface .......................... 4-19 Figure 60 Data order wire - RS-422 connector ............................................................................ 4-21 Figure 61 Data order wire - RS-232 connector ............................................................................ 4-21 Figure 62 XPIC connector (Modem module) ............................................................................... 4-21 Figure 63 ODU connector (Modem module) ............................................................................... 4-22 Figure 64 European Union compliance label .............................................................................. 4-82 Figure 65 Dual-polar antenna in remote mount configuration ................................................... 5-11 Figure 66 Words embossed on coupler ....................................................................................... 5-22 Figure 67 Correct orientation of LPUs ........................................................................................ 5-39
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
xiii

List of Figures

Figure 68 ODU and top LPU grounding ...................................................................................... 5-44 Figure 69 Using the hoist line ..................................................................................................... 5-54 Figure 70 IF cable grounding on a mast or tower ...................................................................... 5-55 Figure 71 Grounding at building entry ....................................................................................... 5-61 Figure 72 Example of a cable analyzer ....................................................................................... 5-64 Figure 73 Example of the cable test ........................................................................................... 5-64 Figure 74 Cable loss plot for a 14 meter cable with no ODU ..................................................... 5-66 Figure 75 Cable loss plot for a 14 meter cable with ODU connected ......................................... 5-67 Figure 76 DTF plot for a 17 meter cable with no ODU ............................................................... 5-69 Figure 77 DTF plot for a 17 meter cable with ODU connected .................................................. 5-70 Figure 78 MMU with rack mounting bracket (front mounting option shown)............................ 5-71 Figure 79 MMU ground connector ............................................................................................. 5-72 Figure 80 MMU IF cable connector (non-standard connector shown) ....................................... 5-73 Figure 81 MMU DC power cable connector ............................................................................... 5-74 Figure 82 MMU with power cable connected ............................................................................. 5-75 Figure 83 Copper data interface connections ............................................................................. 5-78 Figure 84 Fiber data interface connections ................................................................................ 5-79 Figure 85 Management interface connections............................................................................ 5-82 Figure 86 E1/T1 interface (RJ-48C) ............................................................................................. 5-83 Figure 87 E1/T1 interface (molex 60-pin) ................................................................................... 5-84 Figure 88 XPIC interface ............................................................................................................. 5-85 Figure 89 Starting Information page ............................................................................................ 6-8 Figure 90 CLI General Information page .................................................................................... 6-10 Figure 91 CLI Main Menu page .................................................................................................. 6-11 Figure 92 Example of a configurable CLI page........................................................................... 6-12 Figure 93 General Network Configuration page......................................................................... 6-14 Figure 94 Serial Configuration page ........................................................................................... 6-16 Figure 95 Ethernet Payload page for MMU Standard Master I/O module ................................. 6-17 Figure 96 Ethernet Payload page for MMU GigE Master I/O module ........................................ 6-18 Figure 97 Ethernet Payload page for MMU GigE Master I/O module with an SFP module ....... 6-19 Figure 98 Ethernet NMS page .................................................................................................... 6-22 Figure 99 Summary of Configurations page ............................................................................... 6-24 Figure 100 ODU Operational Mode page.................................................................................... 6-26 Figure 101 IDU Operational mode page ..................................................................................... 6-27 Figure 102 Payload Configuration page...................................................................................... 6-28 Figure 103 ODU Tx Power Configuration page .......................................................................... 6-29 Figure 104 ODU Channel Selection page ................................................................................... 6-31
xiv

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Figure 105 Adaptive Coding Modulation page ............................................................................ 6-31 Figure 106 Summary of Configurations page with Redo and Update All buttons ...................... 6-33 Figure 107 ODU Tx Mute page ................................................................................................... 6-34 Figure 108 APC Configuration page ........................................................................................... 6-35 Figure 109 E1/T1 Channel Map page (pre-defined mapping) ..................................................... 6-39 Figure 110 E1/T1 Channel Map page (custom mapping) ............................................................ 6-41 Figure 111 E1/T1 Channel Map page (custom mapping updated).............................................. 6-41 Figure 112 E1/T1 Configurations page ....................................................................................... 6-43 Figure 113 E1/T1 Protection Switching page ............................................................................. 6-45 Figure 114 Voice Orderwire Configuration ................................................................................. 6-49 Figure 115 Protection Configuration page .................................................................................. 6-50 Figure 116 Remote transmit switch algorithm ........................................................................... 6-53 Figure 117 SNMP Configuration page ........................................................................................ 6-54 Figure 118 Alarm Configuration page......................................................................................... 6-58 Figure 119 Alarm Threshold page ............................................................................................... 6-60 Figure 120 Syslog Configuration page ........................................................................................ 6-62 Figure 121 QoS Global Configuration page (Standard Master I/O module) ............................... 6-63 Figure 122 QoS Global Configuration page (GigE Master I/O module) ...................................... 6-65 Figure 123 QoS Port Priority Map page (Standard Master I/O module)..................................... 6-67 Figure 124 QoS Port Priority Map for GigE Master I/O module ................................................. 6-68 Figure 125 QoS VLAN p-bit Tag Priority Map page .................................................................... 6-69 Figure 126 QoS DiffServ DSCP Map page (Standard Master I/O module) ................................. 6-70 Figure 127 QoS DiffServ DSCP Priority Map for GigE Master I/O module................................. 6-71 Figure 128 Switch Priority to Tx Priority Queue Map (GigE Master I/O module) ...................... 6-72 Figure 129 Global VLAN Configuration page.............................................................................. 6-74 Figure 130 Static VLAN Configuration ....................................................................................... 6-76 Figure 131 Add/Edit VLAN Configuration ................................................................................... 6-76 Figure 132 Port Based Forwarding Mode page .......................................................................... 6-77 Figure 133 MSTP Configuration page (when no MSTP instances exist)..................................... 6-89 Figure 134 MSTP Configuration page (when MSTP instances exist) ........................................ 6-89 Figure 135 MSTP Instance to VLAN Map page .......................................................................... 6-91 Figure 136 LACP Configuration page ......................................................................................... 6-92 Figure 137 LACP Status page ..................................................................................................... 6-93 Figure 138 Set Data & Time page (SNTP disabled) .................................................................... 6-96 Figure 139 Set Data & Time page (SNTP enabled)..................................................................... 6-97 Figure 140 Symmetrical relationship between voltage and alignment ..................................... 6-102 Figure 141 Typical RSSI voltage peaks and troughs ................................................................ 6-102
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
xv

List of Figures

Figure 142 Summary of Configuration page ............................................................................. 6-104 Figure 143 System Administration Login page ............................................................................. 7-2 Figure 144 Web interface without status panel ............................................................................ 7-3 Figure 145 Web interface with status panel ................................................................................. 7-4 Figure 146 Status panel examples (Standard and 2+0 XPIC) ...................................................... 7-5 Figure 147 Status panel examples (Protected Non-diversity, East/East and East/West) ............. 7-6 Figure 148 Menu bar .................................................................................................................... 7-9 Figure 149 Active Alarms page ................................................................................................... 7-15 Figure 150 Alarm History page ................................................................................................... 7-18 Figure 151 ODU Configuration page .......................................................................................... 7-21 Figure 152 Add User page .......................................................................................................... 7-27 Figure 153 Delete User page ...................................................................................................... 7-28 Figure 154 Event Log page ......................................................................................................... 7-29 Figure 155 Security Configuration page ..................................................................................... 7-30 Figure 156 RSL Graph ................................................................................................................ 7-32 Figure 157 Signal Noise Ratio Graph ......................................................................................... 7-33 Figure 158 XPIC SNR Graph ....................................................................................................... 7-34 Figure 159 Tx Power Graph ........................................................................................................ 7-35 Figure 160 RF Link Performance Graph ..................................................................................... 7-36 Figure 161 Equalizer Taps Graph ............................................................................................... 7-37 Figure 162 XPIC Equalizer Taps Graph ...................................................................................... 7-38 Figure 163 Constellation Graph (256 QAM) ............................................................................... 7-39 Figure 164 XPIC Constellation Graph (256 QAM) ...................................................................... 7-40 Figure 165 Temperature Graph .................................................................................................. 7-41 Figure 166 NMS Switch Statistics page ..................................................................................... 7-42 Figure 167 Data Switch (payload port) Statistics page .............................................................. 7-44 Figure 168 Ethernet NMS IEEE 802.1w RSTP Status page ..................................................... 7-46 Figure 169 Ethernet Payload IEEE 802.1w RSTP page ........................................................... 7-47 Figure 170 Ethernet Payload IEEE 802.1s MSTP page ............................................................ 7-48 Figure 171 Save/Restore Configuration page ............................................................................. 7-51 Figure 172 System Reboot page ................................................................................................. 7-53 Figure 173 Restore System Defaults page .................................................................................. 7-55 Figure 174 Device Information page........................................................................................... 7-57 Figure 175 Serial Number Information page .............................................................................. 7-58 Figure 176 Device Names page .................................................................................................. 7-59 Figure 177 Authorization Key ..................................................................................................... 7-61 Figure 178 XPIC Authorization Key ............................................................................................ 7-62
xvi

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Figure 179 Reprogramming page ............................................................................................... 7-64 Figure 180 MMU Modules .......................................................................................................... 7-67 Figure 181 Thumbscrew Locations ............................................................................................. 7-68 Figure 182 Threaded Hole Locations .......................................................................................... 7-68 Figure 183 Guides ....................................................................................................................... 7-69 Figure 184 Loopback page .......................................................................................................... 8-16 Figure 185 BERT Mode page ...................................................................................................... 8-19

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

xvii

PTP 810 Series User Guide

List of Tables
Table 1 PTP 810 licensed bands and frequencies ......................................................................... 1-3 Table 2 ODU interfaces ............................................................................................................... 1-22 Table 3 Insertion of tags in ingress frames in double tagged mode ........................................... 1-44 Table 4 Default user accounts ..................................................................................................... 1-51 Table 5 Web-based and CLI access rights................................................................................... 1-51 Table 6 MMU software versions ................................................................................................. 1-55 Table 7 E1/T1 port capacity ........................................................................................................ 1-58 Table 8 MMU base modules ........................................................................................................ 2-39 Table 9 MMU spare, expansion and upgrade modules ............................................................... 2-39 Table 10 MMU accessories ......................................................................................................... 2-40 Table 11 Single-step capacity upgrades (per MMU) ................................................................... 2-41 Table 12 Step-by-step capacity upgrades (per MMU)................................................................. 2-41 Table 13 XPIC capability (per MMU) .......................................................................................... 2-42 Table 14 Selecting antennas for each hardware configuration .................................................. 2-44 Table 15 Antennas: 6 GHz single polarization ............................................................................ 2-45 Table 16 Antennas: 6 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................... 2-45 Table 17 Antennas: 7 GHz and 8 GHz single polarization .......................................................... 2-46 Table 18 Antennas: 7 GHz and 8 GHz dual polarization ............................................................. 2-46 Table 19 Antennas: 11 GHz single polarization .......................................................................... 2-47 Table 20 Antennas: 11 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................. 2-47 Table 21 Antennas: 13 GHz single polarization .......................................................................... 2-48 Table 22 Antennas: 13 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................. 2-48 Table 23 Antennas: 15 GHz single polarization .......................................................................... 2-49 Table 24 Antennas: 15 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................. 2-49 Table 25 Antennas: 18 GHz single polarization .......................................................................... 2-50 Table 26 Antennas: 18 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................. 2-50 Table 27 Antennas: 23 GHz single polarization .......................................................................... 2-51 Table 28 Antennas: 23 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................. 2-51 Table 29 Antennas: 26 GHz single polarization .......................................................................... 2-52 Table 30 Antennas: 26 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................. 2-52 Table 31 Antennas: 28 GHz single polarization .......................................................................... 2-52

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

xviii

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Table 32 Antennas: 28 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................. 2-52 Table 33 Antennas: 32 GHz single polarization .......................................................................... 2-53 Table 34 Antennas: 32 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................. 2-53 Table 35 Antennas: 38 GHz single polarization .......................................................................... 2-53 Table 36 Antennas: 38 GHz dual polarization ............................................................................. 2-53 Table 37 Parabolic radomes (optional)........................................................................................ 2-54 Table 38 ODUs: Lower 6 GHz ODU-A ......................................................................................... 2-55 Table 39 ODUs: Upper 6 GHz ODU-A ......................................................................................... 2-55 Table 40 ODUs: 7 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................... 2-56 Table 41 ODUs: 8 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................... 2-58 Table 42 ODUs: 11 GHz ODU-B .................................................................................................. 2-59 Table 43 ODUs: 11 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................. 2-59 Table 44 ODUs: 13 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................. 2-60 Table 45 ODUs: 15 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................. 2-60 Table 46 ODUs: 18 GHz ODU-B .................................................................................................. 2-61 Table 47 ODUs: 18 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................. 2-62 Table 48 ODUs: 23 GHz ODU-B .................................................................................................. 2-62 Table 49 ODUs: 23 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................. 2-62 Table 50 ODUs: 26 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................. 2-63 Table 51 ODUs: 28 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................. 2-64 Table 52 ODUs: 32 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................. 2-64 Table 53 ODUs: 38 GHz ODU-A .................................................................................................. 2-64 Table 54 Cable and LPU components.......................................................................................... 2-65 Table 55 Inventory of the coaxial cable installation assembly kit (WB3616) .............................. 2-68 Table 56 RMKs, waveguides and accessories ............................................................................. 2-70 Table 57 Remote mounting kits................................................................................................... 2-71 Table 58 Flexible waveguides ..................................................................................................... 2-71 Table 59 Flex-twist hanger kits available from Cambium ........................................................... 2-73 Table 60 ODU coupler mounting kits .......................................................................................... 2-73 Table 61 Orthogonal mounting kits (OMKs)................................................................................ 2-75 Table 62 Copper network cables and connectors ....................................................................... 2-75 Table 63 Fiber network cables and connectors .......................................................................... 2-76 Table 64 MMU physical specifications .......................................................................................... 4-2 Table 65 MMU environmental specifications ................................................................................ 4-2 Table 66 MMU electrical specifications ........................................................................................ 4-2 Table 67 Worst case power consumption for 1+0 link types ........................................................ 4-3 Table 68 Worst case power consumption for 1+1 link types (*1) ................................................. 4-3
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
xix

List of Tables

Table 69 Worst case power consumption for 2+0 link types (*1) ................................................. 4-4 Table 70 AC to DC converter specifications .................................................................................. 4-4 Table 71 ODU physical specifications ........................................................................................... 4-5 Table 72 ODU-A and ODU-B environmental specifications........................................................... 4-5 Table 73 RSSI voltage, received signal level and bandwidth........................................................ 4-6 Table 74 Antenna, transition, waveguide and RMK flanges ....................................................... 4-10 Table 75 Torque value in Nm (lb ft) for each fastener size ......................................................... 4-14 Table 76 ODU coupler physical specifications ............................................................................ 4-14 Table 77 ODU coupler environmental specifications .................................................................. 4-14 Table 78 ODU coupler return losses and isolation ...................................................................... 4-15 Table 79 ODU coupler insertion losses ....................................................................................... 4-15 Table 80 DC Input (power) connector (Power Supply module) .................................................... 4-16 Table 81 Ethernet 100Base-T payload connector 1-2 (Master I/O module) ................................. 4-16 Table 82 Ethernet 1000Base-T payload connector 1-4 (GigE Master I/O module) ...................... 4-17 Table 83 Gigabit Ethernet optical SFP connector (GigE Master I/O module) ............................ 4-17 Table 84 NMS 10/100Base-TX connector 1-2 (Control module) ................................................... 4-17 Table 85 Serial/Alarm port connector (Control module) ............................................................... 4-18 Table 86 E1/T1 - channels 1-2 connector (Master I/O module).................................................... 4-18 Table 87 E1/T1 - channels 3-16 connector (Master I/O module) .................................................. 4-19 Table 88 General wireless specifications .................................................................................... 4-23 Table 89 ETSI band plan ............................................................................................................. 4-24 Table 90 FCC and IC band plan .................................................................................................. 4-25 Table 91 Cross-Reference of capacity license keys to frequency band....................................... 4-26 Table 92 Maximum number of E1/T1 circuits with ETSI channel separations ........................... 4-27 Table 93 Maximum number of E1/T1 circuits with FCC and Canada bandwidths ..................... 4-28 Table 94 Lower 6 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth ............................................. 4-30 Table 95 Lower 6 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth ............................................. 4-30 Table 96 Lower 6 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) .................................. 4-30 Table 97 Lower 6 GHz ETSI with 29.65 MHz channel separation .............................................. 4-31 Table 98 Lower 6 GHz ETSI with 29.65 MHz channel separation (XPIC) .................................. 4-31 Table 99 Upper 6 GHz FCC with 10 MHz bandwidth ................................................................. 4-31 Table 100 Upper 6 GHz FCC with 30 MHz bandwidth ............................................................... 4-32 Table 101 Upper 6 GHz FCC with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) .................................................... 4-32 Table 102 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation ................................................... 4-32 Table 103 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation ................................................. 4-33 Table 104 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 30 MHz channel separation ................................................. 4-33 Table 105 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 30 MHz channel separation (XPIC) ..................................... 4-33
xx

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Table 106 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 40 MHz channel separation ................................................. 4-34 Table 107 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 40 MHz channel separation (XPIC)...................................... 4-34 Table 108 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 60 MHz channel separation ................................................. 4-34 Table 109 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 60 MHz channel separation (XPIC)...................................... 4-35 Table 110 7 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation .............................................................. 4-35 Table 111 7 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-35 Table 112 7 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-36 Table 113 7 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC)................................................. 4-36 Table 114 8 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation .............................................................. 4-36 Table 115 8 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-37 Table 116 8 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-37 Table 117 8 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC)................................................. 4-37 Table 118 8 GHz ETSI with 29.65 MHz channel separation ....................................................... 4-38 Table 119 8 GHz ETSI with 29.65 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................ 4-38 Table 120 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-38 Table 121 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-39 Table 122 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-39 Table 123 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-39 Table 124 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) .......................... 4-40 Table 125 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) .......................... 4-40 Table 126 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-40 Table 127 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-41 Table 128 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) .......................... 4-41 Table 129 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) .......................... 4-41 Table 130 11 GHz ETSI with 40 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-42 Table 131 11 GHz ETSI with 40 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-42 Table 132 13 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-42 Table 133 13 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-43 Table 134 13 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-43 Table 135 13 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-43 Table 136 15 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-44 Table 137 15 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-44 Table 138 15 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-44 Table 139 15 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-45 Table 140 15 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-45 Table 141 15 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-45 Table 142 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-46
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
xxi

List of Tables

Table 143 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-46 Table 144 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 20 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-46 Table 145 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 20 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-47 Table 146 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-47 Table 147 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-47 Table 148 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) .......................... 4-48 Table 149 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) .......................... 4-48 Table 150 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-48 Table 151 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-49 Table 152 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) .......................... 4-49 Table 153 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) .......................... 4-49 Table 154 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-50 Table 155 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-50 Table 156 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) .......................... 4-50 Table 157 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) .......................... 4-51 Table 158 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 80 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-51 Table 159 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 80 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) .......................... 4-51 Table 160 18 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-52 Table 161 18 GHz ETSI with 13.75 MHz channel separation ..................................................... 4-52 Table 162 18 GHz ETSI with 27.5 MHz channel separation ....................................................... 4-52 Table 163 18 GHz ETSI with 55 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-53 Table 164 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-53 Table 165 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-54 Table 166 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 20 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-54 Table 167 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 20 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-54 Table 168 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-55 Table 169 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-55 Table 170 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) .......................... 4-55 Table 171 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) .......................... 4-56 Table 172 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-56 Table 173 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-56 Table 174 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) .......................... 4-57 Table 175 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) .......................... 4-57 Table 176 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) ...................................... 4-57 Table 177 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) ...................................... 4-58 Table 178 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) .......................... 4-58 Table 179 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) .......................... 4-58
xxii

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Table 180 23 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-59 Table 181 23 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-59 Table 182 23 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-59 Table 183 23 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-60 Table 184 23 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-60 Table 185 23 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-60 Table 186 26 GHz FCC with 10 MHz bandwidth ........................................................................ 4-61 Table 187 26 GHz FCC with 20 MHz bandwidth ........................................................................ 4-61 Table 188 26 GHz FCC with 40 MHz bandwidth ........................................................................ 4-62 Table 189 26 GHz FCC with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) ............................................................. 4-62 Table 190 26 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-62 Table 191 26 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-63 Table 192 26 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-63 Table 193 26 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-63 Table 194 26 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-64 Table 195 26 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-64 Table 196 28 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz bandwidth.......................................................................... 4-65 Table 197 28 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-65 Table 198 28 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-65 Table 199 28 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-66 Table 200 28 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-66 Table 201 28 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-66 Table 202 32 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-67 Table 203 28 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-67 Table 204 32 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-67 Table 205 32 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-68 Table 206 32 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-68 Table 207 32 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-68 Table 208 38 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth .................................................... 4-69 Table 209 38 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth .................................................... 4-69 Table 210 38 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) ......................................... 4-70 Table 211 38 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation ............................................................ 4-70 Table 212 38 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-70 Table 213 38 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-71 Table 214 38 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-71 Table 215 38 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation .......................................................... 4-71 Table 216 38 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC)............................................... 4-72
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
xxiii

List of Tables

Table 217 Fast Ethernet specifications ........................................................................................ 4-73 Table 218 Gigabit Ethernet specifications ................................................................................... 4-75 Table 219 Electrical safety specifications .................................................................................... 4-79 Table 220 PTP 810 minimum separation distances, ETSI method.............................................. 4-84 Table 221 PTP 810 minimum separation distances, FCC method (ODU) ................................... 4-86 Table 222 Tools required for PTP 810 installation ........................................................................ 5-3 Table 223 Selecting antenna and ODU installation procedures ................................................... 5-5 Table 224 Expected cable loss when ODU is not connected ....................................................... 5-67 Table 225 Default usernames and passwords ............................................................................... 6-8 Table 226 General Network Configuration attributes ................................................................ 6-15 Table 227 Ethernet Payload attributes (Spanning Tree Configuration) ..................................... 6-20 Table 228 Ethernet Payload attributes (Ethernet Port Configuration) ....................................... 6-20 Table 229 Ethernet NMS attributes (Spanning Tree Configuration) .......................................... 6-23 Table 230 Ethernet NMS attributes (Ethernet Port Configuration) ........................................... 6-23 Table 231 Step 1: Link Configuration mapping to ODU Operational Modes .............................. 6-26 Table 232 ODU Tx Power Configuration attributes .................................................................... 6-30 Table 233 APC attributes ............................................................................................................ 6-35 Table 234 Coupler loss attributes ............................................................................................... 6-37 Table 235 General purpose mappings ......................................................................................... 6-39 Table 236 Naming convention used in channel maps ................................................................. 6-40 Table 237 E1/T1 Configurations attributes ................................................................................. 6-44 Table 238 E1/T1 Protection Switching attributes ....................................................................... 6-46 Table 239 Protection Configuration attributes ........................................................................... 6-51 Table 240 SNMP Configuration attributes .................................................................................. 6-55 Table 241 Alarm Configuration attributes .................................................................................. 6-59 Table 242 Alarm Threshold attributes ........................................................................................ 6-61 Table 243 Syslog Configuration attributes ................................................................................. 6-62 Table 244 QoS Global Configuration attributes (Standard Master I/O module) ......................... 6-64 Table 245 QoS Global Configuration attributes (GigE Master I/O module) ................................ 6-66 Table 246 Global VLAN Configuration attributes ....................................................................... 6-74 Table 247 Add/Edit VLAN Configuration attributes .................................................................... 6-77 Table 248 MSTP Configuration attributes .................................................................................. 6-90 Table 249 LACP Configuration attributes ................................................................................... 6-93 Table 250 Manual clock attributes .............................................................................................. 6-96 Table 251 SNTP clock attributes................................................................................................. 6-97 Table 252 Status panel modem and alarm status indicators ........................................................ 7-7 Table 253 Procedures performed from each menu option .......................................................... 7-10
xxiv

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Table 254 Modem card status LED ............................................................................................. 7-17 Table 255 ODU Alarms ................................................................................................................ 7-18 Table 256 XPIC Alarms ................................................................................................................ 7-19 Table 257 Add User attributes .................................................................................................... 7-27 Table 258 Security Configuration attributes ............................................................................... 7-30 Table 259 NMS Switch Statistics attributes ............................................................................... 7-43 Table 260 Data Switch (payload port) attributes ........................................................................ 7-45 Table 261 Ethernet NMS IEEE 802.1w RSTP Status attributes ............................................... 7-46 Table 262 Ethernet Payload attributes ....................................................................................... 7-49 Table 263 MMU system default parameters ................................................................................ 7-55 Table 264 Device Information attributes .................................................................................... 7-57 Table 265 Device Names attributes ............................................................................................ 7-59 Table 266 Authorization Key attributes ...................................................................................... 7-61 Table 267 MMU software images and module storage ............................................................... 7-70 Table 268 MMU power supply status LED checks ........................................................................ 8-2 Table 269 DC supply checks when MMU power supply status LED is off or red ......................... 8-2 Table 270 MMU status indicator checks ....................................................................................... 8-3 Table 271 NMS port indicator checks ........................................................................................... 8-3 Table 272 Ping response checks ................................................................................................... 8-5 Table 273 Link configuration problems ........................................................................................ 8-8 Table 274 Loopback attributes .................................................................................................... 8-17 Table 275 BERT Mode attributes ................................................................................................ 8-19

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

xxv

List of Tables

xxvi

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

About This User Guide


This guide describes the planning, installation and operation of the Cambium PTP 810. It is intended for use by the system designer, system installer and the system administrator. Users of this guide should have knowledge of the following areas: Radio network design Outdoor radio equipment installation System installation, configuration, monitoring and fault finding

System designers should refer to the following chapters: Chapter 1: Product description Chapter 2: Planning considerations Chapter 3: Legal information Chapter 4: Reference information

Installers should refer to the following chapters: Chapter 5: Installation Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Operators should refer to the following chapters: Chapter 1: Product description Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment Chapter 7: Operation Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

General information

About This User Guide

General information
Version information
The following shows the issue status of this document: Document issue 001v000 Date of issue Jul 2012 Remarks System Release 810-01-00

Contacting Cambium Networks


Support website: Main website: Sales enquiries: Support enquiries: Telephone number list: Address: http://www.cambiumnetworks.com/support http://www.cambiumnetworks.com solutions@cambiumnetworks.com support@cambiumnetworks.com http://www.cambiumnetworks.com/contact.php Cambium Networks Limited, Linhay Business Park, Eastern Road, Ashburton, Devon, UK, TQ13 7UP

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

General information

Purpose
Cambium Networks Point-To-Point (PTP) documents are intended to instruct and assist personnel in the operation, installation and maintenance of the Cambium PTP equipment and ancillary devices. It is recommended that all personnel engaged in such activities be properly trained. Cambium disclaims all liability whatsoever, implied or express, for any risk of damage, loss or reduction in system performance arising directly or indirectly out of the failure of the customer, or anyone acting on the customer's behalf, to abide by the instructions, system parameters, or recommendations made in this document.

Cross references
References to external publications are shown in italics. Other cross references, emphasized in blue text in electronic versions, are active links to the references. This document is divided into numbered chapters that are divided into sections. Sections are not numbered, but are individually named at the top of each page, and are listed in the table of contents.

Feedback
We appreciate feedback from the users of our documents. This includes feedback on the structure, content, accuracy, or completeness of our documents. Send feedback to support@cambiumnetworks.com.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Problems and warranty

About This User Guide

Problems and warranty


Reporting problems
If any problems are encountered when installing or operating this equipment, follow this procedure to investigate and report: 1 2 3 4 5 Search this document and the software release notes of supported releases. Visit the support website. Ask for assistance from the Cambium product supplier. Gather information from affected units, such as any available diagnostic downloads. Escalate the problem by emailing or telephoning support.

Repair and service


If unit failure is suspected, obtain details of the Return Material Authorization (RMA) process from the support website.

Warranty
Cambiums standard hardware warranty is for one (1) year from date of shipment from Cambium or a Cambium distributor. Cambium warrants that hardware will conform to the relevant published specifications and will be free from material defects in material and workmanship under normal use and service. Cambium shall within this time, at its own option, either repair or replace the defective product within thirty (30) days of receipt of the defective product. Repaired or replaced product will be subject to the original warranty period but not less than thirty (30) days. To register PTP products or activate warranties, visit the support website. For warranty assistance, contact the reseller or distributor.

Using non-Cambium parts for repair could damage the equipment or void warranty. Contact Cambium for service and repair instructions.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Problems and warranty

Portions of Cambium equipment may be damaged from exposure to electrostatic discharge. Use precautions to prevent damage.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Security advice

About This User Guide

Security advice
Cambium Networks systems and equipment provide security parameters that can be configured by the operator based on their particular operating environment. Cambium recommends setting and using these parameters following industry recognized security practices. Security aspects to be considered are protecting the confidentiality, integrity, and availability of information and assets. Assets include the ability to communicate, information about the nature of the communications, and information about the parties involved. In certain instances Cambium makes specific recommendations regarding security practices, however the implementation of these recommendations and final responsibility for the security of the system lies with the operator of the system.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Warnings, cautions, and notes

Warnings, cautions, and notes


The following describes how warnings and cautions are used in this document and in all documents of the Cambium Networks document set.

Warnings
Warnings precede instructions that contain potentially hazardous situations. Warnings are used to alert the reader to possible hazards that could cause loss of life or physical injury. A warning has the following format:

Warning text and consequence for not following the instructions in the warning.

Cautions
Cautions precede instructions and are used when there is a possibility of damage to systems, software, or individual items of equipment within a system. However, this damage presents no danger to personnel. A caution has the following format:

Caution text and consequence for not following the instructions in the caution.

Notes
A note means that there is a possibility of an undesirable situation or provides additional information to help the reader understand a topic or concept. A note has the following format:

Note text.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Caring for the environment

About This User Guide

Caring for the environment


The following information describes national or regional requirements for the disposal of Cambium Networks supplied equipment and for the approved disposal of surplus packaging.

In EU countries
The following information is provided to enable regulatory compliance with the European Union (EU) directives identified and any amendments made to these directives when using Cambium equipment in EU countries.

Disposal of Cambium equipment


European Union (EU) Directive 2002/96/EC Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE)
Do not dispose of Cambium equipment in landfill sites. In the EU, Cambium in conjunction with a recycling partner ensures that equipment is collected and recycled according to the requirements of EU environmental law.

Disposal of surplus packaging


Do not dispose of surplus packaging in landfill sites. In the EU, it is the individual recipients responsibility to ensure that packaging materials are collected and recycled according to the requirements of EU environmental law.

In non-EU countries
In non-EU countries, dispose of Cambium equipment and all surplus packaging in accordance with national and regional regulations.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Licensing requirements

Licensing requirements
Operating license
This equipment operates in bands that require a license in most countries.

In most countries it is illegal to operate the PTP 810 without a license from the regional or local regulating authority.

United States of America


This device has been verified by Cambium Networks as being in compliance with the requirements of the rules of the Federal Communications Commission (FCC), 47 C.F.R. Part 101, and may not be operated without a station license. In the United States such licenses are issued by the FCC to entities other than agencies of the United States government. Federal government agencies are licensed by the National Telecommunications and Information Administration (NTIA) acting upon the recommendation of the Interdepartment Radio Advisory Committee (IRAC).

Cambium license agreement


The PTP 810 must be operated in accordance with the Cambium Networks end user license agreement, as specified in Chapter 3: Legal information.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Licensing requirements

About This User Guide

10

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Chapter 1: Product description


This chapter provides a high level description of the PTP 810 product. It describes in general terms the function of the product, the main product variants and typical deployment. It also describes the main hardware components. The following topics are described in this chapter: Overview on page 1-2 introduces the key features, typical uses, product variants and components of the PTP 810. Modular modem unit (MMU) on page 1-8 describes the MMU and its interfaces. Outdoor unit (ODU) on page 1-18 describes the ODU and its interfaces. Antennas and couplers on page 1-24 describes the PTP 810 antennas, couplers and remote mounting kit. Cabling and lightning protection on page 1-31 describes the cabling and lightning protection components of a PTP 810 installation. Wireless operation on page 1-34 describes how the PTP 810 wireless link is operated, including modulation modes, power control and security. Ethernet bridging in the customer network on page 1-38 describes how the PTP 810 bridges Ethernet data in the customer data network. Ethernet bridging in the management network on page 1-47 describes how the PTP 810 bridges Ethernet data in the management network. System management on page 1-50 introduces the PTP 810 management system, including the web interface, installation, configuration, alerts and upgrades. TDM bridging on page 1-57 describes PTP 810 capabilities for E1/T1 transmission over wireless links, and for switching of E1/T1 circuits within the MMU.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-1

Overview

Chapter 1: Product description

Overview
Cambium Networks carrier-grade PTP 810 systems provide reliable, high-capacity connectivity and backhaul for Ethernet and TDM applications. The PTP 810 provides great flexibility to configure PTP systems to address a wide range of applications at affordable cost. The PTP 810 supports a number of configurations including: 1+1 hot standby, 1+1 hot standby with spatial diversity, dual 1+0, 2+0 co-polar, 2+0 cross-polar, and 2+0 XPIC.

Key features
The key features of the PTP 810 are as follows: Flexible indoor Modular Modem Unit (MMU) with pluggable modules that support T1/E1, and Ethernet interfaces. Split mount architecture, with the Outdoor Unit (ODU) mounted outdoors and the Modular Modem Unit (MMU) mounted indoors. Outdoor Units (ODUs) that are common to PTP 800 and PTP 810. Native Ethernet and TDM transmission. Built-in T1/E1 cross-connection switch. Built-in L2 Ethernet switch. 1+0, 1+1 Hot Standby, 1+1 Hot Standby with Spatial Diversity, 2+0 Co-Polar, 2+0 Cross Polar, 2+0 XPIC Support for ribbon and ring networks. Embedded link aggregation for 2+0 links. Configurable channel bandwidths from 7 MHz to 80 MHz. Fixed modulation modes QPSK to 256 QAM. Link capacity from 9 Mbps to 696 Mbps in each direction. Support for licensed bands from 6 GHz to 38 GHz. Upgradeable link capacity limits from 10 Mbps to full capacity via software authorization key. Optional Cross Polar Interference Cancellation (XPIC) mode. Effective quality of service (QoS), with Layer 2 or Layer 3 classification and four priority queues. Ultra-low latency, <115 us @ 332 Mbps with 64 byte frames. Network management (out-of-band). SNMP v1, v2 and v3 security.

1-2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Overview

Link planning with the PTP LINKPlanner.

Supported bands and frequencies


PTP 810 supports the licensed bands and frequencies listed in Table 1. Table 1 PTP 810 licensed bands and frequencies Licensed band Lower 6 GHz Upper 6 GHz Regions FCC, IC, ETSI FCC ETSI 7 GHz 8 GHz 11 GHz ETSI ETSI FCC, IC ETSI 13 GHz 15 GHz 18 GHz 23 GHz ETSI ETSI FCC, IC, ETSI FCC, IC ETSI 26 GHz 28 GHz 32 GHz 38 GHz FCC, ETSI ETSI ETSI FCC, IC ETSI Frequency coverage 5.925 6.425 GHz 6.525 6.875 GHz 6.425 7.100 GHz 7.110 7.900 GHz 7.725 8.500 GHz 10.710 11.690 GHz 10.700 11.700 GHz 12.750 13.250 GHz 14.400 15.350 GHz 17.700 19.700 GHz 21.800 23.600 GHz 21.200 23.600 GHz 24.250 26.500 GHz 27.500 29.500 GHz 31.800 33.400 GHz 38.600 40.000 GHz 37.000 40.000 GHz

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-3

Overview

Chapter 1: Product description

Typical users and applications


PTP 810 systems provide connectivity and backhaul for organizations such as service providers, government and public safety agencies, utilities, health care and hospitals, schools and universities, local government, transportation companies, and business enterprises. Typical applications include: Leased-Line Replacement: Replace or supplement leased-line service to reduce or eliminate recurring fees. Video Surveillance Backhaul: Affordably and reliably backhaul video from surveillance cameras to a dispatch or command center. Network Redundancy: Provide network redundancy for wired or fiber networks. Remote Connectivity: Support teleworkers, mobile personnel and field technicians with always-on access and collaborative communications. Wireless Network Extensions: Connect remote locations where wired service does not exist such as on protected lands. Building-to-Building and Campus Connectivity: Connect between buildings or connect buildings in a campus setting.

System components
The main components of the PTP 810 are shown in Figure 1. Figure 1 Typical PTP 810 deployment

1-4

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Overview

The main components are: Modular modem unit (MMU): The MMU is a flexible and modular indoor unit, providing multiple Ethernet and E1/T1 interfaces to the operators data network, with switching and multiplexing capabilities for operators data traffic. Each MMU connects to one or two Outdoor units (ODUs). A single co-axial connection between the MMU and each of the ODUs carries modulated transmit and receive signals at intermediate frequency (IF), -48 V power for the ODU, and control signals to configure and monitor the ODU. Outdoor unit (ODU): The ODU provides a waveguide RF interface for direct or remote connection to antennas and RF couplers. The ODU up-converts modulated IF signals from the MMU for transmission over the wireless link, and returns downconverted received wireless signals to be demodulated by the MMU. Antennas and couplers: Cambium supplies high performance, low profile antennas for PTP 810 frequency bands in sizes from 0.3 m (1 ft) to 3.7 m (12 ft). These can be mounted directly to the ODUs, or remotely via waveguide. In 1+1 Hot Standby and 2+0 links, ODUs installed at the same end can share an antenna through the use of coupler mounting. Cabling and lightning protection: The MMU is connected to ODUs using CNT-400 coaxial cable (IF cable) and lightning protection units (LPUs). MMUs, ODUs, LPUs and IF cables must all be grounded to provide optimum protection against lightning events.

The term SDIDU appears in a number of places in the user interface. This is an alternative term for the MMU.

Link types
The PTP 810 system supports the following link types: 1+0: A 1+0 link is a single link with no redundancy protection. Each link end uses one ODU and one antenna. If a hardware unit or module fails, the link will be unavailable until the failed item is replaced. 1+1 Hot Standby: A 1+1 Hot Standby link provides protection against single point equipment failure. This is achieved by the deployment of two ODUs at each end, with two modems installed in the Modular Modem Unit at each end. 1+1 Hot Standby with Spatial Diversity: A 1+1 HSB SD link is identical to a 1+1 HSB link, but it uses two antennas at each end of the link to provide spatial diversity. 2+0 Co-Polar: A 2+0 Co-Polar configuration provides two parallel wireless links across a common path, using two RF channels with the same polarization on different frequencies. Each link end uses two ODUs and one or two antennas, and normally requires two separate operating licenses.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-5

Overview

Chapter 1: Product description

2+0 Cross-Polar: A 2+0 Cross-Polar configuration is identical to the 2+0 Co-Polar configuration, except that the two parallel links are on different polarizarions (and different frequencies). 2+0 Cross-Polar Interference Cancellation (XPIC): A 2+0 XPIC configuration is identical to the 2+0 Cross-Polar configuration, except that the two links are on the same frequency, and cross-polar interference cancellation is enabled.

Dual 1+0 links


The PTP 810 Modular Modem Unit supports a Dual 1+0 configuration. In this configuration, a single MMU connects to two ODUs, and provides two independent 1+0 links. This configuration is useful in ring, mesh, ribbon and star networks where several links terminate at the same site. The Dual 1+0 configuration allows Ethernet data to be forwarded between the two wireless links and the front panel Ethernet ports. It also allows E1/T1 traffic to be relayed between wireless links or terminated at front panel E1/T1 ports. In the Dual 1+0 configuration, the MMU can be configured to provide path protection for Ethernet traffic (using RSTP) or E1/T1 traffic (using subnetwork connection protection (SNCP-like) operation). These path protection protocols are particularly useful in 1+0 ring configurations where they provide self-healing in the event of a link outage. Both the network management Ethernet traffic and the customer payload Ethernet traffic are protected in a 1+0 ring configuration using RSTP. An example of a 1+0 ring configuration for Ethernet traffic is shown in Figure 2. This protected 1+0 ring configuration works with E1/T1 traffic as well using SNCP-like operation.

1-6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Overview

Figure 2 Example of a 1+0 ring configuration

Wireless link aggregation


The 2+0 link types can be configured to aggregate the Ethernet payload of the two wireless links. The MMUs internal Ethernet switch load balances packets between the two radio links. This feature is only available when the MMU is fitted with the Gig-E Master I/O module. See GigE Master I/O module on page 1-13 for more details of this module. For more information about these link types refer to: Planning 1+0 links on page 2-22 Planning 1+1 links on page 2-25 Planning 2+0 links on page 2-31

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-7

Modular modem unit (MMU)

Chapter 1: Product description

Modular modem unit (MMU)


This section describes the PTP 810 MMU, its main capabilities and its interfaces.

MMU description
The PTP 810 modular modem unit (MMU) is a flexible and modular indoor unit, providing multiple Ethernet and E1/T1 interfaces to one or more data networks, with internal switching and multiplexing capabilities for data traffic.

Required modules
Every MMU configuration requires, as a minimum, four modules for a basic 1+0 configuration: Power Supply Module Control Module Modem Module Master I/O Module, selected from the following options: o o Standard Master I/O Module GigE Master I/O Module

The module locations are shown in Figure 3. Figure 3 MMU module locations

Power Supply Module


The Power Supply Module provides an interface between the MMU and an external DC power supply, and provides low voltage supplies used by the remaining MMU modules.

1-8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Modular modem unit (MMU)

The Power Supply Module front panel is shown in Figure 4. Figure 4 MMU module Power Supply Module front panel

DC power input
The MMU requires an input voltage of 41 V dc to 60 V dc at the front panel DC Input connector. The MMU then supplies power to the rest of the PTP 810 system including the ODUs. The power dissipation of the complete PTP 810 is dependent on the specific configuration. Details are given in MMU specifications on page 4-2. The MMU front panel power connector pin numbering is as follows: Pin 1 (RET): Power supply return. Pin 2 (48V): Nominal 48 V dc input.

The power supply may be isolated from ground (in which case, the return side will be connected to ground via a diode in the MMU), or the return side may be connected to ground externally. The MMU is protected against reverse polarity for a ground-isolated power supply.

The power supply, the MMU or the ODU may be damaged if a ground-referenced power supply is connected with reverse polarity. Avoid connecting +48 V dc to Pin 2 if Pin 1 is connected to ground. The MMU supplies the ODU with all required power via the IF cable. The DC current drawn by the MMU is specified, for various configurations, in MMU specifications on page 4-2.

DC power connector and wiring


A mating power cable connector is supplied with the MMU. It is a 2-pin plug, 5 mm pitch, manufactured by Phoenix Contact, P/N 17 86 83 1 (connector type MSTB 2,5/2-STF). This connector has screw clamp terminals that accommodate 24 AWG to 12 AWG wire. Select the power cable wire to provide the appropriate current with minimal voltage drop, based on the power supply voltage and length of cable required. The recommended wire size for power cables under 3.1 m (10 feet) in length supplying 48 V dc is 18 AWG.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-9

Modular modem unit (MMU)

Chapter 1: Product description

The MMU does not have a power on/off switch. When DC power is connected to the MMU, the digital radio powers up and is operational. By default the ODU(s) are muted and will not radiate RF power until the MMU is configured using the Link Configuration Wizard. Once the MMU is configured, the antenna should be directed safely before power is applied.

Control Module
The Control Module (Figure 5) hosts the MMU network management agent. The network management agent supports a single IP interface with HTTP, HTTPS, Telnet, SSH, and SNMP protocols. The MMU provides network management access to the management agent using two copper Ethernet ports on the Control Module front panel. The Control Module additionally provides a serial console interface, and alarm inputs and outputs. The Control Module can be removed/replaced without affecting service. Figure 5 MMU Control Module front panel

Control Module interfaces


The Control Module provides the following external interfaces: NMS 10/100 Port 1: Access to the network management agent for HTTP, HTTPS, Telnet, SSH, and SNMP using 10BASE-T and 100BASE-TX Ethernet interfaces. NMS 10/100 Port 2: Similar to Port 1. Serial/Alarm: Serial console, two Form-C relay alarm outputs, two TTL alarm outputs, four TTL alarm inputs on a DB-15HD female connector. USB: Not used at present. Ground terminal: One of two possible ground connections for the MMU.

Control Module status indicator


The Status indicator is the primary front panel indicator for the status of the MMU. Alarm codes are indicated by means of patterns of flashes. The alarm codes are listed in Alarms on page V.
1-10

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Modular modem unit (MMU)

Command line interface


In addition to web-based management and SNMP, the MMU provides a command line interface (CLI) for network management via Telnet or SSH (over Ethernet), or via a serial data interface. The serial interface provides a convenient means to configure the IP interface if the existing IP address is unknown or unreachable.

Alarm assignments
External alarm inputs can be reported to the network management system. Any of the alarm conditions can be mapped to the external alarm outputs.

Modem Module
The Modem Module (Figure 6) provides the external interface with one ODU using a single co-axial connection. The Modem Module has the following functions: Modulator: Generates a modulated IF signal at 350 MHz ready for frequency up-conversion and amplification by the ODU. Demodulator: Receives a modulated IF signal at 140 MHz from the ODU. DC power: Provides power to the ODU at nominal 48 V dc Control and monitoring of the ODU

Figure 6 MMU Modem Module front panel

Modem Module interfaces


The Modem Module provides the following interfaces: ODU: Connects the IF cable using a 50 TNC connector. XPIC: Connects to a second Modem Module for use in the 2+0 XPIC link type. See Additional Modem Module on page 1-15 for further details.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-11

Modular modem unit (MMU)

Chapter 1: Product description

Modem Module status indicator


The Modem Module status indicator has the following states: Green: The wireless link is locked and the modem is active. Orange: The wireless link is locked and the modem is in standby for a 1+1 Hot Standby link. Flashing Green: Low signal-to-noise ratio (SNR). Flashing Orange: The wireless link is unlocked. Flashing Red: ODU 48V power is disabled. Red: May occur in the following conditions: o ODU Power Fault. Occurs when the 48 V to the Modem Module is low or excessive current is being drawn from the 48 V. In either case, the 48 V will be disabled by the hardware. Modem Hardware Fault. Occurs when any of the power-on self tests failed or IF Power Fault or Digital Power Fault detected during normal operation.

Locked means that the link is established (up). Unlocked means that the link is not established (down).

Standard Master I/O module


The Standard Master I/O module (Figure 7) provides the external interface with the Ethernet and TDM network. This module supports connection to an Ethernet data network using one or two Fast Ethernet (100BASE-TX) ports, and to a TDM network using up to 16 T1 or E1 circuits. In addition, the Standard Master I/O module supports the following functions: QoS VLAN bridging 1+1 protection switching Ethernet spanning tree convergence using rapid spanning tree protocol (RSTP) TDM switching Data orderwire Port mapping

1-12

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Modular modem unit (MMU)

Figure 7 MMU Standard Master I/O Module front panel

Standard Master I/O Module external interfaces


The Standard Master I/O module provides the following individual external interfaces: User 10/100 Port 1: RJ-45 connector, auto-negotiation. Connection to the customer data network switch using 10BASE-T and 100BASE-TX Ethernet interfaces. User 10/100 Port 2: Same as User 10/100 Port 1. E1/T1 Port 1: Connection to the customer TDM network via E1 (120 balanced) or T1 (100 balanced) using an RJ-48C connector. E1/T1 Port 2: Same as E1/T1 Port 1. E1/T1 Ports 3 to 16: Fourteen E1/T1 circuits connected via a single 60-pin Molex connector. Aux (Data Orderwire): A serial data channel available for control of external equipment using RJ-45 connector supporting RS-422 up to 64 kbps or RS-232 up to 19.2 kbps. Ground terminal: One of two possible ground connections for the MMU. Call button: Not used.

GigE Master I/O module


The GigE Master I/O module (Figure 8) provides the external interface with the Ethernet and TDM data network. This module supports connection to an Ethernet data network using a copper or fiber Gigabit Ethernet port (using an optional SFP module), one to four copper Gigabit Ethernet (1000BASE-T) ports, and to a TDM network using one or two T1 or E1 circuits. In addition, the GigE Master I/O module supports the following functions: VLAN bridging 1+1 protection switching Ethernet spanning tree convergence using using rapid spanning tree protocol (RSTP) TDM cross-point switching Data orderwire Transparent aggregation for 2+0 link types
1-13

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Modular modem unit (MMU)

Chapter 1: Product description

Figure 8 MMU GigE Master I/O Module front panel

GigE Master I/O Module external interfaces


The GigE Master I/O module provides the following individual external interfaces: SFP: Connection to the customer data network by a copper or fiber Ethernet interface using an optional SFP module. User 10/100/1000 Port 1: RJ45 connection to the customer data network using 10BASE-T, 100BASE-TX and 1000BASE-TX Ethernet interfaces. User 10/100/1000 Port 2, 3, 4: Same as User 10/100/1000 Port 1. Aux (Data Orderwire): RJ-45 connector supporting RS-422 up to 64 kbps or RS-232 up to 19.2 kbps. E1/T1 Port 1: Connection to the customer TDM network via E1 (120 balanced) or T1 (100 balanced) using an RJ-48C connector. E1/T1 Port 2: Same as E1/T1 Port 1. Ground terminal: One of two possible ground connections for the MMU.

Jumbo frame support


The GigE Master I/O Module supports jumbo-sized Ethernet frames up to 9728 octets (4000 Bytes for the SNCP-like version).

Additional modules
The modular construction of the MMU accepts the following additional or optional modules: Additional Power Supply Module Additional Modem Module Expansion I/O: 16 E1/T1 The module locations are shown in Figure 9.

1-14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Modular modem unit (MMU)

Figure 9 MMU additional module locations

Additional Power Supply Module


The additional Power Supply Module provides hardware redundancy. An MMU with two Power Supply Modules will remain in operation following a failure of either module. For additional protection, the two Power Supply Modules may be connected to two independent 48 V supplies.

The addition of an extra power supply module does not provide higher power to the PTP 810.

Additional Modem Module


The additional Modem Module is required for the following link types: Dual 1+0 1+1 Hot Standby 1+1 Hot Standby with Spatial Diversity 2+0 Co-Polar 2+0 Cross-Polar 2+0 Cross-Polar Interference Cancellation (XPIC)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-15

Modular modem unit (MMU)

Chapter 1: Product description

XPIC cable
In the 2+0 XPIC configuration, the two Modem Modules must be linked using the PTP 810 XPIC Cable for operation (Figure 10). The XPIC cable exchanges digital IF signals between the horizontal and vertical polarization modems to cancel cross-polar interference. Figure 10 MMU XPIC cable linking two Modem Modules

Expansion I/O: 16 E1/T1


The Expansion I/O: 16 E1/T1 module provides additional connections to a TDM data network (Figure 11). This module supports up to 16 T1 or E1 circuits. The Expansion I/O can be used in conjunction with the Standard Master I/O to provide a total of 32 E1/T1 circuits, or with the GigE Master I/O to provide a total of 18 E1/T1 circuits. Figure 11 MMU expansion I/O: 16 E1/T1 front panel

1-16

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Modular modem unit (MMU)

Expansion I/O: 16 E1/T1 external interfaces


The Expansion I/O: 16 E1/T1 module provides the following individual external interfaces: E1/T1 Port 1: Connection to the customer TDM network via E1 (120 balanced) or T1 (100 balanced) using an RJ-48C connector. E1/T1 Port 2: Similar to Port 1. E1/T1 Ports 3 to 16: Fourteen E1/T1 circuits connected via a single 60-pin Molex connector.

Further reading on the MMU


For more information on the MMU, refer to the following: Ordering MMUs on page 2-39 describes how to order MMUs for the link and specifies the Cambium part number of the MMU kit. MMU specifications on page 4-2 contains specifications of the MMU, such as dimensions, weight and environmental requirements. Installing the MMU on page 5-71 describes how to install and connect the MMU. Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links) on page 5-77 describes how to prepare the MMU network connections for unprotected links. Connecting to the network on page 6-94 describes how to complete and test the MMU network connections.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-17

Outdoor unit (ODU)

Chapter 1: Product description

Outdoor unit (ODU)


This section describes the ODU and its interfaces.

The PTP 810 Series and PTP 800 Series support an identical set of ODUs.

ODU description
The outdoor unit (ODU) provides the necessary frequency conversion and amplification of signals which pass between the MMU and antenna. In the transmit direction, the ODU takes the fixed intermediate frequency (IF) signal provided by the MMU and converts and amplifies it to a configured licensed band radio frequency signal for transmission at the antenna. In the receive direction, the ODU provides amplification and down conversion of a licensed band signal received at the antenna interface. The result is a fixed IF signal which is passed to the MMU for demodulation. ODUs are available in all licensed bands supported by PTP 810 (see Supported bands and frequencies on page 1-3 for the full list of supported bands). A given licensed band is generally split into sub-bands where a given sub-band is supported by a pair of ODUs. One ODU is designed to transmit at the high frequency side of the Frequency Division Duplex (FDD), the other at the low frequency side. The ODU transmit and receive frequencies are configurable within a sub-band. The ODU is designed for outdoor operation, either mounting directly to the back of an antenna or mounted separately using a Remote Mount Kit which then connects to the antenna with flexible waveguide. The ODU also provides an interface which allows the installer to monitor the receive signal level when aligning antennas.

1-18

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Outdoor unit (ODU)

Alternative ODU platforms


There are two alternative ODU platforms: ODU-A and ODU-B. The platform can be identified from the label. ODU-A is available in all bands, whereas ODU-B is only available in selected regions and bands. ODU-B is the preferred choice when available, as it offers the following advantages over ODU-A: higher transmit power and lower power dissipation.

Do not install an ODU-A and an ODU-B in the same link. For more information about the capabilities and availability of ODU-A and ODU-B, refer to Ordering ODUs on page 2-54.

The term ODU covers both ODU-A and ODU-B.

ODU interfaces
The ODU interfaces are illustrated in: Figure 12, Figure 13, Figure 14, Figure 15 and Figure 16. They are described in Table 2.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-19

Outdoor unit (ODU)

Chapter 1: Product description

Figure 12 ODU-A front view

Figure 13 ODU-B front view

1-20

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Outdoor unit (ODU)

Figure 14 ODU rear view

Figure 15 ODU-A side view

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-21

Outdoor unit (ODU)

Chapter 1: Product description

Figure 16 ODU-B side view

Table 2 ODU interfaces # 1 Interface Waveguide polarization arrow Spring loaded latches Function This indicates the orientation of the waveguide interface. The arrow is parallel to the short dimension of the rectangular waveguide aperture. These four spring loaded latches are used to fasten the ODU to the antenna, remote mounting kit or coupler. This connects to a Cambium direct mount antenna, an ODU coupler kit, or a remote mounting kit. This is used to ground the ODU to the top lightning protection unit (LPU). The received signal strength indication (RSSI) connector is a standard BNC female connector that provides access to an analogue voltage proportional to the received power at the ODU input. A voltmeter is attached to the RSSI connector to measure the voltage when aligning the antenna. For more information, see Aligning antennas on page 6-100. This connects the ODU to the MMU via an IF cable.

3 4 5

Waveguide interface Ground connector RSSI connector

MMU connector

1-22

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Outdoor unit (ODU)

Further reading on the ODU


For more information on the ODU, refer to the following: Grounding and lightning protection on page 2-7 describes the grounding and lightning protection requirements of a PTP 810 installation, including the ODU. Ordering ODUs on page 2-54 lists the ODUs available for PTP 810 installations, with Cambium part numbers. ODU specifications on page 4-5 contains specifications of the ODU, such as dimensions, weight and environmental requirements. Coupler mounting kit specifications on page 4-14 contains specifications of the couplers that may be used to connect two ODUs to one antenna. Installing antennas and ODUs on page 5-5 describes how to install the antennas, ODUs and waveguide connections at each link end, either in a direct mount or remote mount configuration, with or without couplers.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-23

Antennas and couplers

Chapter 1: Product description

Antennas and couplers


This section describes the PTP 810 antennas, couplers and remote mounting kit.

Antennas
A typical antenna is shown in Figure 17. Figure 17 Typical PTP 810 antenna with ODU (Cambium direct mount interface)

Antenna diameter
In each band, the antennas are provided in a number of diameters, the larger the diameter, the greater the gain.

Antenna interface
There are two types of antennas providing different interfaces to the ODU: Direct mount interface: The ODU mounts directly to the back of the antenna (Figure 18) and is secured using the integral spring loaded latches (Figure 19). Waveguide interface: The antenna connects to the ODU via a waveguide (Figure 20). The ODU is mounted separately from the antenna.

1-24

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Antennas and couplers

Figure 18 Direct mount mechanical interface

Figure 19 ODU clipped onto direct mount mechanical interface

Figure 20 Remote mount antenna waveguide interface

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-25

Antennas and couplers

Chapter 1: Product description

Antenna polarization
Antennas can be provided as single polar or dual polar: Single polar : A single polar antenna provides a single interface to the ODU. The antennas are normally supplied with vertical polarization. For horizontal polarization, the antennas can be modified by the user using the instructions provided. Single polar antennas can be provided with a direct mount interface or a waveguide interface. Dual polar: Dual polar antennas provide two interfaces, one with vertical polarization and one with horizontal polarization. This allows two links connecting the same two sites to share antennas, the two links operating on opposite polarizations. Dual Polar antennas provide a waveguide interface only.

Remote mounting kits (RMKs)


An RMK is used in a remote mount configuration to connect the ODU (or coupler) to the antenna via a flexible waveguide. Direct mount configurations do not require RMKs. The RMK has the following features: A clamp for attaching the RMK to a mounting pole. A cylindrical transition (Figure 21) onto which the ODU mounts. A waveguide interface transition (Figure 22) for connection to the antenna via a flexible waveguide.

The choice of RMK depends upon the frequency variant. The 11 GHz RMK is always used with a tapered transition between the antenna and the flexible waveguide. Figure 21 RMK showing the ODU interface

1-26

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Antennas and couplers

Figure 22 RMK showing the waveguide interface

Coupler mounting kits


The signals from two ODUs can be coupled to a single antenna. The ODUs mount directly to the coupler (Figure 23) which then provides an interface to the antenna which is identical to that of an ODU. The coupler can mount directly to the back of a direct mount interface antenna (Figure 24), or it can be mounted separately using the remote mounting kit (RMK). There are two types of coupler: Symmetric coupler: The symmetric coupler splits the power evenly between the two ODUs. A nominal 3 dB is lost in each arm of the coupler. Symmetric couplers are required in 2+0 Co-Polar links. They may also be deployed in 1+1 Hot Standby links if asymmetric couplers would cause excessive loss. Asymmetric coupler: The asymmetric coupler splits the power in a way which favours one ODU. A nominal 1 dB is lost in the Main arm of the coupler with a nominal 7 dB being lost in the other arm. This is often a preferred option for 1+1 Hot Standby links (see Link types on page 1-5).

Couplers increase system loss. The choice of coupler mounting kit depends on the frequency variant and on the coupler type required (symmetric or asymmetric).

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-27

Antennas and couplers

Chapter 1: Product description

Figure 23 ODU coupler mounting kit

Figure 24 Two ODUs and antenna mounted on a coupler

1-28

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Antennas and couplers

Direct mount dual-polar antennas


Direct mount dual-polar antennas are only used in 2+0 cross-polar and 2+0 XPIC direct mount configurations. They are supplied with an orthogonal mode transducer (Figure 25) with transitions (vertical and horizontal) that allow two ODUs to be coupled to the antenna. Cambium supply dual-polar direct mount antennas as listed in Ordering antennas on page 2-44. However, if a previously purchased antenna is to be upgraded to support a 2+0 cross-polar direct mount configuration, Cambium can supply separate orthogonal mount kits (OMKs), as listed in Ordering OMKs on page 2-75. The OMK can only be fitted to an antenna that is in the same band, for example, a 6 GHz antenna can only accept a 6 GHz OMK. Figure 25 Orthogonal mode transducer

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-29

Antennas and couplers

Chapter 1: Product description

Further reading on antennas and couplers


For more information on antennas and antenna accessories, refer to the following: Site selection on page 2-3 describes how to select a site for the antenna. Grounding and lightning protection on page 2-7 describes the grounding and lightning protection requirements of a PTP 810 installation, including the antenna. Ordering antennas on page 2-44 lists the antennas required for PTP 810 installations, with Cambium part numbers. Ordering RMKs and waveguides on page 2-70 lists the RMKs, waveguides, hangers and transitions required for PTP 810 installations, with Cambium part numbers. Ordering coupler mounting kits on page 2-73 lists the couplers required for PTP 810 installations, with Cambium part numbers. Ordering OMKs on page 2-75 lists the OMKs required for PTP 810 installations, with Cambium part numbers. Equipment specifications on page 4-2 contains specifications of the flexible waveguides and couplers. Installing antennas and ODUs on page 5-5 describes how to install the antennas, ODUs and waveguide connections at each link end, either in a direct mount or remote mount configuration, with or without couplers. Task 14: Aligning antennas on page 6-98 describes how to align the two antennas in a link.

1-30

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Cabling and lightning protection

Cabling and lightning protection


This section describes the cabling and lightning protection components of a PTP 810 installation.

Lightning protection
The PTP 810 has been tested for compliance to the EMC immunity specifications identified in European Union compliance on page 4-80. The ODUs are fitted with surge limiting circuits and other features to minimize the risk of damage due to nearby lightning strikes. To be fully effective, these standard features require some additional equipment to be configured as part of the system installation.

The PTP 810 Series is not designed to survive direct lightning strikes. For this reason the antenna and ODU should not be installed at the highest point in a localized area. See Grounding and lightning protection on page 2-7.

ODU to MMU connections


The ODU is connected to the LPUs and MMU using CNT-400 coaxial cable (IF cable).

MMU to network connections


The MMU is connected to network equipment using either a copper data port (100baseT or 1000baseT Ethernet) or a fiber interface (1000BaseSX or 1000BaseLX).

Cable grounding
The ODU, LPUs and IF cable must be grounded to the supporting structure at the points specified in Grounding and lightning protection on page 2-7. One cable grounding kit for 1/4" and 3/8" cable (Figure 26) is required at each grounding point.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-31

Cabling and lightning protection

Chapter 1: Product description

Figure 26 Cable grounding kit (Cambium part number 01010419001)

Lightning protection units (LPUs)


The LPU end kit (Figure 27) is required for IF cables. One LPU is installed next to the ODU and the other is installed near the building entry point. Figure 27 LPU end kit (Cambium part number WB3657)

1-32

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Cabling and lightning protection

Further reading on cabling and lightning protection


For more information on cabling and lightning protection, refer to the following: Maximum IF cable length on page 2-3 gives the maximum permitted lengths of IF cables in PTP 810 installations. Grounding and lightning protection on page 2-7 describes the grounding and lightning protection requirements of a PTP 810 installation. Ordering IF cable, grounding and LPUs on page 2-65 lists the cables, connectors, grounding kits and LPUs required for PTP 810 installations. Installing the IF and ground cables on page 5-38 describes how to install the IF cables and how to install grounding and lightning protection.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-33

Wireless operation

Chapter 1: Product description

Wireless operation
This section gives an overview of the key wireless features supported by PTP 810, including channel separation, bandwidth, modulation modes and transmit power control.

Channel separation
The PTP 810 wireless link supports the following channel separations: 7 MHz 10 MHz 13.75 MHz 14 MHz 20 MHz 27.5 MHz 28 MHz 29.65 MHz 30 MHz 40 MHz 50 MHz 55 MHz 56 MHz 80 MHz.

The available selection of channel separations varies depending on capacity key, band and region.

Channel bandwidth
The PTP 810 wireless link supports the following channel bandwidths:
1-34

7 MHz 10 MHz 14 MHz 20 MHz 28 MHz 30 MHz


phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless operation

40 MHz 50 MHz 56 MHz

The available selection of channel bandwidths varies depending on capacity key, band and region.

Modulation modes
The PTP 810 wireless link operates using single carrier modulation with the following fixed modulation modes: QPSK 16QAM 32QAM 64QAM 128QAM 256QAM

The available selection of modulation modes varies depending on capacity key, band, region and channel bandwidth. PTP 810 provides forward error correction (FEC) coding for data transmitted over the wirless link. The error correction coding consists of an inner convolutional code concatenated with an outer Reed-Solomon code. The overall FEC code rate in PTP 810 varies between 0.81 and 0.89 depending on channel bandwidth and modulation mode. For more information, see Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29.

Adaptive power control


PTP 810 provides closed-loop adaptive power control (APC). APC ensures that transmitters will operate at the minimum level needed for error-free operation of the link. It achieves this by modifying the transmit power in order to maintain a bit error rate (before error correction) between a lower and upper threshold as measured at the remote end of the link. Adaptive operation of the transmitter power can be enabled or disabled using the Adaptive Power Control attribute on the APC Configuration page of the web-based interface. This attribute must have the same setting at both ends of the link. In some regions, automatic transmitter power control is a regulatory requirement; in these cases, APC must not be disabled.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-35

Wireless operation

Chapter 1: Product description

APC is not available in the 2+0 XPIC link type.

Maximum receive power


The maximum receive power is the maximum power at which a PTP 810 link should be operated to maintain error free communication. This maximum receive power for normal operation is -35 dBm. On very short links it may be necessary to use a fixed waveguide attenuator, which will require the use of a remote mount antenna, to keep the maximum receive power at an acceptable level.

Maximum transmit power


Maximum transmit power is the maximum power that the PTP 810 is permitted to generate at the waveguide interface assuming that APC is disabled. The equipment limit for maximum transmit power is defined by modulation mode, band, channel bandwidth and standards body or region. The spectrum license limit is determined by the maximum EIRP permitted by the individual license, the antenna gain and feeder loss. The maximum transmit power that can be configured for PTP 810 is limited by the more restrictive of the equipment limit and the spectrum license limit.

XPIC
PTP 810 systems support XPIC functionality in 64, 128 and 256 QAM modulation modes at 28 MHz or above channel bandwidths. XPIC allows the doubling of throughput without increasing channel bandwidth. To accomplish this, different data is transmitted simultaneously on the horizontal and vertical polarizations in the same channel. For an XPIC link, the PTP 810 MMU must be configured as a dual modem. One XPIC cable is required to inter-connect the two modem modules of each MMU. To enable XPIC, an XPIC license key needs to be purchased. Two XPIC license keys are required per XPIC link; one key per MMU. The serial numbers of the MMU chassis and of each of the modem modules are needed to purchase an XPIC license. These serial numbers are found on either the packing sheet or the GUI using the Serial Number Information command (see Viewing device information on page 7-57.

1-36

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless operation

Further reading on wireless operation


For more information on wireless operation, refer to the following: Link planning on page 2-2 describes factors to be taken into account when planning links, and introduces PTP LINKPlanner. Wireless specifications on page 4-23 contains specifications of the PTP 810 wireless interface, such as RF bands, channel width, spectrum settings, maximum power and sensitivity. Electromagnetic compliance on page 4-79 describes how the PTP 810 complies with the radio regulations that are in force in various countries. Task 3: Configuring wireless interface on page 6-24 describes how to configure the wireless interface using the installation wizard. Monitoring link performance on page 6-105 describes how to check that a newly installed link is achieving predicted levels of performance. Disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU on page 7-21 describes how to control wireless transmission by disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU. Managing performance on page 7-31 describes how to manage the performance of a PTP 810 link.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-37

Ethernet bridging in the customer network

Chapter 1: Product description

Ethernet bridging in the customer network


This section describes how the PTP 810 bridges Ethernet data in the customer data network.

Transparent Ethernet service


The PTP 810 system provides a transparent bridging Ethernet service between data ports at a local MMU and data ports at an associated remote MMU. The Ethernet service is based on conventional layer two transparent bridging, similar to the operation of conventional wired Ethernet bridges or switches. Ethernet bridging in PTP 810 is transparent to all frame types, including MPLS frames, except for specific Layer 2 Control Protocol frames listed below.

Layer two control protocols


The PTP 810 system is transparent to the following layer two control protocols (L2CPs): Link OAM, IEEE 802.3ah Port authentication, IEEE 802.1X Ethernet local management interface (E-LMI), ITU-T Q.933. Link layer discovery protocol (LLDP) Multiple registration protocol (MRP) Generic attribute registration protocol (GARP)

The PTP 810 system processes the following L2CPs: Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RSTP) Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol (MSTP) Pause frames Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP)

Maximum frame size


The maximum frame size for bridged frames in the customer network is as follows: Standard Master I/O: 2048 octets. GigE Master I/O: 4000 octets (S software version) or 9728 octets (J software version).

1-38

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ethernet bridging in the customer network

Internal Ethernet switch


The PTP 810 MMU contains an internal Ethernet switch. Switch ports consist of front panel copper Ethernet ports, a front panel SFP port for copper or fiber connections, and internal ports connecting the switch to one or two wireless modems. The internal switch in the Standard Master I/O module is shown in Figure 28, and the internal switch in the GigE Master I/O module is shown in Figure 29. The internal Ethernet switch in the Standard Master I/O module is limited to 100 Mbps per port. This means that the combined Ethernet traffic to and from the two front panel ports to a given modem (that is, the East Modem or West Modem) is limited to 100 Mbps. Likewise, Ethernet traffic that is relayed between the East and West modems is also routed via the Ethernet switch and is therefore limited to 100 Mbps. The internal Ethernet switch in the GigE Master I/O module has a limit of 1000 Mbps per port which does not place any restrictions on the Ethernet traffic data rate in practice. Figure 28 Internal Ethernet switch for the Standard Master I/O module

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-39

Ethernet bridging in the customer network

Chapter 1: Product description

Figure 29 Internal Ethernet switch for the GigE Master I/O module

The internal Ethernet switch provides standard forwarding of Ethernet frames, including flooding of multicast or broadcast frames, learning the location of end stations from the source address of ingress frames, and filtering of unicast frames with known destination address. The filter database (FDB) has capacity for up to 1024 learned MAC addresses.

On an East link failure, all E1/T1 circuits on the East, if any, will transfer to the West link, consuming the amount of Ethernet throughput equivalent to the number of E1/T1s transferred. Conversely, if the East link has no E1/T1 circuits configured and E1/T1 circuits are carried by the West link, on a East link failure the West link E1/T1 circuits will be lost and replaced by Ethernet capacity.

Spanning tree operation


The internal Ethernet switch in the PTP 810 MMU supports Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RSTP) and Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol (MSTP). These protocols detect loops in bridged Ethernet networks, and block ports as needed to provide connectivity equivalent to a simply-connected spanning tree. The MMU allows port priority to be configured for individual switch ports, so that the default spanning tree can be optimized for carrying likely traffic patterns.

RSTP
The RSTP implementation in the MMU complies with IEEE 802.1D-2004 Clauses 9 and 17 and interoperates with standard RSTP and STP instances in other network equipment. If a wireless link fails in a network containing loops, RSTP will re-enable blocked ports to restore connectivity with the remaining units.

1-40

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ethernet bridging in the customer network

The RSTP Hello time is configurable between 1 and 10 seconds. RSTP typically restores an outage in 3 Hello times. However, the actual restoration time depends on network configuration and cannot be guaranteed. An additional Fast Hello configuration (600 ms to 900 ms) is supported in the MMU for applications where the network consists of only MMUs. The Fast Hello operation reduces the time taken for the network to converge the spanning tree, but is not compatible with other network equipment.

MSTP
The MSTP implementation in the MMU complies with IEEE 802.1s and is backward compatible with RSTP and STP. MSTP configures a separate spanning tree for each VLAN group, referred to as a Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI), and blocks all but one of the possible alternate paths within each spanning tree. MSTP allows the formation of MSTI regions. A MSTI region is a collection of switches that share the same MSTP configuration name and revision attributes. Bridges must share the same VLAN-to-MSTI mapping configuration as well as the same configuration name and revision attributes in order to share spanning trees for intra-region MSTIs. The MSTP protocol uses a variable known as Maximum Hops as a time to live counter instead of the Maximum Age timer used by RSTP. The Maximum Age timers are still used when MSTP interacts with RSTP bridges. If a wireless link fails in a network containing loops, MSTP will re-enable blocked ports to restore connectivity with the remaining units.

Pause frame operation


PTP 810 allows the customer traffic and management Ethernet ports to be individually configured to operate with Ethernet flow control using standard IEEE 802.3 Pause frames. In the GigE Master I/O module, the customer data ports can additionally be configured to generate Pause frames but not to respond to them, or to respond to Pause frames but not to generate them. Pause frames are transmitted at all ports configured for Pause frame operation when the buffer of the internal switch becomes nearly full.

Ethernet link aggregation


The GigE Master I/O module supports aggregation of Ethernet links at the front panel ports using the standard Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) specified in IEEE 802.1ax.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-41

Ethernet bridging in the customer network

Chapter 1: Product description

Transparent wireless link aggregation (GigE Master I/O module)


The GigE Master I/O module can be configured to provide transparent wireless link aggregation in 2+0 co-polar, 2+0 cross-polar and 2+0 XPIC link types. Transparent wireless link aggregation automatically distributes Ethernet frames between the two links (regardless of the content of Ethernet or IP header fields) to ensure that the wireless links are evenly loaded, with the result that the aggregated link has exactly the combined capacity of the individual wireless links.

VLAN bridging of Ethernet Traffic


The MMU provides Ethernet Virtual Local Area Network (VLAN) configuration. The MMU supports Port based VLAN and Static Tag based VLAN. Static Tag based VLAN supports Single Tag mode, Double Tag (S tag + C tag) mode and Double Tag (C tag + C tag) mode. Users can enable only one type of VLAN at a time. It can be either Port based VLAN or Static Tag based VLAN. Port Based VLAN: In Port Based VLAN, users are able to configure which ports are connected to each other. Frame Forwarding is allowed only among the ports that are part of the same VLAN. Static Tag Based VLAN: The MMU supports up to 64 VLANs. Each VLAN is identified by its distinct VLAN ID (between VLAN ID 1 to 4094). Users can Add/Edit/Delete VLANs and ports that belong to each VLAN. Two modes are available: o Single Tag Mode: Single Tag mode is as specified in IEEE802.1Q. Users configure which ports are part of a VLAN and the Ingress/Egress Policy of the ports. Frame Forwarding is allowed only among the ports that are part of the same VLAN and the forwarding is done based on the VLAN tag. Double Tag Mode: Double Tag (S tag + C tag) mode and Double Tag (C tag + C tag) mode is as specified in IEEE802.1ad. Users configure which port is part of a VLAN and whether the port is a Network port or User port. Frame Forwarding is allowed only among the ports that are part of the same VLAN and the forwarding is done based on the outer VLAN tag.

VLAN bridging single-tagged mode


The PTP 810 MMU supports standard IEEE 802.1Q-2004 VLAN bridging operation in the internal Ethernet switch for single-tagged or customer VLAN operation including: Creation and deletion of VLANs. Addition and removal of ports from the member list of VLANs. Filtering of ingress and egress frames at each port based on matching the VID of the frame with the VLAN member lists. Application of the ingress policy for each of the front panel ports: o
1-42

Admit All Frames: Admits tagged and untagged frames.


phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ethernet bridging in the customer network

Admit Tag Only: Admits only tagged frames.

Insertion of a VLAN tag in untagged ingress frames, using the default VID for each port (assuming that the port is configured to admit untagged frames). Setting of a default priority for each port in untagged ingress frames (assuming that the port is configured to admit untagged frames). Application of the egress policy for each of the front panel ports: o o Remove: Removes the VLAN tag from egress frames before transmission. Dont Remove: Retains the VLAN tag in transmitted frames.

The internal modem ports have fixed policies equivalent to Admit All Frames and Dont Remove. This means that all frames passing across the wireless link (between two MMUs) are tagged. The internal modem ports must be present in the appropriate VLAN member lists to allow VLAN frames to be forwarded between MMUs.

VLAN bridging double-tagged modes


In addition to the standard customer VLAN capabilities, the internal Ethernet switch can also be configured as a VLAN bridge for double-tagged frames with the following VLAN bridging modes: Double tagged (S-Tag plus C-Tag) Double tagged (C-Tag plus C-Tag)

The tag protocol ID (TPID) is 0x8100 for C-Tags and 0x88a8 for S-Tags. Double tagged frames with two C-Tags are described as Q-in-Q. In the double-tagged VLAN modes, individual front panel ports can be configured in the following Port Double Tag Modes: Network Port User Port

The User Port setting will normally be used where an MMU front panel port forms the User-Network Interface (UNI) between a service provider and a customer. The Network Port setting will normally be used within a provider-bridged network. When the VLAN Management is Double Tag the egress policy is not configured via a dedicated parameter but it is automatically determined on the base of the Port Double Tag Mode configuration. If the port has been configured as "Network" its egress policy is automatically configured to "Don't Remove". If the port has been configured as "User" its egress policy is automatically configured as "Remove". Table 3 describes how VLAN tags are inserted in ingress frames in double-tagged VLAN operation.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-43

Ethernet bridging in the customer network

Chapter 1: Product description

Table 3 Insertion of tags in ingress frames in double tagged mode VLAN Management Mode Double Tag (S-Tag and C-Tag) Frame Type Port Double Tag Mode Network User Ingress Action

Untagged Single Tagged Double Tagged (S-tag and C-Tag) Double Tagged (C-Tag and C-Tag)

Single S-Tag added Outer S-Tag added Unmodified Outer S-Tag added An additional S-Tag is ALWAYS added because the frame is not recognized as an S-Tag + C-Tag frame, regardless of the ingress port double tag mode type. Single C-Tag added Outer C-Tag added An additional C-Tag is ALWAYS added because the frame is not recognized as a C-Tag + C-Tag frame, regardless the ingress port double tag mode type. Unmodified Outer C-Tag added

Double Tag (Ctag + Ctag)

Untagged Single Tagged Double Tagged (S-tag and C-Tag) Double Tagged (C-Tag and C-Tag)

Network User

The most likely network deployment of the doubled-tagged mode is based on Ethernet frames with a single C-Tag forwarded by the MMU between the provider network and the users network at the UNI, and double-tagged frames with S-Tag and C-Tag forwarded by the MMU internal to the provider bridged network. Internal modem ports always operate in the Network Port mode, with fixed policies equivalent to Admit All Frames and Dont Remove. All frames will be tagged at the internal modem ports, and additional tags are never added.

Port-based forwarding
Port-based forwarding provides a means to configure forwarding between individual front panel Ethernet ports and individual wireless modems and offers a means to create virtual networks without using VLAN bridging. For example, in a 2+0 co-polar, 2+0 cross-polar or 2+0 XPIC link type, port-based forwarding could be used to create two separate networks, one using the East wireless link and one using the West wireless link.
1-44

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ethernet bridging in the customer network

Port-based forwarding is not compatible with wireless link aggregation.

Quality of service for bridged Ethernet traffic


The PTP 810 system provides four queues for Ethernet frames waiting for transmission over the wireless interface. Ethernet frames may be classified into these queues based on either (a) the associated ingress port, or (b) the Ethernet priority or IP Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) within the frame.

Port priority cannot be used at the same time as Ethernet and DSCP priority.

QoS in the Standard Master I/O module


The Standard Master I/O module can be configured to use strict priority scheduling or weighted fair queueing scheduling. Port priorties, and Ethernet or DSCP priorties are mapped directly to one of the four transmission queues.

QoS in the GigE Master I/O module


The GigE Master I/O module uses weighted fair queueing scheduling, with an option to select strict priority for the highest priority transmission queue. Port priorties, and Ethernet or DSCP priorties are mapped first to one of eight switch priorities, and switch priorities are each mapped to one of the four transmission queues.

Wireless link down alert


The PTP 810 system can be configured to alert a loss of link to the connected network equipment. It does this by means of a brief disconnection of selected Ethernet ports. The alert is triggered by any condition which prevents the link from forwarding traffic in one or both link directions. Examples include a deep wireless fade, or equipment failure such as an ODU failure. The wireless link down alert can be deployed in networks which use external network equipment to provide alternative traffic routes in the event of failure. Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) and industry standard ring protocols are commonly deployed in such complex networks and will react to the wireless link down alert.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-45

Ethernet bridging in the customer network

Chapter 1: Product description

The Wireless link down alert cannot be used for customer data when RSTP is enabled for the customer data network in the MMU.

Further reading on Ethernet bridging


For more information on Ethernet bridging, refer to the following: Data network planning on page 2-16 describes factors to be considered when planning PTP 810 data networks. Data network specifications on page 4-73 contains specifications of the PTP 810 Ethernet interfaces. Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces on page 6-14 describes how to configure the IP and Ethernet attributes of the PTP 810.

1-46

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ethernet bridging in the management network

Ethernet bridging in the management network


This section describes how the PTP 810 bridges Ethernet data in the management network.

Embedded management agent


The PTP 810 MMU contains an embedded network management agent used to configure and monitor the communications capabilities of the MMU. The network management agent connects to management systems and workstations using two different interfaces: A point-to-point RS-232 serial data link. A network management IP interface over a standard Ethernet link layer.

The serial data link is available at the Serial/Alarm connector on the MMU Control Module. Ethernet connections to the management agent are at the NMS 1 and NMS 2 Ethernet ports on the MMU Control Module. The management agent can additionally be reached using Ethernet traffic over the wireless link, from the front panel NMS ports at the remote end of the wireless link. The default IP address of the management agent is 192.168.0.1. The IP address can be configured using the serial interface even if the existing IP address is unknown.

Serial interface
The network management serial interface has the following characteristics: Data rate: 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200 kbit/s Data bits: 8 Parity: None Stop bits: 1 Flow control: None

Ethernet interface
The PTP 810 MMU contains an internal Ethernet switch used to connect together the management agent with the NMS front panel ports, and with network management channels multiplexed with customer data over one or two wireless links. The overall arrangement of the management Ethernet switch is shown in Figure 30.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-47

Ethernet bridging in the management network

Chapter 1: Product description

Figure 30 Internal Ethernet switch for the management network Serial Port

Management Agent

West Modem NMS Port 1 100BASE-TX NMS Port 2 100BASE-TX East Modem Ethernet Switch

The internal Ethernet switch provides standard forwarding of Ethernet frames, including flooding of multicast or broadcast frames, learning the location of end stations from the source address of ingress frames, and filtering of unicast frames with known destination address. The filter database (FDB) has capacity for up to 1024 learned MAC addresses.

Network management
The network management mode bridges Ethernet frames between front panel Ethernet ports and Management Agents at both ends of a link. This connectivity allows communication from the MMU management ports to Ethernet end stations reached through the remote MMU, supporting construction of an extended management network that is isolated from the customer network. The MMU segregates customer and management traffic into separate channels both within the MMU and over the air.

1-48

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ethernet bridging in the management network

Spanning tree operation


The internal Ethernet switch in the PTP 810 management network supports Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RSTP). This protocol detects loops in bridged Ethernet networks, and blocks ports as needed to provide connectivity equivalent to a simply-connected spanning tree. The MMU allows port priority to be configured for individual switch ports, so that the default spanning tree can be optimized for carrying likely traffic patterns. If a wireless link fails in a network containing loops, RSTP will re-enable blocked ports to restore connectivity with the remaining units.

Network management quality of service


Network management traffic is forwarded over the wireless link using a dedicated channel with capacity of approximately 500 kbit/s. The management channel represents a single traffic class, and the same quality of service is afforded to all management frames.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-49

System management

Chapter 1: Product description

System management
This section introduces the PTP 810 management system, including the web interface, installation, configuration, alerts and upgrades.

Protocol interfaces
The management agent supports the following protocol interfaces for the serial connection: Text-based command line interface (CLI)

The management agent supports the following protocol interfaces over IP and Ethernet: Text-based CLI over Telnet Text-based CLI over Secure Shell (SSH) Web-based interface using Hyper text transfer protocol (HTTP) Simple network management protocol (SNMP), v1, v2c, v3 Simple mail transfer protocol (SMTP) Simple network time protocol (SNTP) System logging (syslog)

Web server
The PTP 810 management agent contains a web server. The web server supports the HTTP interface. Web-based management offers a convenient way to manage the PTP 810 equipment from a locally connected computer or from a network management workstation connected through a management network, without requiring any special management software.

Command line interface


PTP 810 provides a convenient and intuitive text-based command line interface (CLI). The page structure, access rights and user accounts are shared between the web-based interface and the CLI. In general, the CLI provides the same capabilities as the web-based interface and is a viable alternative for applications where use of a web-browser would not be appropriate. The CLI may be encrypted using Secure Shell (SSH) using the MMU private key and device certificate. SSH supports DES and AES128 encryption.
1-50

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

System management

Identity-based user accounts


User accounts can be added and deleted for different access levels, including field configurable passwords. Refer to Managing user accounts and security on page 7-27. PTP 810 allows up to seven user accounts, with three accounts configured by default. Details of the default accounts are shown in Table 4. Table 4 Default user accounts User name administrator operator monitor Access level Administrator Operator Monitor Default password d1scovery col1ma monitor

The Administrator user may delete the Operator and Monitor accounts, and may create additional Operator and Monitor accounts up to a total of six accounts. The username of Administrator account cannot be changed.

Access rights for user accounts


The access rights for users of the web-based interface and text-based CLI are as shown in Table 5. Table 5 Web-based and CLI access rights Page Home General Device Information Configuration Summary Active Alarm Status Alarm History All Graphs Data Switch and NMS Switch Statistics Reboot All Radio Link and Data Link Configuration pages Alarm Threshold page BERT page All Network Configuration Monitor Read only Read only Read only Read only Read only Read only Read only Operator Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Administrator Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-51

System management

Chapter 1: Product description

Page Serial and Security configuration All Device Information pages All Maintenance and Restore Defaults pages Alarm Configuration page STP Screens Loopback page

Monitor -

Operator -

Administrator Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write

Link configuration wizard


The web-based interface includes a link configuration wizard. This feature simplifies the process of entering initial configuration details. The process handles the important configuration settings that must be set to comply with individual license conditions.

Alarms
The management agent can be configured to generate alerts as SNMP notifications or electronic mail messages when an alarm condition occurs. Alarm conditions are also reported as syslog messages. Active alarms are listed on the Active Alarms web page. An alarm history is provided on the Alarm History web page. A comprehensive list of the possible alarm conditions is provided in Alarms on page V.

Alarm configuration
The PTP 810 MMU allows each alarm condition to be masked. A masked alarm will not be generated or notified in the web-based interface, and will not generate SNMP notifications. Alarm configuration is available on the Alarm Configuration web page.

External alarms
PTP 810 provides four external alarm inputs and four external alarm outputs. Alarm conditions signalled at the external alarm inputs can be repeated as SNMP notifications. External alarm outputs can be individually configured to repeat one or more of the internal or external alarms using the Alarm Configuration web page

1-52

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

System management

Controller status indicator


The Status indicator on the Control Module is the primary front panel indicator of alarms. The Status indicator can operate in two ways: Solid on Flashing to indicate alarm code.

Alarms on page V provides a complete list of alarms and indicates in each case whether the alarm is solid or will flash a code. When an alarm with a code is active: (a) The Controller Status indicator turns orange for five seconds. (b) The Controller Status indicator turns off for five seconds. (c) The Controller Status indicator flashes orange the number of times specified by the first digit of the alarm code. (d) The Controller Status indicator turns off for three seconds. (e) The Controller Status indicator flashes orange the number of times specified by the second digit of the alarm code. Steps (b) to (e) are repeated for each active alarm. The entire process is repeated as long as the alarms are still posted.

SNMP
The MMU management agent supports fault, configuration and performance management by means of an SNMP interface. The management agent is compatible with SNMP v1, SNMP v2c and SNMPv3, using the following MIBs: PTP 810 enterprise MIB EtherLike-MIB (RFC3635) IF-MIB (RFC2863) IANAifType-MIB PerfHist-TC-MIB DS1-MIB (RFC3895) SONET-MIB (RFC3592)

The PTP 810 enterprise MIB is available for download in the application software package from the support web page (see Contacting Cambium Networks on page 2). Further details of the standard SNMP MIB objects supported by PTP 810 are provided in Standard SNMP MIBs on page 4-77. SNMP must be enabled for use by means of the SNMP Mode attribute in the web-based interface.
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
1-53

System management

Chapter 1: Product description

SNMPv3 security
PTP 810 supports SNMPv3 security for a single user with the following configuration: Username: admin Privacy protocol: DES Authentication protocol: MD5 Security model: AuthPriv

PTP 810 allows the privacy and authentication passphrases to be configured in the SNMP Configuration web page.

Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP)


An internal clock supplies accurate date and time information to the system. It can be set to run with or without a connection to a network time server (SNTP). It can be configured to display local time by setting the time zone in the Set Date and Time web page. If an SNTP server connection is available, the clock attempts to synchronize with the server time at regular intervals.

System logging (syslog)


PTP 810 supports the standard syslog protocol to log important configuration changes, status changes, events and alarms to a standard syslog server. The protocol complies with RFC 3164. The MMU sets a configurable syslog facility field (Local0 to Local7) in syslog messages. All alarm notifications sent by SNMP are repeated as syslog messages.

Flexible capacity upgrades


PTP 810 MMUs are shipped with a data throughput capacity of 10 Mbps and without XPIC capability. To increase capacity or to allow XPIC capability, license keys or license key upgrades must be purchased from Cambium. Capacity license keys are sold per PTP 810 MMU unit and are available in the following capacity increments (units of Mbps): 20, 30, 40, 50, 100, 150, 200, 300, 400, and 600. Each of these capacity values is mapped to the over-the-air maximum throughput capacity of the various modulation modes (channel size and modulation) in order to determine which modulation modes will be enabled for a given capacity license key. XPIC capability license keys are sold per PTP 810 MMU unit.

1-54

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

System management

The capacity license key directly controls the allowed modulation modes and channel bandwidths and therefore has an impact on link performance. For ordering details including Cambium part numbers, refer to Ordering capacity upgrades and XPIC capability on page 2-40.

Application software storage and upgrade


The MMU uses separate software images for the following components and modules: Controller kernel Controller application Controller FPGA Master I/O FPGA Modem East firmware Modem East FPGA Modem West firmware Modem West FPGA Expansion I/O FPGA ODU ODU boot loader

The MMU uses dual-bank storage for each of the software components. Software images are upgraded by installing a new image in the inactive bank and then toggling the active and inactive banks. In two cases, the alternative bank contains valid alternative software: The Modem FPGA code. The alternative bank contains the SW needed for XPIC. For example: Modem East FPGA: 4700_PIxx.xx.xx versus 4700_UMyy.yy.yy The GigE Master IO code. The alternative bank contains the "S" version. For example: CCM-4130: 4130_JGxx.xx.xx versus 4130_SGxx.xx.xx The MMU supports two software versions: J and S (Table 6). Table 6 MMU software versions Software version J S Maximum frame size 9728 bytes 4000 bytes SNCP-like protection supported? No Yes (used with 1+0 Ethernet rings)

Software is installed in the MMU using File Transfer Protocol (FTP).

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-55

System management

Chapter 1: Product description

Software may be upgraded as a complete package, in which case all the components are loaded into the inactive banks and all components are toggled to bring the new software into use.

Restore system defaults


Web interface
A PTP 810 MMU can be returned to a default configuration using the Restore System Defaults web page. The IP address and passwords are reset.

Power on reset to system defaults


The MMU may be reset to factory defaults during power up. A power-on reset affects the IP address and the usernames and passwords. The power-on reset provides a means to recover from serious configuration errors including lost or forgotten passwords and unknown IP addresses. For more information, refer to Power on reset to system defaults on page 7-54.

Further reading on system management


For more information on system management, refer to the following: Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment describes all configuration and alignment tasks that are performed when a PTP 810 link is deployed. Chapter 7: Operation provides instructions for operators of the PTP 810 web user interface.

1-56

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

TDM bridging

TDM bridging
This section describes PTP 810 capabilities for E1/T1 transmission over wireless links, and for switching of E1/T1 circuits within the MMU.

E1/T1 capacity
PTP 810 allows a user to configure a variable number of E1/T1 circuits over each wireless link, subject to: The capacity of the wireless link for combined Ethernet and E1/T1 data The number of E1/T1 circuits that can be handled by the Master I/O module. The number of front panel E1/T1 ports.

Capacity of the wireless link


The capacity of a PTP 810 wireless link for combined Ethernet and E1/T1 data depends on the channel bandwidth and modulation mode used. These characteristics of the wireless link set an upper limit on the number of E1/T1 circuits that can be configured. The tables in Maximum E1/T1 circuit capacity on page 4-27, or PTP LINKPlanner can be used to determine the number of E1/T1 circuits that can be carried over any given wireless link. In MMU configurations for dual 1+0 links, the maximum number of E1/T1 circuits for the MMU is the sum of the number of circuits accommodated by the individual links. MMU configurations for the 2+0 link types have double the link capacity of a single link, and therefore double the maximum number of E1/T1 circuits provided by an equivalent 1+0 link.

Master I/O module


The maximum number of E1/T1 circuits supported in a single link also depends on the Master I/O module with the following limits: Standard Master I/O Module: 126 circuits per link. GigE Master I/O Module: 63 circuits per link.

In many applications, the number of circuits that can be accommodated within the link capacity will be lower than these limits imposed by the Master I/O. Only links with wide channel bandwidth and high modulation mode will have sufficient link capacity to support more than 63 circuits. MMU configurations for 2+0 link types accommodate up to 63 or 126 E1/T1 circuits for each link.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-57

TDM bridging

Chapter 1: Product description

Front panel E1/T1 ports


PTP 810 has a maximum capacity for E1/T1 ports at the MMU front panel (Table 7). Table 7 E1/T1 port capacity Master I/O module Standard Standard GigE GigE Expansion module 16 E1/T1 16 E1/T1 Front panel E1/T1 ports 16 32 2 18

Remaining capacity for Ethernet data


The link capacity for Ethernet data is the remaining capacity after resources have been reserved for the configured E1/T1 circuits. The PTP LINKPlanner calculates the remaining capacity for Ethernet data for any supported combination of E1/T1 circuits, channel bandwidth and modulation mode.

E1/T1 clocking
PTP 810 preserves the service clock in bridged E1/T1 circuits. In other words, the E1/T1 transmit clock at the local MMU is set to the average frequency of the E1/T1 clock in the data stream received at the remote MMU. Each circuit is clocked separately, and there is no requirement for multiple E1/T1 circuits to share a common clock. The MMU does not provide facilities for internal or external clock sources. PTP 810 provides E1/T1 with very low added wander, consistent with the requirements of ITU-T G.823 and G.824.

1-58

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

TDM bridging

Identification and mapping of E1/T1 circuits and ports


The overall arrangement of E1/T1 switching in a TDM switch is shown in Figure 31.

Any Channel can be mapped to any other channel within the TDM switch. This includes MA to MA or EX. Loopback is even possible. Figure 31 Switching of E1/T1 circuits in 1+0 and 1+1 links

E1/T1 switching in 1+0 and 1+1 link types


E1/T1 TDM switching in the MMU allows any front panel E1/T1 port to be mapped to any E1/T1 circuit over the wireless link. This means that a PTP 810 link can map any front panel port at the near end of a link to any front panel port at the remote end of the link.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-59

TDM bridging

Chapter 1: Product description

In 1+0 links the East modem is always used. All mappings must be done from the Master IO and Expansion modules to the East modem. In 1+1 links the West modem is automatically used as the standby modem. No mapping should be performed to the West modem.

When performing the mapping, the MMU silently ignores invalid mapping configurations.

Dual 1+0 links


E1/T1 TDM switching in the MMU supports a relay operation where E1/T1 circuits can be connected between the East and West modems within the MMU. E1/T1 circuits carried by the East or West modem can alternatively be terminated at a front panel port similar to the arrangement in the 1+0 link type. For example, E1/T1 switching for the dual 1+0 configuration (Figure 31) consists of: Termination: "E3, MA1", "W3, MA3" and so forth. Relay/Passthrough: "E1, W1", "E2, W2" and so forth. Ring: (using SNCP-like): see SNCP-like protection on page 1-60.

E1/T1 mapping for circuits relayed within the MMU is recorded as shown in the following example: E1, W1 E2, W2 E1/T1 mapping for circuits switched to the MMU front panel is recorded as follows: E3, MA1 E4, MA2 W3, MA3 W4, MA4

SNCP-like protection
The Standard Master I/O module and the GigE module with S software support circuitbased E1/T1 protection, whereby a circuit from the East modem and a circuit from the West modem can be mapped to the same front panel port. This protection is similar in concept to Sub-Network Connection Protection (SNCP) commonly used in SDH networks.

1-60

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

TDM bridging

The Master I/O module duplicates E1/T1 data from a single front panel port and transmits identical data on two circuits carried by different modems. The Master I/O module monitors E1/T1 data received from two circuits carried by two different modems, and selects data from one of the circuits, based on the AIS state of the two circuits. Protection switching normally occurs within 50 ms of detection of a fault. E1/T1 mapping for circuits with SNCP-like protection is recorded as shown in the following example: E1:W1, MA1 E2:W6, EX3 In the protection couplet, the first circuit is the primary or working circuit, and the second is the secondary or protection circuit. SNCP-like protection is used with dual 1+0 links, and can be used to create redundant routes in networks with a ring or mesh topology.

E1/T1 switching in 2+0 co-polar, 2+0 cross-polar and 2+0 XPIC link types
In the 2+0 co-polar, cross-polar and XPIC link types, the MMU allows E1/T1 front panel ports to be mapped to either of the wireless links.

Protection switching in 2+0 co-polar, cross-polar and XPIC


E1/T1 circuits carried by the East modem have preference if one link fails in a 2+0 co-polar, 2+0 cross polar or 2+0 XPIC configuration. If the link supported by the East modem fails, the E1/T1 circuits mapped in the East modem are transferred to the West modem, and any circuits mapped to the West modem (there may be none) are dropped.

This applies even in cases where no E1/T1 circuits are configured for a given East/West link. If the West link has no E1/T1 circuits configured, on an East link failure all E1/T1 circuits will transfer to the West link, consuming the amount of Ethernet throughput equivalent to the number of E1/T1s transferred. Conversely, if the East link has no E1/T1 circuits configured and E1/T1 circuits are carried by the West link, on an East link failure the West link E1/T1 circuits will be lost and replaced by Ethernet capacity.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

1-61

TDM bridging

Chapter 1: Product description

Loopback
The MMU provides system loopback points as a means for testing TDM interface points, bridging connectivity and link performance. Loopback points are available at the local interface unit, local modem and remote interface unit. Loopback points and the duration of the loopback test are selected through the MMU GUI. PTP 810 supports three types of loopback test for troubleshooting purposes (Figure 32). For more information, see Performing a loopback test on page 8-15. Figure 32 Supported loopback tests

Further reading on TDM bridging


For more information on TDM bridging, refer to the following: Installing an E1/T1 interface on page 5-83 describes how to install network connections for E1/T1 interfaces. Trouble bridging E1/T1 traffic on page 8-15 describes how to investigate problems experienced with E1/T1 channels in a newly installed (or operational) link.

1-62

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Chapter 2: Planning considerations


This chapter provides the product information needed to plan a PTP 810 link, and highlights decisions that need to be made as part of the planning process. The following topics are described in this chapter: Link planning on page 2-2 describes factors to be taken into account when planning PTP 810 links, such as site selection and cable length, and it introduces the PTP LINKPlanner. Grounding and lightning protection on page 2-7 describes the grounding and lightning protection requirements of PTP 810 installations. Data network planning on page 2-16 describes factors to be considered when planning PTP 810 data networks. TDM network planning on page 2-19 describes factors to be considered when planning PTP 810 TDM networks. Planning 1+0 links on page 2-22 describes how to plan 1+0 links. Planning 1+1 links on page 2-25 describes how to plan 1+1 Hot Standby and 1+1 Hot Standby Spatial Diversity links. Planning 2+0 links on page 2-31 describes how to plan 2+0 Co-polar, Cross-polar and XPIC links. Planning Dual 1+0 links on page 2-37 describes how to plan Dual 1+0 links. Ordering components on page 2-39 describes how to select components for a planned PTP 810 link (as an alternative to PTP LINKPlanner). It specifies Cambium part numbers for PTP 810 components.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-1

Link planning

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Link planning
This section describes factors to be taken into account when planning PTP 810 links, such as site selection and cable length, and it introduces the PTP LINKPlanner.

Process
The majority of the 6 to 38 GHz spectrum is licensed on a link by link basis. Adapt the planning process to suit the licensing regime that is in force in the country of operation. To plan the link, follow this high-level process: 1 2 3 Identify suitable sites at the ends of the link. Determine the data capacity, E1/T1 capacity and wireless link availability required for the link. Select an RF band, taking into account the range of link, the capacity required, the wireless link availability required, the licensing policy for bands in the region or country, and ease (or otherwise) of obtaining individual licenses in that band. Use the PTP LINKPlanner to check that a satisfactory, unobstructed, line-of-sight path is possible between the ends. For links over water, use the reflection analysis feature of LINKPlanner to determine whether spatial diversity is needed to counter multipath reflections. Select the link type for the link: a. Regulators may mandate, or at least recommend, spatial diversity for certain lengths of link, or for links in certain regions. b. Spatial diversity may be needed to achieve the required wireless link availability in LINKPlanner. Only 1+1 HSB SD is supported (no 1+0 SD). c. Select antenna sizes to achieve capacity and availability requirements. d. Consider using 1+1 HSB or 2+0 links in critical applications where the hardware availability of a single 1+0 link would be insufficient. e. Consider using 2+0 links where the capacity of a wideband 1+0 link is insufficient. Consider 2+0 XPIC links where regulators are reluctant to grant licenses for two channels on different frequencies. 7 8 9 Apply for an individual license, or individual licenses as required. Use the PTP LINKPlanner with the license details to identify a Bill of Materials for the link. Order equipment from Cambium.

4 5 6

2-2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Link planning

Cambium offers a license coordination service for links in the USA. The service includes link study, PCN, FCC application filling, Schedule-K completion and one year license protection warranty. The FCC Microwave license coordination service may be ordered as Cambium part number WB3659.

Site selection
To provide a clear line-of-sight path for the link, mount the antennas where they are elevated above their immediate surroundings and above obstructions. Use LINKPLanner to determine suitable antenna heights to clear the terrain. Conduct a site survey to ensure that there are no other obstacles.

Wind loading
Select a site where the wind load will not be too high. Maximum permitted wind load depends upon antenna diameter: the greater the diameter, the lower the maximum permitted wind load. For example, a 1.8 m (6 ft) antenna used in the 6 GHz band has maximum permitted wind loads of: Operational wind velocity: 110 km/h (68 mph) Peak survival wind velocity: 200 km/h (124 mph)

Maximum IF cable length


Select a site where the IF cable will not be too long. The maximum permitted IF cable length is 190 meters (620 ft) with CNT-400 or equivalent cable.

For deployments that require a cable length greater than 190 meters (620 ft), contact customer support (see Contacting Cambium Networks on page 2).

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-3

Link planning

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

PTP LINKPlanner
Use the Cambium PTP LINKPlanner to design PTP 810 links. This is a link planning and optimization tool designed for use with all PTP products. PTP LINKPlanner is free and available from the support web page (see Contacting Cambium Networks on page 2). The advantages of PTP LINKPlanner are as follows: It is supported on Windows and Macintosh Platforms. It is very easy to use without specialist radio planning knowledge. It is powerful, implementing applicable ITU recommendations for predicting the performance of a radio link. It expresses the performance in terms of data link capacity. It is integrated with Google Earth to facilitate site entry and path visualization. It provides bill of materials data for ease of purchasing. It can provide path data by an automated email service. It can model the PTP 250, PTP 400, PTP 500, PTP 600, PTP 800 and PTP 810 products. It can plan multiple links in the same session. It can generate an export file for Cambium's FCC Coordination service.

The PTP LINKPlanner provides path profile information for individual links as shown in Figure 33.

2-4

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Link planning

Figure 33 LINKPlanner profile view

The PTP LINKPlanner also provides configuration and performance details as shown in Figure 34, and Bill of Materials data as shown in Figure 35. This is necessarily a brief introduction to the PTP LINKPlanner. Please download and evaluate this free software in further detail.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-5

Link planning

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Figure 34 LINKPlanner configuration and performance details

Figure 35 LINKPlanner Bill of Materials view

2-6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Grounding and lightning protection

Grounding and lightning protection


Ensure that the link meets the grounding and lightning protection requirements described in this section.

Electro-magnetic discharge (lightning) damage is not covered under warranty. The recommendations in this guide, when followed correctly, give the user the best protection from the harmful effects of EMD. However 100% protection is neither implied nor possible.

The need for power surge protection


Ensure that the planned PTP 810 installation protects structures, equipment and people against power surges (typically caused by lightning) by conducting the surge current to ground via a separate preferential solid path. The actual degree of protection required depends on local conditions and applicable local regulations. Cambium recommends that PTP 810 installation is contracted to a professional installer.

Standards
To gain a full understanding of lightning protection methods and requirements, refer to the international standards IEC 61024-1 and IEC 61312-1, the U.S. National Electric Code ANSI/NFPA No. 70-1984, or section 54 of the Canadian Electric Code.

International and national standards take precedence over the requirements in this guide.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-7

Grounding and lightning protection

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Lightning Protection Zones


Use the rolling sphere method (Figure 36) to determine where it is safe to mount equipment. An imaginary sphere, typically 50 meters in radius, is rolled over the structure. Where the sphere rests against the ground and a strike termination device (such as a finial or ground bar), consider the space under the sphere to be in the zone of protection (Zone B). Where the sphere rests on two finials, consider the space under the sphere to be in the zone of protection. Figure 36 Rolling sphere method to determine the lightning protection zones

Assess locations on masts, towers and buildings to determine if the location is in Zone A or Zone B: Zone A: In this zone a direct lightning strike is possible. Do not mount equipment in this zone. Zone B: In this zone, direct EMD (lightning) effects are still possible, but mounting in this zone significantly reduces the possibility of a direct strike. Mount equipment in this zone.

Never mount equipment in Zone A. Mounting in Zone A may put equipment, structures and life at risk.

2-8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Grounding and lightning protection

General protection requirements


Ensure that the PTP 810 installation meets the general protection requirements described in this section.

Basic requirements
Install the outdoor equipment, that is antenna and ODU, in Zone B (see Lightning Protection Zones on page 2-8). Ground the indoor devices, that is the MMU, at their chassis bonding points.

Grounding cable requirements


Use grounding cables that meet the following requirements: Grounding cables are no less than 16mm2 or #6AWG in size, with solid or stranded, tinned and/or jacketed copper conductors. Grounding conductor runs are as short, straight, and smooth as possible, with the fewest possible number of bends and curves. Grounding cables are not installed with drip loops. All bends have a minimum radius of 203 mm (8 in) and a minimum angle of 90. A diagonal run is preferable to a bend, even though it does not follow the contour or run parallel to the supporting structure. All bends, curves and connections are routed towards the grounding electrode system, ground rod, or ground bar. Grounding conductors are securely fastened. Braided grounding conductors are not used. Approved bonding techniques are employed when connecting dissimilar metals.

LPU and IF cable requirements


Use LPUs and IF cables that meet the following requirements: A lightning protection unit (LPU) (from the Cambium LPU kit, part number WB3657) is installed within 600 mm (24 in) of the point at which the IF cable enters the building or equipment room. The IF cable is bonded to the supporting structure in order to prevent lightning creating a potential between the structure and cable, which could cause arcing, resulting in damage to equipment. The IF cable is grounded at the building entry point.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-9

Grounding and lightning protection

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Specific requirements for the ODU


Ensure that all ODU installations meet the following requirements: The ODU and top LPU are as close together as possible. The IF cable length between the ODU and top LPU is less than 800 mm. The cable supplied in the accessory kit meets this requirement. The top LPU is mounted lower than the ODU. The ODU and top LPU are bonded together with the 800 mm long 16mm2, #6AWG cable supplied in the accessory kit. The LPU is bonded to the tower (or main grounding system) using the 600mm long 16mm2, #6AWG cable supplied in the accessory kit.

Protection requirements for a mast or tower installation


For equipment (ODU or antenna) mounted on a metal tower or mast, ensure that the installation meets the following requirements: The equipment is lower than the top of the tower or its lightning terminal and finial. The metal tower or mast is correctly grounded. A grounding kit is installed at the first point of contact between the IF cable and the tower, near the top. A grounding kit is installed at the bottom of the tower, near the vertical to horizontal transition point. This grounding kit is bonded to the tower or tower ground bus bar (TGB) if installed. If the tower is greater than 61 m (200 ft) in height, an additional grounding kit is installed at the tower midpoint. Additional ground kits are installed as necessary to reduce the distance between ground kits to 61 m (200 ft) or less. In high lightning prone geographical areas, additional ground kits are installed at intervals between 15 to 22 m (50 to 75 ft). This is especially important on towers taller than 45 m (150 ft).

2-10

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Grounding and lightning protection

Mast or tower protection diagrams


Figure 37 shows the protection requirements for an ODU mounted on a metal tower or mast. Figure 38 shows the protection requirements for a 1+1 or 2+0 protected end.

Figure 37 Grounding and lightning protection on mast or tower

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-11

Grounding and lightning protection

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Figure 38 Grounding and lightning protection on mast or tower (protected end)


Two ODUs and one antenna connected via coupler

IF cable Network cable

Lightning Protection Units (LPUs)

Ground cable Tower/building ground system

First point of contact with tower

Mid-point of tower Ground bus conductor Rack Ground Bar (RGB)

Bottom of tower

Master Ground Bar (MGB)

MMU Tower Ground Bar (TGB) External Ground Bar (EGB) Ground ring Lightning Protection Units (LPUs) To network

Equipment rack

Protection requirements for the ODU on a high rise building


If the antenna or ODU is mounted on a high rise building, with cable entry at roof level (Figure 39) and the equipment inside (Figure 40), then ensure that the installation meets the following requirements: The antenna and ODU are below the lightning terminals and finials. A grounding conductor is installed around the roof perimeter, to form the main roof perimeter lightning protection ring. Air terminals are installed along the length of the main roof perimeter lightning protection ring typically every 6.1m (20ft). The main roof perimeter lightning protection ring contains at least two down conductors connected to the grounding electrode system. The down conductors are physically separated from one another, as far as practical.

2-12

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Grounding and lightning protection

Figure 39 Grounding and lightning protection on building

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-13

Grounding and lightning protection

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Protection inside the building


Inside multi-story or high rise buildings (Figure 40), ensure that the installation meets the following requirements: The IF cable shield is bonded to the building grounding system at the entry point to the building. The IF cable shield is bonded to the building grounding system at the entry point to the equipment area. An LPU is installed within 600 mm (24 in) of the entry point to the equipment area.

Figure 40 Grounding and lightning protection inside high building

2-14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Grounding and lightning protection

In a 1+1 Hot Standby protected end, prior to connecting MMUs via the protection interface, connect the front panel ground stud of both MMUs to a common ground (Figure 41).

Figure 41 Grounding and lightning protection inside high building (protected end)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-15

Data network planning

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Data network planning


When planning PTP 810 data networks, consider the factors described in this section.

IP interface
Choose an IP address for the IP interface of the MMU management agent. The IP address must be unique and valid for the connected network segment. Find out the correct subnet mask and gateway IP address for this network segment. Ensure that the design of the data network permits bi-direction routing of IP datagrams between network management systems and the MMUs. For example, ensure that the gateway IP address identifies a router or other gateway that provides access to the rest of the data network.

Quality of service for bridged Ethernet traffic


Decide how quality of service will be configured in PTP 810 to minimize frame loss and latency for high priority traffic. Wireless links often have lower data capacity than wired links or network equipment like switches and routers, and quality of service configuration is most critical at network bottlenecks.

Classification rules
Select the classification rules based on Ethernet priority or IP priority to match QoS policy in the rest of the data network. Ethernet priority is also known as Layer 2 or link layer priority. IP priority is also known as Layer 3 or network layer priority. QoS is implemented using weighted or strict priority queues. Incoming packets are assigned to a weighted priority queue based on one or more of the following criteria: Port Based Priority: packets are assigned to a priority queue based upon the port the packet arrives on. 802.1Q VLAN Tag Priority: packets are assigned to a priority queue based upon the priority tag field in the VLAN tag. Diffserv: packets are assigned to a priority queue based upon the value of the DSCP field of the IPv4 header.

Port based priority cannot be used at the same time as the 802.1Q VLAN Tag and Diffserv priority on the Standard Master I/O Module card.

2-16

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Data network planning

The installed Master I/O module determines which QoS configuration capabilities are supported: PTP 810 MMU Standard Master I/O module: o o o o o Port Based Priority, 802.1Q VLAN Tag Priority and DiffServ Priority Four queues Weighted fair queuing scheme or Strict priority scheme Priority queues for weighted fair queuing scheme with fixed weights of 8, 4, 2 and 1 Priority Resolution Port Based Priority, 802.1Q VLAN Tag Priority and DiffServ Priority Four queues Weighted fair queuing scheme Priority queues have user-configurable weights High Queue Preempt Priority Resolution

PTP 810 MMU GigE Master I/O module o o o o o o

The two Master I/O modules available with the PTP 810 MMU support four priority queues (Figure 42). This capability applies to both Fast Ethernet and GigE Ethernet traffic. Figure 42 PTP 810 MMU Ethernet QoS Priority Queue
Port Priority Priority Queue 1 Priority Queue 2 Priority Queue 3 Priority Queue 4

802.1Q VLAN Tag Priority

Priority Resolution

DiffServ

Ethernet priority
Ethernet priority is encoded in a VLAN tag. Use the Ethernet priority if the network carries traffic in customer or service provider VLANs, and the priority in the VLAN tag has been set to indicate the priority of each type of traffic. Select a suitable mapping from the Ethernet priority to the four PTP 810 queues. An advantage of Ethernet priority is that any VLAN-tagged frame can be marked with a priority, regardless of the higher-layer protocols contained within the frame. A disadvantage of Ethernet priority is that the priority in the frame must be regenerated whenever traffic passes through a router.
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
2-17

Data network planning

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

IP/Diffserv priority scheme


Diffserv is the Layer 3 Differentiated Services feature that uses the 6-bit Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) field in the IP header IP priority is encoded in the DSCP field in an IPv4 or IPv6 header. The DSCP field provides 64 levels of priority. Determine the DSCP values used in the network and select a suitable mapping from these DSCP values to the four PTP 810 queues. An advantage of IP priority is that priority in the IP header is normally propagated transparently through a router. Also, the DSCP field supports a large number of distinct priority code points. A disadvantage of DSCP is that frames receive a single default classification if they contain a network layer protocol other than IPv4 or IPv6.

Fast Ethernet port shutdown


If the PTP 810 link is part of a redundant network where STP is used in external Ethernet bridges in order to resolve loops in the data path, enable the Shutdown On Link Failure attribute to ensure that protection protocols are invoked promptly following loss of the wireless link.

Shutdown on link failure cannot be enabled unless RSTP is disabled in the MMU.

2-18

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

TDM network planning

TDM network planning


When planning PTP 810 TDM networks, consider the factors described in this section.

E1/T1 termination points and pass-through


The E1/T1 termination points at each site in a TDM network must be carefully planned. A termination point refers to a full E1/T1 physically connected to the MMU. The set of E1/T1 termination points include the Master IO Module front panel E1/T1 ports as well as the Expansion Module ports. E1/T1s may also pass-through the MMU from East to West radio ports in Dual 1+0 configurations. The TDM switch capability is "any to any": E1/T1 ports configured over the East radio port can be connected to any E1/T1 port of the West radio port or to any E1/T1 port of the front panel. Moreover, an E1/T1 port of the front panel can be connected to any E1/T1 radio port or to another E1/T1 port of the front panel. The maximum number of E1/T1 termination points that are supported by a PTP 810 MMU is dependent not only on the selection of the Master I/O module and Expansion I/O module, but on the channel bandwidth, modulation mode and link type (1+0/1+1, 2+0, Dual 1+0). All these dependencies are covered in detail in TDM bridging on page 1-57). Planning the TDM network involves identifying the termination endpoints of each E1/T1 in the network and determining the primary and fallback (in the case of SNCP-like protected circuits) paths through the network. Once done, the number of E1/T1 circuits per link can be determined and planned based on the number of E1/T1 circuits that terminate or passthrough a given MMU.

Protection requirements
The architecture of a TDM network is also dependent on whether or not protection against link failure is required. For ribbon topologies that do not require protection, Dual 1+0 links can be deployed (see Dual 1+0 links on page 1-60). With Dual 1+0 links, a minimum of one PTP 810 MMU per site is required to pass E1/T1 circuits from one radio link to the other radio link in a ribbon topology without protection. The MMU at a given site can also be used to source and terminate E1/T1 circuits. For ribbon topologies that require protection, 1+1 Hot Standby or 1+1 Hot Standby Spatial Diversity links can be deployed (see Planning 1+1 links on page 2-25). 1+1 links require the use of both the East and West modems of a PTP 810 MMU. Therefore, at least two MMUs per site are required to pass E1/T1 circuits from one radio link to the other radio link in a ribbon topology with protection.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-19

TDM network planning

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

For ring topologies, SNCP-like protection can be used to create redundant routes using PTP 810 MMUs configured to support Dual 1+0 links (see SNCP-like protection on page 160). With SNCP-like protection, the TDM switch in the Master I/O module duplicates E1/T1 data from a single front panel port and transmits it on both the East and West modems. Duplicating each E1/T1 circuit sourced by a front panel port reduces the maximum number of E1/T1 circuits that can be supported versus a non-protected ring configuration. The Standard Master I/O Module supports SNCP-like protection. The GigE Master I/O module supports SNCP-like protection only when it is configured to use the 4130_SGxx.xx.xx firmware image (see Installing new software versions on page 7-63).

2+0 link failover preference


In 2+0 links, the E1/T1 circuits carried by the East modem have preference if the East modem link fails (see Protection switching in 2+0 co-polar, cross-polar and XPIC on page 1-61). If the link supported by the East modem fails, the E1/T1 circuits mapped in the East modem are transferred to the West modem and all the E1/T1 circuits mapped to the West modem are dropped. This is an important consideration in planning 2+0 links. The number of E1/T1 circuits in a 2+0 link that require protection from being dropped will directly impact the number of E1/T1s on the East radio port that the PTP 810 MMUs at each end of the link will need to support. This will also impact the modulation mode and capacity license that need to be used. It is possible to plan 2+0 links with E1/T1 circuits on just the East modem and use the West modem for Ethernet data. In this case, on East modem link failure, all E1/T1 circuits are transferred to the West modem, causing a loss of Ethernet throughput equivalent to the amount that the E1/T1 circuits use.

TDM and Ethernet traffic capacity tradeoffs


In network topologies that support both TDM and Ethernet traffic, there are other planning considerations. One consideration is that the choice of Master I/O module provides a tradeoff between TDM and Ethernet traffic capacity. The Standard Master I/O module has an Ethernet switch that limits maximum Ethernet throughput capacity to 98.7 Mbps with a 1518 byte frame size. As a tradeoff, the Standard Master I/O module supports more E1/T1 front panel ports as well as a higher capacity TDM switch than the GigE Master I/O module. The GigE Master I/O module has an Ethernet switch that limits the maximum Ethernet throughput capacity to 1000 Mbps, which is more than a 2+0 link can carry. This means that it is limited by the capacity of the modulation mode being used. It also supports link aggregation for 2+0 links. As a tradeoff, the GigE Master I/O module supports fewer E1/T1 front panel ports as well as a lower capacity TDM switch than the Standard Master I/O module.

2-20

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

TDM network planning

With either Master I/O module the total throughput traffic capacity is highly dependent on the modulation mode being used (see Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 429). It also depends on the capacity license that has been purchased. For any modulation mode and Master I/O module, the traffic capacity of the E1/T1 circuits that are configured over either the East or West radio links is given priority over the Ethernet data traffic. The available Ethernet data traffic is effectively the traffic capacity that is still unused after E1/T1 traffic channels and Network Management traffic are accounted for. The PTP 810 MMU cannot be configured to prioritize Ethernet data traffic over TDM traffic. The prioritization of E1/T1 circuits over Ethernet data traffic also holds true in the event of a link failure in a 2+0 topology as described above. If the link supported by the East modem fails, the E1/T1 circuits mapped in the East modem are transferred to the West modem, the E1/T1 circuits mapped to the West modem (if any) are dropped, and the remaining West modem Ethernet data traffic is the traffic capacity that is still unused after the E1/T1 traffic channels from the East modem and the Network Management traffic are accounted for.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-21

Planning 1+0 links

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Planning 1+0 links


When planning 1+0 links, follow the process described in this section.

Concept of a 1+0 link


A 1+0 link is the simplest link to deploy. There is no redundant equipment deployed and so costs are minimized. The 1+0 link provides no protection in the case of equipment failure. If a link is very critical to network operation and where a service outage due to equipment failure cannot be tolerated, consider deploying a 1+1 Hot Standby, 1+1 Host Standby Spatial Diversity or 2+0 link.

Antenna, ODU and MMU configurations for 1+0


Select one of the following 1+0 link end configurations: ODU with direct mount antenna (Figure 43). ODU with remote mount antenna (Figure 44).

2-22

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Planning 1+0 links

Figure 43 Schematic view of 1+0 ODU direct mount link end

ODU

Direct mount antenna

IF cable

MMU

East modem

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-23

Planning 1+0 links

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Figure 44 Schematic view of 1+0 ODU remote mount link end

Flexible waveguide

Remote mount antenna

ODU

RMK

IF cable

MMU

East modem

2-24

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Planning 1+1 links

Planning 1+1 links


When planning 1+1 Hot Standby and 1+1 Hot Standby Spatial Diversity links, follow the process described in this section.

Concept of a 1+1 Hot Standby link


A 1+1 Hot Standby link provides protection against single point equipment failure of a Modem module, an IF cable, or an ODU. This is achieved by the deployment of extra equipment which automatically takes over the operation of the link in case of failure. The two main advantages of a 1+1 Hot Standby link are: Better availability. In the unlikely event of equipment failure in one of the protected items, the 1+1 Hot Standby link becomes operational again with a down time of less than 250 ms. This is compared to a lengthy down time in the event of equipment failure in a 1+0 link. This may be particularly important in remote locations or for safety critical applications. Maintenance operations can be carried out with a minimum of interruption to the service provided by the link.

Concept of a 1+1 Hot Standby Spatial Diversity link


A 1+1 Hot Standby Spatial Diversity link provides protection against single point equipment failure similar to the 1+1 Hot Standby configuration described above, and additionally provides protection against multipath and clear-air multipath fading in the wireless link. The spatial diversity configuration uses separate antennas for the two ODUs, and thus additionally provides protection against equipment failure of an ODU.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-25

Planning 1+1 links

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Antenna, ODU and MMU configurations for 1+1 links


Select one of the following 1+1 Hot Standby link end configurations:

ODUs coupled to single direct mount antenna


The coupler mounts directly to the back of the antenna (Figure 45). Choose symmetric or asymmetric couplers. The asymmetric coupler provides a better link budget (nominally 6 dB) for the Primary ODUs at the expense of the link budget of the Secondary ODUs. Figure 45 ODUs coupled to single direct mount antenna (schematic)

Primary ODU

Direct mount antenna

Secondary ODU

Symmetric or asymmetric coupler

IF cables

MMU West modem East modem

2-26

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Planning 1+1 links

ODUs coupled to single remote mount antenna


Requires a Remote Mount Kit (RMK) to mount the Coupler and 3' of flexible waveguide to connect the RMK to the antenna (Figure 46). Choose symmetric or asymmetric couplers. The asymmetric coupler provides a better link budget (nominally 6 dB) for the Primary ODUs at the expense of the link budget of the Secondary ODUs. Figure 46 ODUs coupled to single remote mount antenna (schematic)

Primary ODU

Flexible waveguide

Remote mount antenna

Remote mount kit Secondary ODU Symmetric or asymmetric coupler

IF cables

MMU West modem East modem

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-27

Planning 1+1 links

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

ODUs with separate direct mount antennas


May be used to provide Spatial Diversity. The ODUs mounts directly to the back of the antennas (Figure 47). The antenna connected to the Secondary ODU may have lower gain if space on the mast is an issue. Although antennas may have different gains, the polarizations must be the same. Figure 47 ODUs with separate direct mount antennas (schematic)

Primary ODU

Direct mount antenna

Secondary ODU

Direct mount antenna

IF cable

IF cable

MMU West modem East modem

2-28

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Planning 1+1 links

ODUs with separate remote mount antennas


May be used to provide Spatial Diversity. Each ODU is mounted using a Remote Mount Kit (Figure 48). Each RMK connects to its antenna with a 3' flexible waveguide. The antenna connected to the Secondary ODU may have lower gain if space on the mast is an issue. Although antennas may have different gains, the polarizations must be the same. Figure 48 ODUs with separate remote mount antennas (schematic)

Flexible waveguide

Remote mount antenna

Primary ODU Remote mount antenna

Remote mount kits

Secondary ODU

Flexible waveguide

IF cable

IF cable

MMU West modem East modem

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-29

Planning 1+1 links

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Designating primary and secondary units


At each link end, the Primary ODU is the one connected to the East modem, and the Secondary ODU is the one connected to the West modem. In deployments with asymmetric couplers, connect the Primary ODU to the arm of the coupler with lowest path loss. The coupler labels this arm as "Main". If separate antennas are deployed, connect the Primary ODU to the antenna with the highest gain.

Link planning for 1+1 Hot Standby links


A 1+1 Hot Standby link has four radio paths: Primary end A to Primary end B Primary end A to Secondary end B Secondary end A to Primary end B Secondary end A to Secondary end B

A 1+1 Hot Standby link normally operates on the Primary to Primary radio path. However, any of the four paths may become active if a fault causes a protection switch at one end of the link. Use LINKPlanner to check wireless link availability for all four paths, ensuring that the minimum required availability can be met by all paths.

Link planning for Spatial Diversity


Spatial Diversity can significantly improve the availability of a link, particularly for long links. Indeed regulations can recommend or even mandate that Spatial Diversity is deployed for links which are longer than a specific range. LINKPlanner calculates link availability for all link configurations and provides a very convenient way of seeing the effect of enabling Spatial Diversity.

2-30

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Planning 2+0 links

Planning 2+0 links


When planning 2+0 links, follow the process described in this section.

Concept of a 2+0 link


A 2+0 link consists of a single dual modem PTP 810 MMU at each end of the link. The MMUs are configured using either the East/East or 2+0 XPIC ODU Operational Modes for 2+0 co-polar/cross-polar or 2+0 XPIC, respectively. These configurations allow for traffic to be sent over both modems of the MMU, effectively doubling the throughput. In the 2+0 co-polar/cross-polar cases, this results in two wireless links that must operate on different frequencies and so a separate license is generally required for each link. In the 2+0 XPIC case, the two wireless links operate on the same frequency. When the MMUs have a GigE Master I/O module installed, they can be configured to provide link aggregation (see Transparent wireless link aggregation (GigE Master I/O module) on page 1-42) Link aggregation is used to automatically load balance traffic across the two wireless links. An external aggregation switch is required to provide equivalent load balancing for the Standard Master I/O module. For either Master I/O module, it is possible to use port based forwarding or RSTP/MSTP to segregate traffic between the two wireless links (see Managing 2+0 Co-Polar, Cross-Polar & XPIC links on page 7-25).

Antenna, ODU and MMU configurations for 2+0


Select one of the following 2+0 link end configurations:

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-31

Planning 2+0 links

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

ODUs coupled to single direct mount antenna - co-polar links


The Coupler mounts directly to the back of the antenna (Figure 49). Use the symmetric coupler with the 2+0 East-East configuration, as both links use the same bandwidth and modulation. Figure 49 ODUs coupled to single direct mount antenna - co-polar links (schematic)

Link A ODU Direct mount antenna (single polar) Link B ODU

Coupler

IF cables

MMU West modem East modem

2-32

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Planning 2+0 links

ODUs coupled to a single remote mount antenna - co-polar links


Requires a Remote Mount Kit (RMK) to mount the Coupler and 3' of flexible waveguide to connect the RMK to the antenna (Figure 50). Use the symmetric coupler with the 2+0 East-East configuration, as both links use the same bandwidth and modulation. Figure 50 ODUs coupled to a single remote mount antenna - co-polar links (schematic)

Flexible waveguide

Remote mount antenna (single polar)

Link A ODU

Link B ODU

Remote mount kit Coupler

IF cables

MMU West modem East modem

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-33

Planning 2+0 links

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

ODUs coupled to a single direct mount antenna - cross-polar links


This configuration includes both 2+0 cross-polar and 2+0 XPIC configurations. It requires a dual-polar direct mount antenna (Figure 51).

To upgrade any standard antenna to dual-polar direct mount, purchasing an orthogonal mount kit from Cambium.

Figure 51 ODUs coupled to a single direct mount antenna - cross-polar links (schematic)

2-34

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Planning 2+0 links

ODUs connected to a dual polar remote mount antenna - cross-polar links


This configuration includes both 2+0 cross-polar and 2+0 XPIC configurations. It requires two Remote Mount Kits (RMK) to mount the ODUs and two 3' flexible waveguide to connect the RMKs to the antenna (Figure 52). Figure 52 ODUs connected to a dual polar remote mount antenna - cross-polar links (schematic)

Flexible waveguide Link A ODU Remote mount kits Remote mount antenna (dual polar)

Link B ODU

Flexible waveguide

IF cables

MMU West modem East modem

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-35

Planning 2+0 links

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Frequency spacing
For co-polar deployments, the transmit frequency of link A and link B at a given end must be separated by at least two channel separations. For example, if the channel separation is configured as 28 MHz, the spacing between the two transmit frequencies must be at least 56 MHz. For cross-polar deployments where XPIC operation is not enabled, the transmit frequency of link A and link B at a given end must be separated by at least one channel separation. For example, if the channel separation is configured as 28 MHz, the spacing between the two transmit frequencies must be at least 28 MHz. For cross-polar 2+0 XPIC deployments, the same transmit frequency must be used for link A and link B.

2-36

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Planning Dual 1+0 links

Planning Dual 1+0 links


When planning ring and ribbon topologies in a PTP 810 network using the Dual 1+0 configuration and LINKPlanner, follow the procedures in this section to update the BOM.

BOM for ring and ribbon topologies


The creation of a ribbon or ring topology in a PTP 810 01-00 system will make use of the Dual 1+0 configuration (East/West ODU operational mode) in the PTP 810 MMUs. The Dual 1+0 configuration uses a single PTP 810 MMU with dual modems at each site and is an unprotected configuration deploying 1+0 links. LINKPlanner is only aware of each individual link. It will generate a BOM for each link without knowing that the PTP 810 MMU will have some redundant components that are shared at each site in a 1+0 ribbon or ring topology. The following planning considerations need to be taken into account to generate the correct BOM for these system topologies.

1+0 Ribbon topology


Along the chain of links used in a 1+0 ribbon topology, a single PTP 810 MMU is shared between two links for each site that is not one of the two end-points of the chain. Each PTP 810 that is not at the ends of the chain connects to a pair of ODUs, where each ODU interfaces to a separate modem module and a separate power supply module. All other PTP 810 MMU modules including the chassis, controller module, master I/O module and any expansion I/O module do not need to be duplicated. The PTP 810 MMU base module configuration that is the correct choice to use for each shared site in a 1+0 ribbon topology chain is the dual modem base module configuration that is used with 1+1 and 2+0 links. Since each individual link in the chain is in a 1+0 configuration, LINKPlanner will generate a BOM consisting of two single modem PTP 810 MMU base modules and two expansion I/O modules (if used) for each shared site along the chain. The end result is the need to manually replace the two single modem base modules with one dual modem base module and delete the duplicate expansion I/O module for each shared site from the overall system BOM list. The capacity license keys used will need to be adjusted as well. A 1+0 ribbon topology containing N links will consist of N+1 sites where N-1 of these sites will be shared sites. For each of these N-1 shared sites, the system planner will need to: 1 2 Replace the part number of one of the single modem base modules with the part number of the equivalent dual modem base module. Delete the duplicate single modem base module and the duplicate expansion I/O module (if used) from the BOM generated by LINKPlanner.
2-37

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Planning Dual 1+0 links

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Double the capacity license key size.

1+0 Ring topology


From the perspective of the required PTP 810 MMU module configurations and the associated BOM generated by LINKPlanner, the 1+0 ring topology is very similar to the 1+0 ribbon topology. The main difference is that the end points are also connected, resulting in an topology where every site becomes a shared site. A 1+0 ring containing N links will consist of N sites where each of these sites will be a shared site. For each of these N shared sites, the system planner will need to: 1 2 3 Replace the part number of one of the single modem base modules with the part number of the equivalent dual modem base module. Delete the duplicate single modem base module and the duplicate expansion I/O module (if used) from the BOM generated by LINKPlanner. Double the capacity license key size.

2-38

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Ordering components
This section describes how to select components for a planned PTP 810 link.

Ordering MMUs
Select MMUs and associated components from the following tables: Base modules: Table 8 Spare, expansion and upgrade modules: Table 9 Accessories: Table 10

Table 8 MMU base modules Cambium part number C000081M001 C000081M008 C000081M003 C000081M005 Description PTP810 MMU Standard, 2xFE + 16xE1/T1 PTP810 MMU GigE, 4xGigE + 1xGigE SFP + 2xE1/T1 PTP810 MMU Standard Dual Modem, 2xFE + 16xE1/T1 PTP810 MMU GigE Dual Modem, 4xGigE + 1xGigE SFP + 2xE1/T1

Table 9 MMU spare, expansion and upgrade modules Cambium part number N000081H005 C000081H002 N000081H015 N000081H004 N000081H016 N000081H012 N000081H006 C000081H001 Description PTP810 MMU Control Module PTP810 MMU Modem Module PTP810 MMU Power Supply Module PTP810 MMU Chassis PTP810 MMU Standard Master I/O module PTP810 MMU GigE Master I/O module PTP810 MMU Expansion I/O: 16xE1/T1 PTP810 MMU Dual Modem upgrade kit, Power Supply Module + Modem Module

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-39

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 10 MMU accessories Cambium part number N000081L002 N000081L001 N000081L004 N000081L005 N000081L006 N000081L007 Description PTP810 AC to DC power adapter PTP810 14 to 1 Shielded E1/T1 cables, Bare Wire 10ft PTP810 XPIC cable TNC Male for CNT-400 braided cable TNC Male Right Angle for CNT-400 braided cable Type N Female to TNC Male Adapter

Ordering capacity upgrades and XPIC capability


MMU Modem Modules are shipped with a data throughput capacity of 10 Mbps and without XPIC capability. To increase the capacity or install XPIC capability, perform the following procedures: Order access keys. Use the access keys to generate authorization keys. Enter the authorization keys in the MMU web interface. The procedure is described in Entering an authorization key on page 7-60.

The MMU may not achieve the data throughput capacity specified in the access key, as its capacity also depends on channel bandwidth and modulation mode. For more information, see Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29.

Ordering access keys


Select either a single-step capacity upgrade from Table 11, or one or more step-by-step capacity upgrades from Table 12. For XPIC capability, select an XPIC upgrade key from Table 13. Order these components from a Cambium authorized Point-To-Point dealer. The dealer will send one or more access keys by email.

2-40

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Table 11 Single-step capacity upgrades (per MMU) Cambium part number WB3538 WB3539 WB3540 WB3541 WB3542 WB3543 WB3544 WB3545 WB3546 N000081K001 Description PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 20 Mbps (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 30 Mbps (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 40 Mbps (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 50 Mbps (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 100 Mbps (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 150 Mbps (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 200 Mbps (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 300 Mbps (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 400 Mbps (per Unit) PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP 600 Mbps (per Unit)

Table 12 Step-by-step capacity upgrades (per MMU) Cambium part number WB3547 WB3548 WB3549 WB3550 WB3551 WB3552 WB3553 WB3554 Description PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP upgrade from 20 -> 30 Mbps key (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP upgrade from 30 -> 40 Mbps key (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP upgrade from 40 -> 50 Mbps key (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP upgrade from 50 -> 100 Mbps key (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP upgrade from 100 -> 150 Mbps key (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP upgrade from 150 -> 200 Mbps key (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP upgrade from 200 -> 300 Mbps key (per Unit) PTP800/PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP upgrade from 300 -> 400 Mbps Key (per Unit)
2-41

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Cambium part number N000081K003

Description PTP810 Modem Capacity CAP upgrade from 400 -> 600 Mbps Key (per Unit)

Table 13 XPIC capability (per MMU) Cambium part number N000081K005 Description PTP810 MMU XPIC Authorization Key (per Unit)

Using access keys to generate authorization keys


When the MMU or Modem Module is delivered, proceed as follows for each access key ordered: 1 Obtain the MMU or Modem Module serial numbers: For a capacity upgrade, obtain the MMU chassis serial number. This is recorded on the packing sheet and on the MMU enclosure (Figure 53). For an XPIC capability upgrade, obtain the Modem Module serial numbers. This is recorded on the packing sheet (it is not visible on the Modem Modules). Alternatively, log into the MMU via the web interface and obtain these serial numbers (see Viewing device information on page 7-57). 2 3 4 4 Go to the PTP web support page (see Contacting Cambium Networks on page 2). Navigate to the Cambium Networks License Key Generator. Enter the required details, including access keys and serial numbers. Submit the web form. Cambium will send the authorization keys by email.

Figure 53 Location of chassis serial number on MMU enclosure

2-42

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

If XPIC capability is not requested, PTP License Key Generator provides two authorization keys: 1+x: The 1+x authorization key permits operation of 1+0, 1+1 HSB, and 1+1 HSB SD link configurations of the MMU. 2+0: The 2+0 authorization key permits operation of Dual 1+0, 2+0 Cross-Polar and 2+0 Co-Polar link configurations of the MMU.

If XPIC capability is requested, PTP License Key Generator provides three authorization keys; the 1+x, 2+0 (as defined above) and: XPIC: The XPIC Authorization Key is used to allow operation of 2+0 XPIC link configurations of the MMU.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-43

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Ordering antennas
Use Table 14 to select the type and quantity of antennas required per link. Table 14 Selecting antennas for each hardware configuration Hardware configuration 1+0 1+1 1+1 2+0 co-polar 2+0 cross-polar Antenna mounting Direct or remote Direct or remote Direct or remote Direct or remote Direct or remote (*2) Antenna protection? No Yes Antenna polarization Single (*1) Single Single Single Dual Quantity per link 2 2 4 2 2

(*1) Select single-polar antennas (direct or remote mount) for normal 1+0 links. Alternatively, to provide for a future upgrade from 1+0 to 2+0, select dual-polar remote mount antennas. (*2) As an alternative to purchasing a dual-polar direct mount antenna, use an orthogonal mount kit (OMK) to upgrade any standard antenna to dual-polar direct mount; refer to Ordering OMKs on page 2-75. Select antennas from the following tables: Lower 6 GHz and Upper 6 GHz: Table 15 and Table 16. 7 GHz and 8 GHz: Table 17 and Table 18. 11 GHz: Table 19 and Table 20. 13 GHz: Table 21 and Table 22. 15 GHz: Table 23 and Table 24. 18 GHz: Table 25 and Table 26. 23 GHz: Table 27 and Table 28. 26 GHz: Table 29 and Table 30. 28 GHz: Table 31 and Table 32. 32 GHz: Table 33 and Table 34. 38 GHz: Table 35 and Table 36. Parabolic radomes (optional): Table 37.

In the Interface column of these tables, Direct means Cambium direct mount and a flange size, for example PDR70, means remote mount.

2-44

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Table 15 Antennas: 6 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85009298001 85010089050 85010089021 85010091022 85010091024 85010091007 85009294001 85009294002 85009294003 85009294004 Diameter Interface Midband gain 33 dBi 35 dBi 39 dBi 33 dBi 35 dBi 39 dBi 38.2 dBi 40.8 dBi 43.4 dBi 44.9 dBi Vertical beamwidth 3.3 2.9 1.8 3.3 2.9 1.8 1.9 1.4 1.1 0.9 Weight

1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 2.4 m (8 ft) 3 m (10 ft) 3.7 m (12 ft)

Direct Direct Direct PDR70 PDR70 PDR70 CPR137G CPR137G CPR137G CPR137G

24 kg (53 lb) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb) 78 kg (172 lb) 114 kg (251 lb) 144 kg (317 lb) 245 kg (540 lb)

Table 16 Antennas: 6 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85009302001 85009302002 85009302003 85010092048 85010092060 85010092021 Diameter Interface Midband gain 33 dBi 35 dBi 39 dBi 33 dBi 35 dBi 39 dBi Vertical beamwidth 3.3 2.9 1.8 3.3 2.9 1.8 24 kg (53 lb) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb) Weight

1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) PDR70 PDR70 PDR70

(*) The antenna includes an orthogonal mode transducer.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-45

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 17 Antennas: 7 GHz and 8 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089045 85009298002 85010089051 85010089025 85010091020 85010091023 85010091025 85010091011 Diameter Interface Midband gain 31.1 dBi 35.5 dBi 37.3 dBi 40.8 dBi 31.1 dBi 35.5 dBi 37.3 dBi 40.8 dBi Vertical beamwidth 4.7 2.6 2.2 1.5 4.7 2.6 2.2 1.5 Weight

0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct Direct Direct Direct PDR84 PDR84 PDR84 PDR84

11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 ib) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb)

Table 18 Antennas: 7 GHz and 8 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85009303001 85009303002 85009303003 85009303004 85010092051 85010092059 85010092061 85010092025 Diameter 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) Interface Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) PDR84 PDR84 PDR84 PDR84 Mid-band gain 31.1 dBi 35.5 dBi 37.3 dBi 40.6 dBi 31.1 dBi 35.5 dBi 37.3 dBi 40.6 dBi Vertical beamwidth 4.7 2.6 2.2 1.5 4.7 2.6 2.2 1.5 14 kg (31 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb) Weight

(*) The antenna includes an orthogonal mode transducer.

2-46

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Table 19 Antennas: 11 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089049 85010089003 85009298003 85010089052 85010089005 85010091019 85010091003 85010091017 85010091026 85010091005 85009301001 85009294005 85009294006 Diameter Interface Midband gain 34.5 dBi 37.4 dBi 38.4 dBi 40.4 dBi 43.8 dBi 34.5 dBi 37.4 dBi 38.4 dBi 40.4 dBi 43.8 dBi 40.4 dBi 43.6 dBi 46.2 dBi Vertical beamwidth 3.3 2.1 2.0 1.5 1.1 3.3 2.1 2.0 1.5 1.1 1.6 1.1 0.8 Weight

0.6 m (2 ft) 0.8 m (2.6 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 0.8 m (2.6 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 2.4 m (8 ft)

Direct Direct Direct Direct Direct PDR100 (*1) PDR100 (*1) PDR100 (*1) PDR100 (*1) PDR100 (*1) CPR90G (*1) CPR90G (*1) CPR90G (*1)

11 kg (25 lb) 30 kg (66 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 46 kg (101 lb) 84 kg (185 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 30 kg (66 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 46 kg (101 lb) 84 kg (185 lb) 69 kg (152 lb) 78 kg (171 lb) 125 kg (276lb)

(*1) Waveguide interface 11 GHz antennas require a tapered transition (Table 56). Table 20 Antennas: 11 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85009304001 85009304002 85009304003 85009304004 85010092052 85010092003 85010092042 85010092062 85010092005 Diameter Interface Midband gain 34.5 dBi 38.4 dBi 40.4 dBi 43.8 dBi 34.5 dBi 37.2 dBi 38.4 dBi 40.4 dBi 43.8 dBi Vertical beamwidth 3.3 2.0 1.5 1.1 3.3 2.1 2.0 1.5 1.1 11 kg (25 lb) 30 kg (66 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 46 kg (101 lb) 84 kg (185 lb) Weight

0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 0.8 m (2.6 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct (*1) Direct (*1) Direct (*1) Direct (*1) PDR100 (*2) PDR100 (*2) PDR100 (*2) PDR100 (*2) PDR100 (*2)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-47

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

(*1) The antenna includes an orthogonal mode transducer. (*2) Waveguide interface 11 GHz antennas require a tapered transition (Table 56).

The 11 GHz waveguide interface antennas require an extra component, the 11 GHz tapered transition. This is supplied by Cambium (Table 56) and is required to convert between the antenna interface and the waveguide flange. Table 21 Antennas: 13 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089053 85010089046 85009298004 85010089054 85010089030 85010091012 85010091021 85010091018 85010091027 85010091016 Diameter Interface Midband gain 30.9 dBi 36.0 dBi 40.0 dBi 42.0 dBi 45.2 dBi 30.9 dBi 36.0 dBi 40.0 dBi 42.0 dBi 45.2 dBi Vertical beamwidth 4.7 2.7 1.6 1.3 0.9 4.7 2.7 1.6 1.3 0.9 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct Direct Direct Direct Direct PBR120 PBR120 PBR120 PBR120 PBR120

7 kg (15 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb) 7 kg (15 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb)

Table 22 Antennas: 13 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85009305001 85009305002 85009305003 85009305004 85009305005 85010092026 85010092056 85010092043
2-48

Diameter

Interface

Midband gain 30.9 dBi 36.0 dBi 40.0 dBi 42.0 dBi 45.2 dBi 30.9 dBi 36.0 dBi 40.0 dBi

Vertical beamwidth 4.7 2.7 1.6 1.3 0.9 4.7 2.7 1.6

Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft)

Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) PBR120 PBR120 PBR120

7 kg (15 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb)


phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Cambium number 85010092063 85010092030

Diameter

Interface

Midband gain 42.0 dBi 45.2 dBi

Vertical beamwidth 1.3 0.9

Weight

1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

PBR120 PBR120

55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb)

(*) The antenna includes an orthogonal mode transducer.

Table 23 Antennas: 15 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089055 85010089047 85009298005 85010089056 85010089035 Diameter Interface Midband gain 32.1 dBi 36.8 dBi 41.1 dBi 42.9 dBi 46.2 dBi Vertical beamwidth 4.3 2.5 1.5 1.2 0.8 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct Direct Direct Direct Direct

7 kg (15 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb)

Table 24 Antennas: 15 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85009306001 85009306002 85009306003 85009306004 85009306005 85010092031 85010092057 85010092044 85010092064 85010092035 Diameter Interface Midband gain 32.0 dBi 36.8 dBi 41.1 dBi 42.9 dBi 46.2 dBi 32.0 dBi 36.8 dBi 41.1 dBi 42.9 dBi 46.2 dBi Vertical beamwidth 4.3 2.5 1.5 1.2 0.8 4.3 2.5 1.5 1.2 0.8 7 kg (15 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 55 kg (121 lb) 62 kg (137 lb) Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) PBR140 PBR140 PBR140 PBR140 PBR140

(*) The antenna includes an orthogonal mode transducer.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-49

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 25 Antennas: 18 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089057 85010089042 85009298006 85010089058 85010089010 Diameter Interface Midband gain 34.2 dBi 38.9 dBi 43.5 dBi 44.7 dBi 47.8 dBi Vertical beamwidth 3.3 2.1 1.1 0.9 0.7 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct Direct Direct Direct Direct

6 kg (13 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 46 kg (101 lb) 84 kg (185 lb)

Table 26 Antennas: 18 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85009307001 85009307002 85009307003 85009307004 85009307005 85010092006 85010092053 85010092045 85010092065 85010092010 Diameter Interface Midband gain 34.2 dBi 38.9 dBi 43.5 dBi 44.7 dBi 47.6 dBi 34.2 dBi 38.9 dBi 43.5 dBi 44.7 dBi 47.6 dBi Vertical beamwidth 3.3 2.1 1.1 0.9 0.7 3.3 2.1 1.1 0.9 0.7 6 kg (13 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 46 kg (101 lb) 84 kg (185 lb) Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) PBR220 PBR220 PBR220 PBR220 PBR220

(*) The antenna includes an orthogonal mode transducer.

2-50

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Table 27 Antennas: 23 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089059 85010089043 85009298007 85010089060 85010089015 Diameter Interface Midband gain 35.3 dBi 40.5 dBi 44.8 dBi 46.7 dBi 49.4 dBi Vertical beam -width 3.0 1.7 1.0 0.8 0.5 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct Direct Direct Direct Direct

6 kg (13 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 46 kg (101 lb) 84 kg (185 lb)

Table 28 Antennas: 23 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85009308001 85009308002 85009308003 85009308004 85009308005 85010092011 85010092054 85010092046 85010092066 85010092015 Diameter Interface Midband gain 35.3 dBi 40.5 dBi 44.8 dBi 46.7 dBi 49.2 dBi 35.3 dBi 40.5 dBi 44.8 dBi 46.7 dBi 49.2 dBi Vertical beam -width 3.0 1.7 1.0 0.8 0.5 3.0 1.7 1.0 0.8 0.5 6 kg (13 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 46 kg (101 lb) 84 kg (185 lb) Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft) 0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.8 m (6 ft)

Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) Direct (*) PBR220 PBR220 PBR220 PBR220 PBR220

(*) The antenna includes an orthogonal mode transducer.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-51

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 29 Antennas: 26 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089061 85010089044 85009298008 85010089062 Diameter Interface Midband gain 36.6 dBi 41.6 dBi 45.8 dBi 47.4 dBi Vertical beamwidth 2.5 1.5 0.8 0.6 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft)

Direct Direct Direct Direct

6 kg (13 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 46 kg (101 lb)

Table 30 Antennas: 26 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85010092016 85010092055 85010092047 85010092067 Diameter Interface Midband gain 36.6 dBi 41.6 dBi 45.8 dBi 47.4 dBi Vertical beamwidth 2.5 1.5 0.8 0.6 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft) 1.0 m (3 ft) 1.2 m (4 ft)

PBR220 PBR220 PBR220 PBR220

6 kg (13 lb) 11 kg (25 lb) 24 kg (53 lb) 46 kg (101 lb)

Table 31 Antennas: 28 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089064 85010089041 Diameter Interface Midband gain 38.1 dBi 42.6 dBi Vertical beamwidth 2.2 1.2 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft)

Direct Direct

7 kg (14 lb) 11 kg (25 lb)

Table 32 Antennas: 28 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85010092040 85010092041


2-52

Diameter

Interface

Midband gain 38.1 dBi 42.6 dBi

Vertical beamwidth 2.2 1.2

Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft)

PBR320 PBR320

7 kg (14 lb) 11 kg (25 lb)


phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Table 33 Antennas: 32 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089036 85010089037 Diameter Interface Midband gain 38.9 dBi 43.5 dBi Vertical beamwidth 1.8 1.0 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft)

Direct Direct

7 kg (14 lb) 11 kg (25 lb)

Table 34 Antennas: 32 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85010092036 85010092037 Diameter Interface Midband gain 38.9 dBi 43.5 dBi Vertical beamwidth 1.8 1.0 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft)

PBR320 PBR320

7 kg (14 lb) 11 kg (25 lb)

Table 35 Antennas: 38 GHz single polarization Cambium number 85010089063 85010089048 Diameter Interface Midband gain 40.1 dBi 45.2 dBi Vertical beamwidth 1.6 0.9 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft)

Direct Direct

6 kg (13 lb) 11 kg (25 lb)

Table 36 Antennas: 38 GHz dual polarization Cambium number 85010092038 85010092058 Diameter Interface Midband gain 40.1 dBi 45.2 dBi Vertical beamwidth 1.6 0.9 Weight

0.3 m (1 ft) 0.6 m (2 ft)

PBR320 PBR320

7 kg (15 lb) 11 kg (25 lb)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-53

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 37 Parabolic radomes (optional) Cambium number 85009295001 85009295002 Description 10 Foot Radome For Par10 Antenna 11 Foot Radome For Par12 Antenna

Ordering ODUs
Determine the number of ODUs required per link, as follows: 1+0 links: 2 ODUs. 1+1 Hot Standby links: 4 ODUs. 2+0 links: 4 ODUs.

Select ODUs from the following tables: Lower 6 GHz: Table 38. Upper 6 GHz: Table 39. 7 GHz: Table 40. 8 GHz: Table 41. 11 GHz: Table 42 (ODU-B) and Table 43 (ODU-A). 13 GHz: Table 44. 15 GHz: Table 45. 18 GHz: Table 46 (ODU-B) and Table 47 (ODU-A). 23 GHz: Table 48 (ODU-B) and Table 49 (ODU-A). 26 GHz: Table 50. 28 GHz: Table 51. 32 GHz: Table 52. 38 GHz: Table 53.

If ODU-B is available (11, 18 and 23 GHz), choose it in preference to ODU-A. Do not install ODU-A and ODU-B in the same link.

2-54

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Table 38 ODUs: Lower 6 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010411007 01010411008 01010411009 01010411010 01010411011 01010411012 Standard FCC, ETSI Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi Sub-band frequency 5925 6025 MHz 6175 6275 MHz 6000 6100 MHz 6250 6350 MHz 6075 6175 MHz 6325 6425 MHz T/R spacing 252 MHz

Table 39 ODUs: Upper 6 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010411024 01010411022 01010411025 01010411023 01010411027 01010411026 01010411013 01010411014 01010411015 01010411016 01010411017 01010411018 01010411019 01010411020 ETSI FCC Standard FCC Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B1-Lo B1-Hi B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi Sub-band frequency 6580 6640 MHz 6740 6800 MHz 6640 6710 MHz 6800 6870 MHz 6530 6580 MHz 6700 6750 MHz 6430 6540 MHz 6770 6880 MHz 6520 6630 MHz 6860 6970 MHz 6600 6710 MHz 6940 7050 MHz 6670 6780 MHz 7010 7120 MHz 170 MHz 340 MHz T/R spacing 160 MHz

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-55

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 40 ODUs: 7 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010610001 01010610002 01010610003 01010610004 01010610005 01010610006 01010610013 01010610014 01010610015 01010610016 01010610017 01010610018 01010610019 01010610020 01010610021 01010610022 01010610023 01010610024 01010610025 01010610026 01010610027 01010610028 01010610029 01010610030 01010610031 01010610032 01010610033 ETSI Standard ETSI Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi B5-Lo B5-Hi B6-Lo B6-Hi B7-Lo B7-Hi B8-Lo B8-Hi B9-Lo B9-Hi B10-Lo B10-Hi B21-Lo Sub-band frequency 7428 7484 MHz 7582 7638 MHz 7470 7526 MHz 7624 7680 MHz 7512 7568 MHz 7666 7722 MHz 7114 7177 MHz 7275 7338 MHz 7149 7212 MHz 7310 7373 MHz 7184 7247 MHz 7345 7408 MHz 7219 7282 MHz 7380 7443 MHz 7239 7302 MHz 7400 7463 MHz 7274 7337 MHz 7435 7498 MHz 7309 7372 MHz 7470 7533 MHz 7344 7407 MHz 7505 7568 MHz 7414 7477 MHz 7575 7638 MHz 7449 7512 MHz 7610 7673 MHz 7484 7547 MHz 161 MHz T/R spacing 154 MHz

2-56

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Cambium part number 01010610034 01010610035 01010610036 01010610037 01010610038 01010610039 01010610040 01010610041 01010610042 01010610043 01010610044 01010610062 01010610063 01010610064 01010610065 01010610066 01010610067 01010610045 01010610046 01010610047 01010610048 01010610049 01010610050 01010610051 01010610052 01010610053 01010610054 01010610055 01010610056

Standard

Subband B21-Hi B22-Lo B22-Hi B23-Lo B23-Hi B24-Lo B24-Hi B25-Lo B25-Hi B26-Lo B26-Hi

Sub-band frequency 7645 7708 MHz 7519 7582 MHz 7680 7743 MHz 7539 7602 MHz 7700 7763 MHz 7574 7637 MHz 7735 7798 MHz 7609 7672 MHz 7770 7833 MHz 7644 7707 MHz 7805 7868 MHz 7443 7499 MHz 7611 7667 MHz 7485 7541 MHz 7653 7709 MHz 7527 7583 MHz 7695 7751 MHz 7093 7149 MHz 7289 7345 MHz 7121 7177 MHz 7317 7373 MHz 7149 7205 MHz 7345 7401 MHz 7177 7233 MHz 7373 7429 MHz 7205 7261 MHz 7401 7457 MHz 7400 7484 MHz 7645 7729 MHz

T/R spacing

ETSI

B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi

168 MHz

ETSI

B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi B5-Lo B5-Hi

196 MHz

ETSI

B1-Lo B1-Hi

245 MHz

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-57

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Cambium part number 01010610057 01010610058 01010610059 01010610060

Standard

Subband B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi

Sub-band frequency 7484 7568 MHz 7729 7813 MHz 7568 7652 MHz 7813 7897 MHz

T/R spacing

Table 41 ODUs: 8 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010611001 01010611002 01010611003 01010611004 01010611005 01010611006 01010611007 01010611008 01010611009 01010611010 01010611011 01010611012 01010611019 01010611020 01010611021 01010611022 01010611023 01010611024 01010611025 01010611026 01010611027 01010611028
2-58

Standard ETSI

Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi B5-Lo B5-Hi B6-Lo B6-Hi

Sub-band frequency 8279 8307 MHz 8398 8426 MHz 8293 8321 MHz 8412 8440 MHz 8307 8335 MHz 8426 8454 MHz 8321 8349 MHz 8440 8468 MHz 8335 8363 MHz 8454 8482 MHz 8349 8377 MHz 8468 8496 MHz 8043 8113 MHz 8251 8321 MHz 8099 8169 MHz 8307 8377 MHz 8155 8225 MHz 8363 8433 MHz 8211 8281 MHz 8419 8489 MHz 7905 8024 MHz 8171 8290 MHz

T/R spacing 119 MHz

ETSI

B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi

208 MHz

ETSI

B1-Lo B1-Hi

266 MHz

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Cambium part number 01010611029 01010611030 01010611031 01010611032 01010611033 01010611034

Standard

Subband B2-Lo B2-Hi

Sub-band frequency 8017 8136 MHz 8283 8402 MHz 7835 7971 MHz 8146 8282 MHz 7717 7867 MHz 8028 8178 MHz

T/R spacing

ETSI

B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi

311 MHz

Table 42 ODUs: 11 GHz ODU-B Cambium part number 85009317001 85009317002 85009317003 85009317004 85009317005 85009317006 Standard FCC Sub-band B5-Lo B5-Hi B6-Lo B6-Hi B7-Lo B7-Hi Sub-band frequency 10700 10890 MHz 11200 11390 MHz 10855 11045 MHz 11355 11545 MHz 11010 11200 MHz 11510 11700 MHz T/R spacing 490 MHz

Table 43 ODUs: 11 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010208001 01010208002 01010208003 01010208004 01010208005 01010208006 01010208007 01010208008 01010208009 01010208010
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Standard FCC, ETSI

Sub-band B5-Lo B5-Hi B6-Lo B6-Hi B7-Lo B7-Hi

Sub-band frequency 10700 10890 MHz 11200 11390 MHz 10855 11045 MHz 11355 11545 MHz 11010 11200 MHz 11510 11700 MHz 10675 10855 MHz 11205 11385 MHz 10795 10975 MHz 11325 11505 MHz

T/R spacing 490 MHz

ETSI

B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi

530 MHz

2-59

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Cambium part number 01010208011 01010208012 01010208013 01010208014

Standard

Sub-band B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi

Sub-band frequency 10915 11135 MHz 11455 11665 MHz 11035 11215 MHz 11565 11745 MHz

T/R spacing

Table 44 ODUs: 13 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010583001 01010583002 01010583003 01010583004 01010583005 01010583006 01010583007 01010583008 Standard ETSI Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi Sub-band frequency 12751 12814 MHz 13017 13080 MHz 12807 12870 MHz 13073 13136 MHz 12863 12926 MHz 13129 13192 MHz 12919 12982 MHz 13185 13248 MHz T/R spacing 266 MHz

Table 45 ODUs: 15 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010584001 01010584002 01010584003 01010584004 01010584005 01010584006 01010584007 01010584008 01010584009 ETSI Standard Subband B4-Lo B4-Hi B5-Lo B5-Hi B6-Lo B6-Hi B7-Lo B7-Hi B4-Lo Sub-band frequency T/R spacing 420 MHz

ETSI

14501 14613 MHz 14921 15033 MHz 14606 14725 MHz 15026 15145 MHz 14718 14837 MHz 15138 15257 MHz 14816 14928 MHz 15236 15348 MHz 14403 14522 MHz

490 MHz

2-60

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Cambium part number 01010584010 01010584011 01010584012 01010584013 01010584014 01010584015 01010584016 01010584020 01010584021 01010584022 01010584023 01010584024 01010584025 01010584026 01010584027 01010584028 01010584029 01010584030 01010584031 01010584032 01010584033

Standard

Subband B4-Hi B5-Lo B5-Hi B6-Lo B6-Hi B7-Lo B7-Hi

Sub-band frequency

T/R spacing

14893 15012 MHz 14515 14634 MHz 15005 15124 MHz 14627 14746 MHz 15117 15236 MHz 14739 14858 MHz 15229 15348 MHz 14500 14625 MHz 15228 15353 MHz 14627 14746 MHz 14942 15061 MHz 14725 14844 MHz 15040 15159 MHz 14823 14942 MHz 15138 15257 MHz 14400 14512 MHz 15044 15156 MHz 14498 14610 MHz 15142 15254 MHz 14596 14708 MHz 15240 15352 MHz 644 MHz 315 MHz 728 MHz

ETSI

B2-Lo B2-Hi

Italy

B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi

ETSI

B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi

Table 46 ODUs: 18 GHz ODU-B Cambium part number 85009318001 85009318002 Standard FCC Subband B3-Lo B3-Hi Sub-band frequency 17700 18140 MHz 19260 19700 MHz T/R spacing 1560 MHz

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-61

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 47 ODUs: 18 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010209001 01010209002 01010209003 01010209004 01010209005 01010209006 01010209007 01010209008 01010209013 01010209014 FCC Standard ETSI Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi Sub-band frequency 17685 17985 MHz 18695 18995 MHz 17930 18230 MHz 18940 19240 MHz 18180 18480 MHz 19190 19490 MHz 18400 18700 MHz 19410 19710 MHz 17700 18140 MHz 19260 19700 MHz 1560 MHz T/R spacing 1010 MHz

Table 48 ODUs: 23 GHz ODU-B Cambium part number 85009319001 85009319002 85009319003 85009319004 85009319005 85009319006 Standard FCC Subband B5-Lo B5-Hi B6-Lo B6-Hi B7-Lo B7-Hi Sub-band frequency 21200 21600 MHz 22400 22800 MHz 21600 22000 MHz 22800 23200 MHz 22000 22400 MHz 23200 23600 MHz T/R spacing 1200 MHz

Table 49 ODUs: 23 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010210001 01010210002 01010210003 01010210004
2-62

Standard ETSI

Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi

Sub-band frequency 21994 22330 MHz 23002 23338 MHz 22274 22610 MHz 23282 23618 MHz

T/R spacing 1008 MHz

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Cambium part number 01010210005 01010210006 01010210007 01010210008 01010210009 01010210010 01010210011 01010210012 01010210013 01010210014 01010210015 01010210016 01010210017 01010210018

Standard FCC

Subband B5-Lo B5-Hi B6-Lo B6-Hi B7-Lo B7-Hi

Sub-band frequency 21200 21600 MHz 22400 22800 MHz 21600 22000 MHz 22800 23200 MHz 22000 22400 MHz 23200 23600 MHz 21200 21500 MHz 22432 22732 MHz 21472 21786 MHz 22704 23018 MHz 21779 22093 MHz 23011 23325 MHz 22086 22386 MHz 23318 23618 MHz

T/R spacing 1200 MHz

ETSI

B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi

1232 MHz

Table 50 ODUs: 26 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010403003 01010403004 01010403005 01010403006 01010403007 01010403008 01010403001 01010403002 FCC Standard ETSI Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B1-Lo B1-Hi Sub-band frequency 24549 24885 MHz 25557 25893 MHz 24829 25165 MHz 25837 26173 MHz 25109 25445 MHz 26117 26453 MHz 24250 24450 MHz 25050 25250 MHz 800 MHz T/R spacing 1008 MHz

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-63

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 51 ODUs: 28 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01009420001 01009420002 01009420003 01009420004 Standard ETSI Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi Sub-band frequency 27520 28025 MHz 28528 29033 MHz 27968 28473 MHz 28976 29481 MHz T/R spacing 1008 MHz

Table 52 ODUs: 32 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010612001 01010612002 01010612003 01010612004 Standard ETSI Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi Sub-band frequency 31815 32207 MHz 32627 33019 MHz 32179 32571 MHz 32991 33383 MHz T/R spacing 812 MHz

Table 53 ODUs: 38 GHz ODU-A Cambium part number 01010433002 01010433003 01010433004 01010433005 01010433006 01010433007 01010433008 01010433009 01010433010 01010433011 01010433012 01010433001
2-64

Standard FCC

Subband B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi B3-Lo B3-Hi B4-Lo B4-Hi

Sub-band frequency 38595 38805 MHz 39295 39505 MHz 38795 39005 MHz 39495 39705 MHz 38995 39205 MHz 39695 39905 MHz 39195 39405 MHz 39895 40105 MHz 37044 37632 MHz 38304 38892 MHz 37604 38192 MHz 38864 39452 MHz

T/R spacing 700 MHz

ETSI

B1-Lo B1-Hi B2-Lo B2-Hi

1260 MHz

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Ordering IF cable, grounding and LPUs


For ODU based installations, select cable and LPU components from Table 54.

Table 54 Cable and LPU components Item CNT-400 coaxial cable, 50 (IF cable) Cambium part number and notes CNT-400 cable is supplied by Cambium with the following lengths and part numbers. 50 Ohm Braided Coaxial Cable - 75 meter. Cambium part number 30010194001. 50 Ohm Braided Coaxial Cable - 500 meter. Cambium part number 30010195001. For 1+1 and 2+0 links, order enough IF cable to connect two ODU/modem pairs at each link end. Lightning protection unit (LPU) end kit Quantity per link: 1+0 links: 2 LPU kits (4 LPUs). 1+1 Hot Standby links: 4 LPU kits (8 LPUs). 2+0 links: 4 LPU kits (8 LPUs). LPU END KIT PTP800. Cambium part number WB3657.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-65

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Item Hoisting Grip for CNT-400 cable

Cambium part number and notes For hoisting the IF cable up to the ODU without damaging the connector. Quantity per link: 1+0 links: 2 minimum. 1+1 Hot Standby links: 4 minimum. 2+0 links: 4 minimum. Hoisting Grip for CNT-400 cable. Cambium part number 07009304001.

Coaxial cable installation assembly kit (for CNT-400 cable)

Quantity per link: 1+0 links: 2 kits. 1+1 Hot Standby links: 4 kits. 2+0 links: 4 kits. Coaxial Cable Installation Assembly Kit. Cambium part number WB3616. For kit contents, see Table 55.

Cable grounding kits for 1/4" and 3/8" cable

Additional grounding kits may be required to cover all IF cable grounding points. Cable Grounding Kits For 1/4" And 3/8" Cable. Cambium part number 01010419001. Kit contents: grounding cable, selfamalgamating tape, PVC tape, tie-wraps, bolts, washers and nuts.

2-66

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Item Crimp tool for N-type and TNC connectors

Cambium part number and notes Required for crimping N-type connectors and TNC connectors to IF cables. Crimp tool for N-type connector. Cambium part number 66010063001.

N-Type to TNC Adapter TNC connectors

Cambium part number N000081L007. Required for connecting IF cables to MMUs. Quantity per link: 1+0 links: two connectors. 2+0 links: four connectors. Select either straight or right-angle as required. TNC Male for CNT-400 braided cable. Cambium part number N000081L005A. TNC Male Right Angle for CNT-400 braided cable. Cambium part number N000081L006A. Use the crimp tool, Cambium part number 66010063001.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-67

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 55 Inventory of the coaxial cable installation assembly kit (WB3616) Item Braided cable assembly Notes Quantity per kit: 1. 0.7 meter long cable to go between the ODU and the top LPU.

Cable grounding kits for 1/4" and 3/8" cable

Quantity per kit: 2. Each kit contains, earth wire, PVC tape, self amalgamating tape and fixings.

Ground lead

Quantity per kit: 1 Green, 0.8 meter long with M5 lugs fitted each end. Use for grounding the ODU to the top LPU.

2-68

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Item Ground lead

Notes Quantity per kit: 2. Green, 0.6 meter long with M5 lugs fitted one end and M10 the other. Use for grounding the top and bottom LPUs to the supporting structure.

Weather proofing kit

Quantity per kit: 1. Kit contains 6 reels of self amalgamating tape, 2 reels of 19mm wide PVC tape and 1 reel of 50mm wide PVC tape.

N type connector

Quantity per kit: 4. To fit CNT-400 cable. Use crimp tool part number 66010063001.

Cable ties

Quantity per kit: 50.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-69

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Ordering RMKs and waveguides


For remote mounted ODUs (or couplers) select RMKs, waveguides and accessories from Table 56. Table 56 RMKs, waveguides and accessories Item ODU remote mounting kit Cambium part number and notes Quantity per remote mounted ODU: 1. Part numbers: listed in Table 57.

Flexible waveguide

Quantity per remote mounted ODU: 1. Part numbers: listed in Table 58. All waveguides are 900 mm (35 in) long. For more information, see Flexible waveguide specifications on page 4-9.

Flex-twist hanger kit

Quantity per remote mounted ODU: 2. Part numbers: listed in Table 59. To provide adequate support for a 900mm flexible waveguide, two hangers are required.

2-70

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Item Tapered transition

Cambium part number and notes Required only for 11 GHz remote-mounted antennas, fitted between the antenna and the flexible waveguide. Quantity per remote mounted ODU: 1. Part number: 58010077001. For more information, see Flexible waveguide specifications on page 4-9.

Table 57 Remote mounting kits Band 6 GHZ 7 GHz 8 GHz 11 13 GHZ 15 GHz 18 26 GHz 28 32 GHz 38 GHz Output UDR70 UBR84 UBR84 UBR120 UBR140 UBR220 UBR320 UBR320 Cambium part number 07010109008 07010109001 07010109002 07010109003 07010109004 07010109005 07010109006 07010109007

Table 58 Flexible waveguides Band Cambium part number 58010076016 Attenuation VSWR Flanges (RMK/ antenna) PDR70 CPR137G Max twist Min bend radius (E/H plane) E: 102 mm (4.0 in) H: 204 mm (8.0 in)

6 GHz

0.3 dB/m

1.10

214/m

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-71

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Band

Cambium part number 58010076017

Attenuation

VSWR

Flanges (RMK/ antenna) PDR70 UDR70

Max twist

Min bend radius (E/H plane) E: 102 mm (4.0 in) H: 204 mm (8.0 in) E: 76 mm (3.0 in) H: 152 mm (6.0 in) E: 64 mm (2.5 in) H: 115 mm (4.5 in) E: 64 mm (2.5 in) H: 127 mm (5 in)

6 GHz

0.3 dB/m

1.10

214/m

7 GHz 8 GHz

58010076019

0.4 dB/m

1.10

PBR84 UDR84

264/m

11 GHz 13 GHz

58010076005

0.6 dB/m

1.10

PBR120 UBR120

360/m

11 GHz 13 GHz

58010076018

0.43 dB/m

1.10

PDR100 CPR90G

310/m

15 GHz

58010076008

0.99 dB/m

1.10

PBR140 UBR140

445/m

E: 52 mm (2 in) H: 102 mm (4 in) E: 38 mm (1.5 in) H: 76 mm (3.0 in) E: 38 mm (1.5 in) H: 76 mm (3.0 in)

18 GHz 23 GHz 26 GHz 28 GHz 32 GHz 38 GHz

58010076011

2.6 dB/m

1.25

PBR220 UBR220

510/m

58010076014

3.3 dB/m

1.30

PBR320 UBR320

510/m

2-72

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Table 59 Flex-twist hanger kits available from Cambium Accessory WR137 flex-twist hanger kit WR112 flex-twist hanger kit WR90 flex-twist hanger kit WR75 flex-twist hanger kit WR62 flex-twist hanger kit WR42 flex-twist hanger kit WR28 flex-twist hanger kit Frequency variant 6 GHz 7 8 GHz 11 13 GHz 11 13 GHz 15 GHz 18 26 GHz 28 38 GHz Cambium part number 07010118001 07010118002 (*) 07010118003 07010118004 07010118005 07010118006

(*) Not yet available from Cambium. Order from CommScope, part number 244106A-100.

Ordering coupler mounting kits


Determine the number of coupler mounting kits required per link, as follows: 1+0 links: not required. 1+1 Hot Standby links without antenna protection: 2 coupler mounting kits. 1+1 Hot Standby links with antenna protection: not required. 2+0 co-polar links: 2 symmetric coupler mounting kits. 2+0 cross-polar links: not required.

Select symmetric or asymmetric couplers. Select coupler mounting kits from Table 60. Table 60 ODU coupler mounting kits Band 6 GHz 6 GHz 7 GHz 7 GHz 8 GHz Coupler type 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric Cambium part number 07010110021 07010110022 07010110001 07010110002 07010110003

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-73

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Band 8 GHz 11 GHz 11 GHz 13 GHz 13 GHz 15 GHz 15 GHz 18 GHz 18 GHz 23 GHz 23 GHz 26 GHz 26 GHz 28 GHz 28 GHz 32 GHz 32 GHz 38 GHz 38 GHz

Coupler type 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric

Cambium part number 07010110004 07010110005 07010110006 07010110007 07010110008 07010110009 07010110010 07010110011 07010110012 07010110013 07010110014 07010110015 07010110016 07010110023 07010110024 07010110017 07010110018 07010110019 07010110020

2-74

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Ordering components

Ordering OMKs
To upgrade any standard antenna to support a direct mount interface in a 2+0 cross-polar or 2+0 XPIC link, purchase an orthogonal mount kit (OMK). Select an OMK that is in the same band as the antenna that it is upgrading; for example, use a 6 GHz OMK to upgrade a 6 GHz antenna. Select OMKs from Table 61. Table 61 Orthogonal mounting kits (OMKs) Band 6 GHz 7 GHz and 8 GHz 11 GHz 13 GHz 15 GHz 18 GHz 23 GHz Cambium part number 85009316001 85009316002 85009316004 85009316005 85009316006 85009316007 85009316008

Cambium also supply dual-polar direct mount antennas complete with orthogonal mode transducers for 2+0 cross-polar links. See Ordering antennas on page 2-44.

Ordering network connection components


Select network connection components from Table 62 (copper interfaces) or Table 63 (fiber interfaces). Table 62 Copper network cables and connectors Item Screened Cat5e cable Cambium part number and notes To minimise radiated emissions, use screened Cat5e cable for all copper connections from the MMU Ethernet ports (Data or Management) to any network switch. Two required per Cat5e cable.

RJ45 connectors

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

2-75

Ordering components

Chapter 2: Planning considerations

Table 63 Fiber network cables and connectors Item Fiber cable and connectors Cambium part number and notes If a fiber interface between the MMU and Ethernet switch is required, then fiber cable and connectors are needed (not supplied by Cambium). If a fiber interface between the MMU and Ethernet switch is required, then two SFP modules are needed. Either: SFP SX Gig-E Optical Pluggable Module - 850 nm. Cambium part number 01010430001. Or: SFP LX Gig-E Optical Pluggable Module 1310 nm. Cambium part number 01010431001.

SFP Gig-E fiber pluggable module

2-76

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Chapter 3: Legal information


This chapter provides legal notices including software license agreements.

Changes or modifications must not be made to the equipment without the express consent of the party responsible for compliance. Any such modifications could void the users authority to operate the equipment and will void the manufacturers warranty. The following topics are described in this section: Cambium Networks end user license agreement on page 3-2 Limit of liability on page 3-9

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

3-1

Cambium Networks end user license agreement

Chapter 3: Legal information

Cambium Networks end user license agreement


Acceptance of this agreement
In connection with Cambiums delivery of certain proprietary software or products containing embedded or pre-loaded proprietary software, or both, Cambium is willing to license this certain proprietary software and the accompanying documentation to you only on the condition that you accept all the terms in this End User License Agreement (Agreement). IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THE TERMS OF THIS AGREEMENT, DO NOT USE THE PRODUCT OR INSTALL THE SOFTWARE. INSTEAD, YOU MAY, FOR A FULL REFUND, RETURN THIS PRODUCT TO THE LOCATION WHERE YOU ACQUIRED IT OR PROVIDE WRITTEN VERIFICATION OF DELETION OF ALL COPIES OF THE SOFTWARE. ANY USE OF THE SOFTWARE, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO USE ON THE PRODUCT, WILL CONSTITUTE YOUR ACCEPTANCE TO THE TERMS OF THIS AGREEMENT.

Definitions
In this Agreement, the word Software refers to the set of instructions for computers, in executable form and in any media, (which may include diskette, CD-ROM, downloadable internet, hardware, or firmware) licensed to you. The word Documentation refers to electronic or printed manuals and accompanying instructional aids licensed to you. The word Product refers to Cambiums fixed wireless broadband devices for which the Software and Documentation is licensed for use.

Grant of license
Cambium Networks Limited (Cambium) grants you (Licensee or you) a personal, nonexclusive, non-transferable license to use the Software and Documentation subject to the Conditions of Use set forth in Conditions of use and the terms and conditions of this Agreement. Any terms or conditions relating to the Software and Documentation appearing on the face or reverse side of any purchase order, purchase order acknowledgment or other order document that are different from, or in addition to, the terms of this Agreement will not be binding on the parties, even if payment is accepted.

3-2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Cambium Networks end user license agreement

Conditions of use
Any use of the Software and Documentation outside of the conditions set forth in this Agreement is strictly prohibited and will be deemed a breach of this Agreement. 1. Only you, your employees or agents may use the Software and Documentation. You will take all necessary steps to insure that your employees and agents abide by the terms of this Agreement. 2. You will use the Software and Documentation (i) only for your internal business purposes; (ii) only as described in the Software and Documentation; and (iii) in strict accordance with this Agreement. 3. You may use the Software and Documentation, provided that the use is in conformance with the terms set forth in this Agreement. 4. Portions of the Software and Documentation are protected by United States copyright laws, international treaty provisions, and other applicable laws. Therefore, you must treat the Software like any other copyrighted material (for example, a book or musical recording) except that you may either: (i) make 1 copy of the transportable part of the Software (which typically is supplied on diskette, CD-ROM, or downloadable internet), solely for back-up purposes; or (ii) copy the transportable part of the Software to a PC hard disk, provided you keep the original solely for back-up purposes. If the Documentation is in printed form, it may not be copied. If the Documentation is in electronic form, you may print out 1 copy, which then may not be copied. With regard to the copy made for backup or archival purposes, you agree to reproduce any Cambium copyright notice, and other proprietary legends appearing thereon. Such copyright notice(s) may appear in any of several forms, including machine-readable form, and you agree to reproduce such notice in each form in which it appears, to the extent it is physically possible to do so. Unauthorized duplication of the Software or Documentation constitutes copyright infringement, and in the United States is punishable in federal court by fine and imprisonment. 5. You will not transfer, directly or indirectly, any product, technical data or software to any country for which the United States Government requires an export license or other governmental approval without first obtaining such license or approval.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

3-3

Cambium Networks end user license agreement

Chapter 3: Legal information

Title and restrictions


If you transfer possession of any copy of the Software and Documentation to another party outside of the terms of this agreement, your license is automatically terminated. Title and copyrights to the Software and Documentation and any copies made by you remain with Cambium and its licensors. You will not, and will not permit others to: (i) modify, translate, decompile, bootleg, reverse engineer, disassemble, or extract the inner workings of the Software or Documentation, (ii) copy the look-and-feel or functionality of the Software or Documentation; (iii) remove any proprietary notices, marks, labels, or logos from the Software or Documentation; (iv) rent or transfer all or some of the Software or Documentation to any other party without Cambiums prior written consent; or (v) utilize any computer software or hardware which is designed to defeat any copy protection device, should the Software and Documentation be equipped with such a protection device. If the Software and Documentation is provided on multiple types of media (such as diskette, CD-ROM, downloadable internet), then you will only use the medium which best meets your specific needs, and will not loan, rent, lease, or transfer the other media contained in the package without Cambiums written consent. Unauthorized copying of the Software or Documentation, or failure to comply with any of the provisions of this Agreement, will result in automatic termination of this license.

Confidentiality
You acknowledge that all Software and Documentation contain valuable proprietary information and trade secrets and that unauthorized or improper use of the Software and Documentation will result in irreparable harm to Cambium for which monetary damages would be inadequate and for which Cambium will be entitled to immediate injunctive relief. If applicable, you will limit access to the Software and Documentation to those of your employees and agents who need to use the Software and Documentation for your internal business purposes, and you will take appropriate action with those employees and agents to preserve the confidentiality of the Software and Documentation, using the same degree of care to avoid unauthorized or improper disclosure as you use for the protection of your own proprietary software, but in no event less than reasonable care. You have no obligation to preserve the confidentiality of any proprietary information that: (i) was in the public domain at the time of disclosure; (ii) entered the public domain through no fault of yours; (iii) was given to you free of any obligation to keep it confidential; (iv) is independently developed by you; or (v) is disclosed as required by law provided that you notify Cambium prior to such disclosure and provide Cambium with a reasonable opportunity to respond.

3-4

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Cambium Networks end user license agreement

Right to use Cambiums name


Except as required in Conditions of use, you will not, during the term of this Agreement or thereafter, use any trademark of Cambium Networks, or any word or symbol likely to be confused with any Cambium Networks trademark, either alone or in any combination with another word or words.

Transfer
The Software and Documentation may not be transferred to another party without the express written consent of Cambium, regardless of whether or not such transfer is accomplished by physical or electronic means. Cambiums consent may be withheld at its discretion and may be conditioned upon transferee paying all applicable license fees and agreeing to be bound by this Agreement.

Updates
During the first 12 months after purchase of a Product, or during the term of any executed Maintenance and Support Agreement for the Product, you are entitled to receive Updates. An Update means any code in any form which is a bug fix, patch, error correction, or minor enhancement, but excludes any major feature added to the Software. Updates are available for download at the support website. Major features may be available from time to time for an additional license fee. If Cambium makes available to you major features and no other end user license agreement is provided, then the terms of this Agreement will apply.

Maintenance
Except as provided above, Cambium is not responsible for maintenance or field service of the Software under this Agreement.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

3-5

Cambium Networks end user license agreement

Chapter 3: Legal information

Disclaimer
CAMBIUM DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS, IMPLIED, STATUTORY, OR IN ANY COMMUNICATION WITH YOU. CAMBIUM SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ANY WARRANTY INCLUDING THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILTY, NONINFRINGEMENT, OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE SOFTWARE AND DOCUMENTATION ARE PROVIDED AS IS. CAMBIUM DOES NOT WARRANT THAT THE SOFTWARE WILL MEET YOUR REQUIREMENTS, OR THAT THE OPERATION OF THE SOFTWARE WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR FREE, OR THAT DEFECTS IN THE SOFTWARE WILL BE CORRECTED. CAMBIUM MAKES NO WARRANTY WITH RESPECT TO THE CORRECTNESS, ACCURACY, OR RELIABILITY OF THE SOFTWARE AND DOCUMENTATION. Some jurisdictions do not allow the exclusion of implied warranties, so the above exclusion may not apply to you.

Limitation of liability
THE TOTAL LIABILITY OF CAMBIUM UNDER THIS AGREEMENT FOR DAMAGES WILL NOT EXCEED THE TOTAL AMOUNT PAID BY YOU FOR THE PRODUCT LICENSED UNDER THIS AGREEMENT. IN NO EVENT WILL CAMBIUM BE LIABLE IN ANY WAY FOR INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, INDIRECT, SPECIAL OR PUNITIVE DAMAGES OF ANY NATURE, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, LOST BUSINESS PROFITS, OR LIABILITY OR INJURY TO THIRD PERSONS, WHETHER FORESEEABLE OR NOT, REGARDLESS OF WHETHER CAMBIUM HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBLITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Some jurisdictions do not permit limitations of liability for incidental or consequential damages, so the above exclusions may not apply to you.

3-6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Cambium Networks end user license agreement

U.S. government
If you are acquiring the Product on behalf of any unit or agency of the U.S. Government, the following applies. Use, duplication, or disclosure of the Software and Documentation is subject to the restrictions set forth in subparagraphs (c) (1) and (2) of the Commercial Computer Software Restricted Rights clause at FAR 52.227-19 (JUNE 1987), if applicable, unless being provided to the Department of Defense. If being provided to the Department of Defense, use, duplication, or disclosure of the Products is subject to the restricted rights set forth in subparagraph (c) (1) (ii) of the Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software clause at DFARS 252.227-7013 (OCT 1988), if applicable. Software and Documentation may or may not include a Restricted Rights notice, or other notice referring specifically to the terms and conditions of this Agreement. The terms and conditions of this Agreement will each continue to apply, but only to the extent that such terms and conditions are not inconsistent with the rights provided to you under the aforementioned provisions of the FAR and DFARS, as applicable to the particular procuring agency and procurement transaction.

Term of license
Your right to use the Software will continue in perpetuity unless terminated as follows. Your right to use the Software will terminate immediately without notice upon a breach of this Agreement by you. Within 30 days after termination of this Agreement, you will certify to Cambium in writing that through your best efforts, and to the best of your knowledge, the original and all copies, in whole or in part, in any form, of the Software and all related material and Documentation, have been destroyed, except that, with prior written consent from Cambium, you may retain one copy for archival or backup purposes. You may not sublicense, assign or transfer the license or the Product, except as expressly provided in this Agreement. Any attempt to otherwise sublicense, assign or transfer any of the rights, duties or obligations hereunder is null and void.

Governing law
This Agreement is governed by the laws of the United States of America to the extent that they apply and otherwise by the laws of the State of Illinois.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

3-7

Cambium Networks end user license agreement

Chapter 3: Legal information

Assignment
This agreement may not be assigned by you without Cambiums prior written consent.

Survival of provisions
The parties agree that where the context of any provision indicates an intent that it survives the term of this Agreement, then it will survive.

Entire agreement
This agreement contains the parties entire agreement regarding your use of the Software and may be amended only in writing signed by both parties, except that Cambium may modify this Agreement as necessary to comply with applicable laws.

Third party software


The software may contain one or more items of Third-Party Software supplied by other third-party suppliers. The terms of this Agreement govern your use of any Third-Party Software UNLESS A SEPARATE THIRD-PARTY SOFTWARE LICENSE IS INCLUDED, IN WHICH CASE YOUR USE OF THE THIRD-PARTY SOFTWARE WILL THEN BE GOVERNED BY THE SEPARATE THIRD-PARTY LICENSE.

Licenses and attributions


The document PTP 810 Third Party Licenses and Attributions contains licenses and attributions for third party software components that are incorporated into the PTP 810 product. This document is available for download from the support website (see Contacting Cambium Networks on page 2). To gain access to source code licensed under the GPL, please contact Cambium via the support web site (see Contacting Cambium Networks on page 2).

3-8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Limit of liability

Limit of liability
IN NO EVENT SHALL CAMBIUM NETWORKS BE LIABLE TO YOU OR ANY OTHER PARTY FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, EXEMPLARY OR OTHER DAMAGE ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PRODUCT (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF BUSINESS PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, LOSS OF BUSINESS INFORMATION OR ANY OTHER PECUNIARY LOSS, OR FROM ANY BREACH OF WARRANTY, EVEN IF CAMBIUM HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. (Some states do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damages, so the above exclusion or limitation may not apply to you.) IN NO CASE SHALL CAMBIUMS LIABILITY EXCEED THE AMOUNT YOU PAID FOR THE PRODUCT.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

3-9

Limit of liability

Chapter 3: Legal information

3-10

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Chapter 4: Reference information


This chapter describes the physical, environmental, safety, wireless and electromagnetic specifications for PTP 810. The following topics are described in this chapter: Equipment specifications on page 4-2 contains specifications of the MMU, ODU and other equipment supplied by Cambium for PTP 810 installations. It also specifies the MMU front panel connectors. Wireless specifications on page 4-23 contains specifications of the PTP 810 wireless interface, including RF bands, channel width and link loss. Data network specifications on page 4-73 contains specifications for the PTP 810 Ethernet interfaces. Network management specifications on page 4-77 lists supported SNMP objects from the standard MIB-II, IF-MIB and Bridge-MIB. Electromagnetic compliance on page 4-79 describes how the PTP 810 complies with the regulations that are in force in various countries, and contains notifications made to regulatory bodies for the PTP 810. Radiation hazard assessment on page 4-83 evaluates the radiation levels produced by the PTP 810 products against ETSI and FCC standards.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-1

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Equipment specifications
This section contains specifications of the MMU, ODU and other equipment supplied by Cambium for PTP 810 installations. It also specifies the MMU front panel connectors.

MMU specifications
The PTP 810 MMU base models conform to the specifications listed in Table 64, Table 65 and Table 66.

Table 64 MMU physical specifications Category Dimensions Weight Specification Width 44.5 cm (17.5 in), Height 4.45 cm (1.75 in), Depth 23.85 cm (9.4 in) 3.12 kg (7 lbs)

Table 65 MMU environmental specifications Category Temperature Humidity Specification 5 C to 55 C 95% non-condensing

Table 66 MMU electrical specifications Category Input voltage MMU dissipation Specification 41 V to 60 V dc Max. 40 W (single modem) Max. 61 W (dual modem)

4-2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

The MMU and ODU power consumption figures are specified in Table 67 (1+0), Table 68 (1+1) and Table 69 (2+0). The following abbreviations are used in these tables: Standard means PTP810 MMU Standard, 2xFE + 16xE1/T1. GigE means PTP810 MMU GigE, 4xGigE + 1xGigE SFP + 2xE1/T1. Standard Dual Modem means PTP810 MMU Standard Dual Modem, 2xFE + 16xE1/T1. GigE Dual Modem means PTP810 MMU GigE, Dual Modem, 4xGigE + 1xGigE SFP + 2xE1/T1.

Table 67 Worst case power consumption for 1+0 link types Base module (*1) Expansion I/O module ODU-A, 6 11 GHz (W) 93.9 16xE1/T1 96.3 97.5 16xE1/T1 99.9 ODU-A, 13 38 GHz (W) 84.9 87.3 88.5 90.9 ODU-B, 6 11 GHz (W) 80.9 83.3 84.5 86.9 ODU-B, 13 18 GHz (W) 72.9 75.3 76.5 78.9 ODU-B, 23 38 GHz (W) 78.9 81.3 82.5 84.9

Standard Standard GigE GigE

Table 68 Worst case power consumption for 1+1 link types (*1) Base module Expansion I/O module ODU-A, 6 11 GHz (W) 147.5 16xE1/T1 151.1 149.5 16xE1/T1 153.5 ODU-A, 13 38 GHz (W) 138.5 142.1 140.5 144.5 ODU-B, 6 11 GHz (W) 125.5 129.1 127.5 131.5 ODU-B, 13 18 GHz (W) 117.5 121.1 119.5 123.5 ODU-B, 23 38 GHz (W) 123.5 127.1 125.5 129.5

Standard Dual Modem Standard Dual Modem GigE Dual Modem GigE Dual Modem

(*1) 1+1 includes: 1+1 Hot Standby and 1+1 Hot Standby with Spatial Diversity.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-3

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 69 Worst case power consumption for 2+0 link types (*1) Base module Expansion I/O module ODU-A, 6 11 GHz (W) 171.2 16xE1/T1 174.8 173.3 16xE1/T1 177.2 ODU-A, 13 38 GHz (W) 153.2 156.8 155.3 159.2 ODU-B, 6 11 GHz (W) 145.2 148.8 147.3 151.2 ODU-B, 13 18 GHz (W) 129.2 132.8 131.3 135.2 ODU-B, 23 38 GHz (W) 141.2 144.8 143.3 147.2

Standard Dual Modem Standard Dual Modem GigE Dual Modem GigE Dual Modem

(*1) 2+0 includes: Dual 1+0, 2+0 co-polar, 2+0 cross-polar and 2+0 XPIC.

AC to DC converter specifications
The PTP 810 AC to DC converter conforms to the specifications listed in Table 70. Table 70 AC to DC converter specifications Category Input range Output voltage Maximum output power Line frequency Inrush current Input current Power conversion efficiency Electromagnetic compatibility Safety ground leakage current Hold-up time Overvoltage protection Overcurrent protection Specification 90 to 260 V ac (wide range) Single output -48 V dc nominal 130 W 47 to 63 Hz 60 A maximum at 230 V ac, cold start 25C 1.7 A maximum, Io = Full Load, 230 V ac 80% typical FCC Part 15, Subpart B Class A EN55022 (CISPR 22) Class A 0.75 mA maximum, Io = Full Load, 240 V ac input 50 ms minimum, Io = Full Load, Vin = 110 V ac 112% to 132%, crowbar design 110% to 150%

4-4

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

Category Output power dissipation Operating humidity Temperature

Specification Derate linearly from 100% load at 25 C to 50% load at 70C 95% maximum 0C to 70C

The AC to DC converter is only suitable for operation with MMUs fitted with a single modem and only up to an MMU temperature of 40C.

ODU specifications
The ODU conforms to the specifications listed in Table 71 and Table 72. Table 71 ODU physical specifications Category Dimensions Weight ODU-A Diameter 26.7 cm (10.5 in), Depth 8.9 cm (3.5 in) 4.6 kg (10.1 lbs) ODU-B Diameter 25.2 cm (9.9 in), Depth 9.2 cm (3.6 in) 3.9 kg (8.6 lbs)

Table 72 ODU-A and ODU-B environmental specifications Category Temperature Humidity Waterproof UV Exposure Specification 33C to 55C (cold start at -45C) 100% condensing IP67 10 year operational life (UL746C test evidence)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-5

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

RSSI output
Table 73 specifies the voltage measured at the RSSI connector of the ODU for each combination of received signal level (dBm) and channel separation or bandwidth (MHz). This table applies to ODU-A and ODU-B. Table 73 RSSI voltage, received signal level and bandwidth RSL (dBm) Channel separation 7, 13.75, 14, 27.5, 28, 29.65, 55, 56, 60 or 80 MHz 4.54 4.48 4.41 4.35 4.29 4.22 4.16 4.10 4.03 3.97 3.90 3.84 3.78 3.71 3.65 3.59 3.52 3.46 3.40 3.33 3.27 3.21 3.14 Bandwidth 10, 20 or 40 MHz 4.63 4.57 4.50 4.44 4.38 4.31 4.25 4.19 4.12 4.06 4.00 3.93 3.87 3.81 3.74 3.68 3.62 3.55 3.49 3.43 3.36 3.30 3.24 Bandwidth 30 MHz Bandwidth 50 MHz

-20 -21 -22 -23 -24 -25 -26 -27 -28 -29 -30 -31 -32 -33 -34 -35 -36 -37 -38 -39 -40 -41 -42
4-6

4.71 4.65 4.58 4.52 4.46 4.39 4.33 4.27 4.20 4.14 4.08 4.01 3.95 3.89 3.82 3.76 3.70 3.63 3.57 3.51 3.44 3.38 3.32

4.57 4.51 4.44 4.38 4.32 4.25 4.19 4.13 4.06 4.00 3.94 3.87 3.81 3.75 3.68 3.62 3.56 3.49 3.43 3.37 3.30 3.24 3.18
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

RSL (dBm)

Channel separation 7, 13.75, 14, 27.5, 28, 29.65, 55, 56, 60 or 80 MHz 3.08 3.02 2.95 2.89 2.83 2.76 2.70 2.64 2.57 2.51 2.45 2.38 2.32 2.26 2.19 2.13 2.07 2.00 1.94 1.88 1.81 1.75 1.69 1.62 1.56 1.50 1.43 1.37

Bandwidth 10, 20 or 40 MHz 3.17 3.11 3.05 2.98 2.92 2.86 2.79 2.73 2.67 2.60 2.54 2.48 2.41 2.35 2.29 2.22 2.16 2.10 2.03 1.97 1.90 1.84 1.78 1.71 1.65 1.59 1.52 1.46

Bandwidth 30 MHz

Bandwidth 50 MHz

-43 -44 -45 -46 -47 -48 -49 -50 -51 -52 -53 -54 -55 -56 -57 -58 -59 -60 -61 -62 -63 -64 -65 -66 -67 -68 -69 -70

3.25 3.19 3.13 3.06 3.00 2.94 2.87 2.81 2.75 2.68 2.62 2.55 2.49 2.43 2.36 2.30 2.24 2.17 2.11 2.05 1.98 1.92 1.86 1.79 1.73 1.67 1.60 1.54

3.11 3.05 2.98 2.92 2.86 2.79 2.73 2.67 2.60 2.54 2.48 2.41 2.35 2.29 2.22 2.16 2.10 2.03 1.97 1.91 1.84 1.78 1.72 1.65 1.59 1.53 1.46 1.40

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-7

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

RSL (dBm)

Channel separation 7, 13.75, 14, 27.5, 28, 29.65, 55, 56, 60 or 80 MHz 1.31 1.24 1.18 1.11 1.05 0.99 0.92 0.86 0.80 0.73 0.67 0.61 0.54 0.48 0.42 0.35 0.29 0.23 0.16 0.10

Bandwidth 10, 20 or 40 MHz 1.40 1.33 1.27 1.21 1.14 1.08 1.02 0.95 0.89 0.83 0.76 0.70 0.64 0.57 0.51 0.45 0.38 0.32 0.26 0.19

Bandwidth 30 MHz

Bandwidth 50 MHz

-71 -72 -73 -74 -75 -76 -77 -78 -79 -80 -81 -82 -83 -84 -85 -86 -87 -88 -89 -90

1.48 1.41 1.35 1.29 1.22 1.16 1.10 1.03 0.97 0.91 0.84 0.78 0.72 0.65 0.59 0.53 0.46 0.40 0.34 0.27

1.34 1.27 1.21 1.15 1.08 1.02 0.96 0.89 0.83 0.77 0.70 0.64 0.58 0.51 0.45 0.39 0.32 0.26 0.19 0.13

4-8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

Flexible waveguide specifications


Waveguide flanges
Figure 54 shows the locations of the flanges on the antenna, transition, waveguide and remote mounting kit (RMK). The numbers (1 to 4) refer to Table 74.

11 GHz antennas with a CPR90G interface need a different flexible waveguide and have the tapered transition next to the RMK not the antenna. Figure 54 Locations of waveguide flanges

The numbered call-outs in Figure 54 are: 1. Antenna flange 2. Tapered transition flanges 3. Flexible waveguide flanges 4. RMK flange

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-9

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Flanges for each frequency variant


Table 74 specifies the antenna, transition, waveguide and RMK flanges for each frequency variant. Table 74 Antenna, transition, waveguide and RMK flanges 1 Antenna flange PDR70 CPR137G PDR84 PDR84 PDR100 CPR90G PBR120 PBR140 PBR220 PBR220 PBR220 PBR320 PBR320 2 Tapered transition flanges n/a n/a n/a n/a UDR100/ PBR120 UDR100/ PBR120 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 3 Waveguide flange (antenna) UDR70 CPR137G UDR84 UDR84 UBR120 CPR90G UBR120 UBR140 UBR220 UBR220 UBR220 UBR320 UBR320 3 Waveguide flange (ODU) PDR70 PDR70 PBR84 PBR84 PBR120 PDR100 PBR120 PBR140 PBR220 PBR220 PBR220 PBR320 PBR320 4 RMK flange UDR70 UDR70 UBR84 UBR84 UBR120 UBR120 UBR120 UBR140 UBR220 UBR220 UBR220 UBR320 UBR320

Frequency

Wave guide size WR137 WR137 WR112 WR112 WR75 WR90 WR75 WR62 WR42 WR42 WR42 WR28 WR28

6 GHz (*) 6 GHz (*) 7 GHz 8 GHz 11 GHz 11 GHz 13 GHz 15 GHz 18 GHz 23 GHz 26 GHz 32 GHz 38 GHz

(*) These flanges are used for both Lower 6 GHz and Upper 6 GHz.

4-10

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

Waveguide flange diagrams


Waveguide flanges are illustrated in Figure 55 (Lower and Upper 6 GHz), Figure 56 (7 to 15 GHz), Figure 57 (18 to 38 GHz) and Figure 58 (11 GHz tapered transition). Figure 55 Waveguide flanges 6 GHz

RMK Side Flange


49.3

Antenna Side Flange

6 GHz

PDR70
49.3

UDR70

6 GHz

PDR70

CPR137G

Note that the CPR137G has the same overall dimensions as the PDR70 but with a shallower groove depth.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-11

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Figure 56 Waveguide flanges 7 to 15 GHz

4-12

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

Figure 57 Waveguide flanges 18 to 38 GHz

Figure 58 Waveguide flanges 11 GHz tapered transition

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-13

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Torque values for waveguide flanges


To obtain the correct torque values for fastening waveguides, refer to Table 75. Table 75 Torque value in Nm (lb ft) for each fastener size Material Stainless steel M3 0.9 (0.6) M4 2.2 (1.6) M5 4.5 (3.3) M6 7.7 (5.7) M8 18.7 (13.8)

Coupler mounting kit specifications


The ODU coupler mounting kits conform to the specifications listed in Table 76 and Table 77.

Table 76 ODU coupler physical specifications Category Packed dimensions Weight Specification 250 x 280 x 390 (W x L x H) mm 10 x 11 x 15.5 (W x L x H) ins 6 GHz band: 7 GHz to 11 GHz bands: 4.6 kg (10.1 lbs) 13 GHz to 38 GHz bands: 4.2 kg (9.3 lbs)

Table 77 ODU coupler environmental specifications Category Temperature Relative humidity Weatherproofing Exposure Shock and Vibration Specification 40C to 50C 0% to 100% IP67 Salt mist, industrial atmospheres and UV radiation ETSI EN 300 019-2-4 (class 4.1E) IEC class 4M5

4-14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

Coupler losses and isolation


Table 78 contains ODU port return losses and isolation figures for Cambium-supplied ODU couplers. These figures apply to both symmetric and asymmetric couplers. Table 78 ODU coupler return losses and isolation Bands 6 GHz 7 GHz to 38 GHz ODU port return loss 18 dB minimum 20 dB maximum Isolation between ODU ports 20 dB minimum 20 dB minimum

Table 79 contains ODU port insertion losses for Cambium-supplied ODU couplers. Table 79 ODU coupler insertion losses Bands 6 GHz Coupler type 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 7 GHz to 26 GHz 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric 32 GHz to 38 GHz 3 dB symmetric 6 dB asymmetric Main 1.9 dB, Standby 6.5 dB 3.8 dB Main 1.8 dB, Standby 7.2 dB 4.0 dB Main 2.0 dB, Standby 7.4 dB ODU port maximum insertion losses

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-15

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

MMU front panel connectors


This section contains specifications for the PTP 810 MMU front panel connectors. Table 80 DC Input (power) connector (Power Supply module) Interface MSTB 2,5/ 2-GF Pin 1 2 Type POWER POWER Signal Power supply return -48 V dc nominal

Table 81 Ethernet 100Base-T payload connector 1-2 (Master I/O module) Interface RJ-45 female Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Type INPUT INPUT OUTPUT N/A N/A OUTPUT N/A N/A Signal RX+ RXTX+ N/A N/A TXN/A N/A

4-16

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

Table 82 Ethernet 1000Base-T payload connector 1-4 (GigE Master I/O module) Interface RJ-45 female Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Type I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O Signal DB+ DBDC+ DADA+ DCDD+ DD-

Table 83 Gigabit Ethernet optical SFP connector (GigE Master I/O module) Interface LC Duplex Fiber Pin TX Type OUTPUT Signal 1000Base-SX/LX/ZX payload output (optical)

RX

INPUT

1000Base-SX/LX/ZX payload input (optical)

Table 84 NMS 10/100Base-TX connector 1-2 (Control module) Interface RJ-45 female Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Type OUTPUT OUTPUT INPUT N/A N/A INPUT N/A N/A Signal TX+ TXRX+ N/A N/A RXN/A N/A

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-17

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 85 Serial/Alarm port connector (Control module) Interface DB-15HD female Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Type OUTPUT INPUT/OUTPUT OUTPUT/INPUT OUTPUT N/A N/A N/A N/A INPUT INPUT N/A N/A N/A INPUT INPUT Signal TTL Alarm Output 3 RS-232 RX/TX RS-232 TX/RX TTL Alarm Output 4 GROUND Alarm 1 Form C Contact Normally Open Alarm 1 Form C Contact Normally Closed Alarm 2 Form C Contact Common TTL Alarm Input 1 TTL Alarm Input 3 Alarm 1 Form C Contact Common Alarm 2 Form C Contact Normally Open Alarm 2 Form C Contact Normally Closed TTL Alarm Input 2 TTL Alarm Input 4

Table 86 E1/T1 - channels 1-2 connector (Master I/O module) Interface Pin Type Signal

RJ-48 female 100 /120 b alanced

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

INPUT INPUT N/A OUTPUT OUTPUT N/A N/A N/A

RX+ RXGND TX+ TXGND N/A N/A

The interface used for the E1/T1 - Channels 3-16 (Table 87) is the Molex LFH Matrix 50 Receptacle 100 /120 Balanced connector (Figure 59).

4-18

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

Figure 59 Molex LFH Matrix 50 Receptacle 100 /120 Balanced interface

Table 87 E1/T1 - channels 3-16 connector (Master I/O module) Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 Type OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT NC NC OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT Signal T1 Channel 13 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 14 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 15 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 16 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 9 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 10 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 11 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 12 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 5 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 6 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 7 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 8 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 3 Transmit Tip T1 Channel 4 Transmit Tip NC NC T1 Channel 4 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 3 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 8 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 7 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 6 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 5 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 12 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 11 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 10 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 9 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 16 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 15 Transmit Ring
4-19

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Pin 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60

Type OUTPUT OUTPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT NC NC INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT INPUT

Signal T1 Channel 14 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 13 Transmit Ring T1 Channel 16 Receive Tip T1 Channel 15 Receive Tip T1 Channel 9 Receive Tip T1 Channel 14 Receive Tip T1 Channel 10 Receive Tip T1 Channel 13 Receive Tip T1 Channel 11 Receive Tip T1 Channel 4 Receive Tip T1 Channel 12 Receive Tip T1 Channel 3 Receive Tip T1 Channel 5 Receive Tip T1 Channel 8 Receive Tip T1 Channel 6 Receive Tip T1 Channel 7 Receive Tip NC NC T1 Channel 7 Receive Ring T1 Channel 6 Receive Ring T1 Channel 8 Receive Ring T1 Channel 5 Receive Ring T1 Channel 3 Receive Ring T1 Channel 12 Receive Ring T1 Channel 4 Receive Ring T1 Channel 11 Receive Ring T1 Channel 13 Receive Ring T1 Channel 10 Receive Ring T1 Channel 14 Receive Ring T1 Channel 9 Receive Ring T1 Channel 15 Receive Ring T1 Channel 16 Receive Ring

4-20

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Equipment specifications

Figure 60 Data order wire - RS-422 connector Interface RJ-45 female Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Type OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT INPUT INPUT OUTPUT INPUT INPUT Signal TX Clock TX Clock + TX Data RX Data RX Data + TX Data + RX Clock RX Clock +

Figure 61 Data order wire - RS-232 connector Interface RJ-45 female Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Type N/A N/A N/A N/A INPUT OUTPUT N/A N/A Signal NC NC Signal GND NC RX Data + TX Data + NC NC

Figure 62 XPIC connector (Modem module) Interface RJ-45 female Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Type OUTPUT OUTPUT OUTPUT INPUT INPUT OUTPUT INPUT INPUT Signal XPIC IXPIC IXPIC QXPIC IXPIC IXPIC QXPIC QXPIC Q-

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-21

Equipment specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Figure 63 ODU connector (Modem module) Interface TNC coaxial female Pin Center Type I/O Signal 350 MHz TX IF / 140 MHz RX IF / -48 V dc

Shield

N/A

Shield / Chassis GND

4-22

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Wireless specifications
This section contains specifications of the PTP 810 wireless interface, including RF bands, channel width and link loss.

General wireless specifications


The PTP 810 conforms to the general wireless specifications listed in Table 88. Table 88 General wireless specifications Feature Channel separation (ETSI) Channel bandwidth (FCC/IC) Modulation Duplex scheme Capacity options Specification 7, 13.75, 14, 27.5, 28, 29.65, 30, 40, 55, 56 or 60 MHz. 10, 20, 30, 40, 50 or 80 MHz. QPSK, 16QAM, 32QAM, 64QAM, 128QAM and 256QAM. Fixed or adaptive modulation. Frequency division duplex. Basic capacity is 10 Mbps in each link direction. May be upgraded via software license key to one of the following capacity levels: 20, 30, 40, 50, 100, 150, 200, 300, 400 or 600 Mbps. Latency APC Ultra-low latency, <130 us @ 300 Mbps with 64 bytes frame. Supported in all configurations apart from XPIC.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-23

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Frequency bands and channel separation


EN 302 217 refers to the relevant ITU-R and CEPT recommendations which are appropriate for operation in ETSI regions. These are summarized in Table 89. Table 89 ETSI band plan Band Frequency range (GHz) 5.925-6.425 6.425-7.100 Channel separation (MHz) 29.65 30, 40, 60 7, 14 7.125-7.9 7.725 8.5 7, 14, 28 7, 14, 28 29.65 11 GHz 13 GHz 15 GHz 10.7-11.7 12.75-13.25 14.4-15.35 40 7, 14, 28 7, 14, 28, 56 T/R spacing (MHz) 252.04 340 340 154, 161, 168, 196, 245 119, 208, 266 311.32 490, 530 266 420, 490, 644, 728 315 18 GHz 23 GHz 17.7-19.7 21.2-23.6 7, 13.75, 27.5, 55 7, 14, 28, 56 7, 14, 28, 56 26 GHz 32 GHz 38 GHz 24.5-26.5 31.8-33.4 37-39.5 7, 14, 28, 56 7, 14, 28, 56 7, 14, 28, 56 1010 1008 1232 1008 812 1260 ERC (CEPT/ERC) 14-01 An 1 14-02E 02-06 Annex 1 and 3 12-06E 12-02E T/R 12-07 12-03E 13-02E An A 13-02E An B Rec 01(02) T/R 12-01 ITU-R

Lower 6 GHz Upper 6 GHz 7 GHz 8 GHz

F.383-8 F.384-10 F.385-9 F.386-8 An 2, 3, 5 F.386-8 An 6 F.387-10 F.497-7 F.636-3 F.595-9 F.637-3 An 3, 5 F.637-3 An 1 F.748-4 An 1 F.1520-2 An 1, 2 F.749-2 An 1

4-24

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

FCC 101.147 defines the frequency plans for FCC. These are summarized in Table 90 (ODU platforms).

Table 90 FCC and IC band plan Band Frequency range (GHz) 5.925-6.425 6.525-6.875 10.7-11.7 17.7-19.7 Bandwidth (MHz) 10, 30 10, 30 10, 30, 40 10, 20, 30, 40, 50 ODU-B: 80 23 GHz 26 GHz 38 GHz 21.8-23.6 24.25-25.25 38.6-40 10, 20, 30, 40, 50 10, 20, 40 10, 50 1200 800 700 FCC, IC FCC only FCC, IC Part 101-147 (s) 10-1-08 Edition Part 101-147 (s) 10-1-08 Edition T/R spacing (MHz) 252.04 160, 170 490 1560 FCC/IC Reference

Lower 6 GHz Upper 6 GHz 11 GHz 18 GHz

FCC, IC FCC only FCC, IC FCC, IC

Part 101-147 (o) 10-1-08 Edition Part 101-147 (r) 10-1-08 Edition

Capacity license keys and frequency bands


Table 91 shows capacity license keys cross-referenced to frequency bands and regulatory agencies for PTP 810.

The purchase of a capacity license key results in the generation of both a 1+x and a 2+0 authorization key. However, there are some capacity license key and frequency band combinations which only support the 1+x authorization key.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-25

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 91 Cross-Reference of capacity license keys to frequency band Capacity key Cambium part number ETSI band (GHz) L6 U6 15 18 23 26 28 32 38 1+x 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 All 2+0, XPIC 2+0, XPIC 7 8 13 11 L6 U6 FCC/IC band (GHz) 11 26 18 23 38

10 Mbps 20 Mbps 30 Mbps 40 Mbps 50 Mbps 100 Mbps 150 Mbps 200 Mbps 300 Mbps 400 Mbps 600 Mbps

Default WB3538 WB3539 WB3540 WB3541 WB3542 WB3543 WB3544 WB3545 WB3546 N000081 K001

None None None 1+x 1+x 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 2+0 2+0, XPIC None None

1+x 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 2+0 2+0, XPIC None None

None None None None None None 1+x 1+x 2+0, XPIC 2+0, XPIC None

None None None None 1+x 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 2+0 2+0, XPIC XPIC None

None None None None 1+x 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 2+0, XPIC 2+0, XPIC None

1+x 1+x 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 2+0, XPIC 2+0, XPIC None

1+x 1+x 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 All 2+0, XPIC 2+0, XPIC

1+x 1+x 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 1+x, 2+0 2+0, XPIC 2+0, XPIC

4-26

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Maximum E1/T1 circuit capacity


Table 92 shows the maximum number of E1/T1 circuits referenced to link type, modulation mode and ETSI channel spacing. Table 93 shows the maximum number of E1/T1 circuits referenced to link type, modulation mode and FCC/IC bandwidth.

The maximum number of E1/T1 circuits is dependent on the choice of Master I/O module. The values in Table 92 and Table 93 are based on the Standard Master I/O Module which supports 126 E1/T1 circuits per modem. The GigE Master I/O Module only supports 63 E1/T1 circuits per modem. Table 92 Maximum number of E1/T1 circuits with ETSI channel separations Link Type Modulation mode 7 MHz 13.75 14 MHz 30, 28 27.5 29.65 MHz 81 34 29 23 18 9 70 59 50 39 19 162 32 28 22 18 8 68 58 46 36 18 140 118 100 78 38 168 146 120 40 MHz 55, 56 60 MHz

1+x 1+x 1+x 1+x 1+x 1+x 2+0 2+0 2+0 2+0 2+0 2+0 XPIC XPIC XPIC

256QAM 128QAM 64QAM 32QAM 16QAM QPSK 256QAM 128QAM 64QAM 32QAM 16QAM QPSK 256QAM 128QAM 64QAM

16 14 11 9 4

110 96 81 68 53 26 205 192 162 136 106 52 205 198 168

126 126 123 101 75 39 205 205 205 202 150 78 205 205 205

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-27

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 93 Maximum number of E1/T1 circuits with FCC and Canada bandwidths Link Type 1+x 1+x 1+x 1+x 1+x 1+x 2+0 2+0 2+0 2+0 2+0 2+0 XPIC XPIC XPIC Modulation mode 256QAM 128QAM 64QAM 32QAM 16QAM QPSK 256QAM 128QAM 64QAM 32QAM 16QAM QPSK 256QAM 128QAM 64QAM 62 52 42 34 16 31 26 21 17 8 10 MHz 20 MHz 30 MHz 73 63 53 43 35 17 146 126 106 86 70 34 110 96 86 68 53 26 205 192 172 136 106 52 205 198 174 40 MHz 126 126 109 91 71 35 205 205 205 182 142 70 205 205 205 50 MHz 126 126 126 114 89 44 205 205 205 205 178 88 205 205 205 80 MHz 126 126 126 125 104 51 205 205 205 205 205 102 205 205 205

4-28

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity


This section contains tables of wireless performance for PTP 810 links. The tables specify, for each frequency band, region (FCC and ETSI), bandwidth and modulation mode, the following data: F/R mode: This means Fixed or reference mode. It indicates whether or not the modulation mode is available as a fixed or reference mode. Cap (Mbps): This means Capacity. It is the maximum user capacity applied to the TDM channels, Ethernet data ports and management ports that can be transmitted over the radio interface. Sens (dBm): This means Sensitivity It is the minimum receive power which can achieve a Bit Error Rate of 1 x 10-6 as defined in EN 302 217 Annex F. Max tx (dBm): This means 'Maximum transmit power', the maximum transmit power that can be configured in the MMU. Min tx (dBm): This means 'Minimum transmit power', the minimum transmit power that can be configured in the MMU.

The tables are ordered by frequency band as follows: Wireless performance in the Lower 6 GHz band on page 4-30 Wireless performance in the Upper 6 GHz band on page 4-31 Wireless performance in the 7 GHz band on page 4-35 Wireless performance in the 8 GHz band on page 4-36 Wireless performance in the 11 GHz band on page 4-38 Wireless performance in the 13 GHz band on page 4-42 Wireless performance in the 15 GHz band on page 4-44 Wireless performance in the 18 GHz band on page 4-46 Wireless performance in the 23 GHz band on page 4-53 Wireless performance in the 26 GHz band on page 4-61 Wireless performance in the 32 GHz band on page 4-67 Wireless performance in the 38 GHz band on page 4-69

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-29

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Wireless performance in the Lower 6 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the Lower 6 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 94 Lower 6 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 Sens (Mbps) (dBm) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 -73.8 -77.4 -81.1 -85.4 -91.6 Max tx (dBm) 22 22 22 22 22 Min tx (dBm) 9 9 9 9 9

Table 95 Lower 6 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.89 32QAM 0.82 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 173.0 149.9 134.4 107.4 83.5 41.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 345.9 299.8 268.8 214.8 167.1 83.2 Sens (dBm) -64.9 -69.8 -71.6 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 22 22 22 22 22 22 Min tx (dBm) 9 9 9 9 9 9

Table 96 Lower 6 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.88 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 357.9 310.2 273.7 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 22 22 22 Min tx (dBm) 9 9 9

4-30

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 97 Lower 6 GHz ETSI with 29.65 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -69.7 -72.9 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 28 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14 14

Table 98 Lower 6 GHz ETSI with 29.65 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14

Wireless performance in the Upper 6 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the Upper 6 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 99 Upper 6 GHz FCC with 10 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 Sens (dBm) -73.8 -77.4 -81.1 -85.4 -91.6 Max tx (dBm) 22 22 22 22 22 Min tx (dBm) 9 9 9 9 9

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-31

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 100 Upper 6 GHz FCC with 30 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.89 32QAM 0.82 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 173.0 149.9 134.4 107.4 83.5 41.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 345.9 299.8 268.8 214.8 167.1 83.2 Sens (dBm) -64.9 -69.8 -71.6 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 22 22 22 22 22 22 Min tx (dBm) 9 9 9 9 9 9

Table 101 Upper 6 GHz FCC with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.88 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 357.9 310.2 273.7 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 22 22 22 Min tx (dBm) 9 9 9

Table 102 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -75.1 -78.5 -82.2 -86.4 -92.8 Max tx (dBm) 24 24 26 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14

4-32

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 103 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -72.7 -74.8 -79.3 -83.4 -89.9 Max tx (dBm) 24 24 26 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14

Table 104 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 30 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -69.7 -72.9 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 26 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14 14

Table 105 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 30 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-33

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 106 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 40 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.82 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode No Yes Yes No No No Cap 1+x (Mbps) 230.4 199.7 169.0 142.3 110.7 55.4 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 460.8 399.4 338.0 284.7 221.4 110.8 Sens (dBm) -68.5 -71.6 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 26 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14 14

Table 107 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 40 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode No Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 474.4 411.1 347.9 Sens (dBm) -69.4 -72.9 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14

Table 108 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 60 MHz channel separation Modulation mode
256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.82 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81

F/R mode Yes Yes Yes No No No

Cap 1+x (Mbps) 339.5 294.2 255.4 208.9 155.2 81.3

Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 679.0 588.5 510.7 417.9 310.3 162.6

Sens (dBm) -62.1 -66.7 -70.7 -

Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 28 28 30

Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14 14

4-34

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 109 Upper 6 GHz ETSI with 60 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 696.4 603.6 510.7 Sens (dBm) -63.0 -67.5 -71.0 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14

Wireless performance in the 7 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 7 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29.

Table 110 7 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -75.1 -78.5 -86.4 -92.8 Max tx (dBm) 24 24 28 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14

Table 111 7 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -72.7 -74.8 -79.3 -83.4 -89.9 Max tx (dBm) 24 24 28 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-35

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 112 7 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -69.7 -72.9 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 28 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14 14

Table 113 7 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulationm ode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14

Wireless performance in the 8 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 8 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29.

Table 114 8 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -75.1 -78.5 -86.4 -92.8 Max tx (dBm) 24 24 28 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14

4-36

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 115 8 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -72.7 -74.8 -79.3 -83.4 -89.9 Max tx (dBm) 24 24 28 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14

Table 116 8 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -69.7 -72.9 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 28 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14 14

Table 117 8 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-37

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 118 8 GHz ETSI with 29.65 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -69.7 -72.9 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 28 28 30 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14 14 14 14

Table 119 8 GHz ETSI with 29.65 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 22 24 24 Min tx (dBm) 14 14 14

Wireless performance in the 11 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 11 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 120 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 Sens (dBm) -74.3 -77.9 -81.6 -85.9 -92.1 Max tx (dBm) 19 19 19 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6

4-38

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 121 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 Sens (dBm) -74.3 -77.9 -81.6 -85.9 -92.1 Max tx (dBm) 20 20 20 20 20 Min tx (dBm) 5 5 5 5 5

Table 122 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.89 32QAM 0.82 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 173.0 149.9 134.4 107.4 83.5 41.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 345.9 299.8 268.8 214.8 167.1 83.2 Sens (dBm) -65.4 -70.3 -72.1 -78.0 -80.1 -87.5 Max tx (dBm) 19 19 19 19 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6 6

Table 123 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.89 32QAM 0.82 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 173.0 149.9 134.4 107.4 83.5 41.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 345.9 299.8 268.8 214.8 167.1 83.2 Sens (dBm) -65.4 -70.3 -72.1 -78.0 -80.1 -87.5 Max tx (dBm) 20 20 20 20 20 20 Min tx (dBm) 5 5 5 5 5 5

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-39

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 124 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.88 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 357.9 310.2 273.7 Sens (dBm) -65.8 -71.4 -74.0 Max tx (dBm) 19 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6

Table 125 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.88 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 357.9 310.2 273.7 Sens (dBm) -65.8 -71.4 -74.0 Max tx (dBm) 20 20 20 Min tx (dBm) 5 5 5

Table 126 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 231.7 200.8 170.0 143.2 111.4 55.7 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 463.5 401.7 339.9 286.3 222.7 111.4 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -68.9 -72.0 -76.7 -80.1 -86.3 Max tx (dBm) 19 19 19 19 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6 6

4-40

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 127 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 231.7 200.8 170.0 143.2 111.4 55.7 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 463.5 401.7 339.9 286.3 222.7 111.4 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -68.9 -72.0 -76.7 -80.1 -86.3 Max tx (dBm) 20 20 20 20 20 20 Min tx (dBm) 5 5 5 5 5 5

Table 128 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 477.1 413.5 349.9 Sens (dBm) -65.1 -69.9 -73.3 Max tx (dBm) 19 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6

Table 129 11 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 477.1 413.5 349.9 Sens (dBm) -65.1 -69.9 -73.3 Max tx (dBm) 20 20 20 Min tx (dBm) 5 5 5

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-41

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 130 11 GHz ETSI with 40 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.82 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode No Yes Yes No No No Cap 1+x (Mbps) 230.4 199.7 169.0 142.3 110.7 55.4 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 460.8 399.4 338.0 284.7 221.4 110.8 Sens (dBm) -69.0 -72.1 Max tx (dBm) 19 21 21 26 26 28 Min tx (dBm) 11 11 11 11 11 11

Table 131 11 GHz ETSI with 40 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode No Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 474.4 411.1 347.9 Sens (dBm) -69.9 -73.4 Max tx (dBm) 19 21 21 Min tx (dBm) 11 11 11

Wireless performance in the 13 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 13 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 132 13 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -75.6 -79.0 -86.9 -93.3 Max tx (dBm) 18 18 23 23 26 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8 8 8

4-42

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 133 13 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -73.2 -75.3 -79.8 -83.9 -90.4 Max tx (dBm) 18 18 23 23 26 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8 8 8

Table 134 13 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.2 -73.4 -78.0 -81.3 -87.5 Max tx (dBm) 16 18 18 23 23 26 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8 8 8 8

Table 135 13 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -65.7 -71.3 -74.3 Max tx (dBm) 16 18 18 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-43

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Wireless performance in the 15 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 15 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 136 15 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -75.6 -79.0 -86.9 -93.3 Max tx (dBm) 18 18 23 23 26 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8 8 8

Table 137 15 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -73.2 -75.3 -79.8 -83.9 -90.4 Max tx (dBm) 18 18 23 23 26 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8 8 8

Table 138 15 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.2 -73.4 -78.0 -81.3 -87.5 Max tx (dBm) 16 18 18 23 23 26 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8 8 8 8

4-44

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 139 15 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -65.7 -71.3 -74.3 Max tx (dBm) 16 18 18 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8

Table 140 15 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 339.5 294.2 255.4 208.9 155.2 81.3 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 679.0 588.5 510.7 417.9 310.3 162.6 Sens (dBm) -62.6 -67.2 -71.2 -78.7 -84.2 Max tx (dBm) 16 18 18 23 23 26 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8 8 8 8

Table 141 15 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 696.4 603.6 510.7 Sens (dBm) -63.5 -68.0 -71.5 Max tx (dBm) 16 18 18 Min tx (dBm) 8 8 8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-45

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Wireless performance in the 18 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 18 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 142 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 Sens (dBm) -74.3 -77.9 -81.6 -85.9 -92.1 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2

Table 143 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 Sens (dBm) -74.3 -77.9 -81.6 -85.9 -92.1 Max tx (dBm) 19 19 23 23 24 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2

Table 144 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 20 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 114.5 99.3 84.0 68.8 55.7 27.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 229.1 198.5 168.0 137.5 111.4 55.5 Sens (dBm) -68.0 -72.1 -75.1 -78.6 -82.7 -89.1 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

4-46

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 145 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 20 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 114.5 99.3 84.0 68.8 55.7 27.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 229.1 198.5 168.0 137.5 111.4 55.5 Sens (dBm) -68.0 -72.1 -75.1 -78.6 -82.7 -89.1 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 23 23 24 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 146 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 173.0 149.9 134.4 107.4 83.5 41.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 345.9 299.8 268.8 214.8 167.1 83.2 Sens (dBm) -65.4 -70.3 -72.1 -78.0 -80.1 -87.5 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 147 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 173.0 149.9 134.4 107.4 83.5 41.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 345.9 299.8 268.8 214.8 167.1 83.2 Sens (dBm) -65.4 -70.3 -72.1 -78.0 -80.1 -87.5 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 23 23 24 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-47

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 148 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 357.9 310.2 273.7 Sens (dBm) -65.8 -71.4 -74.0 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

Table 149 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 357.9 310.2 273.7 Sens (dBm) -65.8 -71.4 -74.0 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

Table 150 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 231.7 200.8 170.0 143.2 111.4 55.7 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 463.5 401.7 339.9 286.3 222.7 111.4 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -68.9 -72.0 -76.7 -80.1 -86.3 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

4-48

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 151 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 231.7 200.8 170.0 143.2 111.4 55.7 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 463.5 401.7 339.9 286.3 222.7 111.4 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -68.9 -72.0 -76.7 -80.1 -86.3 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 23 23 24 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 152 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 477.1 200.8 170.0 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -68.9 -72.0 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

Table 153 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 477.1 413.5 349.9 Sens (dBm) -65.1 -69.9 -73.3 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-49

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 154 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 290.7 252.0 218.7 178.9 139.2 69.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 581.4 503.9 437.3 357.9 278.4 139.2 Sens (dBm) -63.2 -68.0 -72.2 -75.7 -78.9 -85.0 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 155 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 290.7 252.0 218.7 178.9 139.2 69.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 581.4 503.9 437.3 357.9 278.4 139.2 Sens (dBm) -63.2 -68.0 -72.2 -75.7 -78.9 -85.0 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 23 23 24 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 156 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 596.3 516.8 437.1 Sens (dBm) -64.4 -68.7 -72.1 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

4-50

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 157 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 596.3 516.8 437.1 Sens (dBm) -64.4 -68.7 -72.1 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

Table 158 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 80 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 339.5 294.2 255.4 208.9 162.5 81.3 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 679.0 588.5 510.7 417.9 325.0 162.6 Sens (dBm) -62.6 -67.2 -71.2 -74.9 -77.9 -84.2 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 23 23 24 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 159 18 GHz FCC and Canada with 80 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 696.4 603.6 510.7 Sens (dBm) -63.5 -67.8 -71.3 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-51

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 160 18 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -75.6 -79.0 -86.9 -93.3 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 22 22 25.5 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7

Table 161 18 GHz ETSI with 13.75 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -73.2 -75.3 -79.8 -83.9 -90.4 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 22 22 25.5 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7

Table 162 18 GHz ETSI with 27.5 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.2 -73.4 -78.0 -81.3 -87.5 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 25.5 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7 7

4-52

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 163 18 GHz ETSI with 55 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 339.5 294.2 255.4 208.9 155.2 81.3 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 679.0 588.5 510.7 417.9 310.3 162.6 Sens (dBm) -62.6 -67.2 -71.2 -78.7 -84.2 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 25.5 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7 7

Wireless performance in the 23 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 23 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 164 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 Sens (dBm) -73.8 -77.4 -81.1 -85.4 -91.6 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-53

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 165 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 Sens (dBm) -73.8 -77.4 -81.1 -85.4 -91.6 Max tx (dBm) 19 19 23 23 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2

Table 166 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 20 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 114.5 99.3 84.0 68.8 55.7 27.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 229.1 198.5 168.0 137.5 111.4 55.5 Sens (dBm) -67.5 -71.6 -74.6 -78.1 -82.2 -88.6 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 167 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 20 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 114.5 99.3 84.0 68.8 55.7 27.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 229.1 198.5 168.0 137.5 111.4 55.5 Sens (dBm) -67.5 -71.6 -74.6 -78.1 -82.2 -88.6 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 23 23 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

4-54

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 168 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 173.0 149.9 134.4 107.4 83.5 41.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 345.9 299.8 268.8 214.8 167.1 83.2 Sens (dBm) -64.9 -69.8 -71.6 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 169 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 173.0 149.9 134.4 107.4 83.5 41.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 345.9 299.8 268.8 214.8 167.1 83.2 Sens (dBm) -64.9 -69.8 -71.6 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 23 23 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 170 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 357.9 310.2 273.7 Sens (dBm) -65.3 -70.9 -73.5 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-55

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 171 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 30 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 357.9 310.2 273.7 Sens (dBm) -65.3 -70.9 -73.5 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

Table 172 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 231.7 200.8 170.0 143.2 111.4 55.7 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 463.5 401.7 339.9 286.3 222.7 111.4 Sens (dBm) -64.2 -68.4 -71.5 -76.2 -79.6 -85.8 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 173 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 231.7 200.8 170.0 143.2 111.4 55.7 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 463.5 401.7 339.9 286.3 222.7 111.4 Sens (dBm) -64.2 -68.4 -71.5 -76.2 -79.6 -85.8 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 23 23 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

4-56

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 174 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 477.1 200.8 170.0 Sens (dBm) -64.6 -69.4 -72.8 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

Table 175 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 477.1 413.5 349.9 Sens (dBm) -64.6 -69.4 -72.8 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

Table 176 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 290.7 252.0 218.7 178.9 139.2 69.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 581.4 503.9 437.3 357.9 278.4 139.2 Sens (dBm) -62.7 -67.5 -71.7 -75.2 -78.4 -84.5 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-57

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 177 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 290.7 252.0 218.7 178.9 139.2 69.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 581.4 503.9 437.3 357.9 278.4 139.2 Sens (dBm) -62.7 -67.5 -71.7 -75.2 -78.4 -84.5 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 23 23 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 178 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-A) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 596.3 516.8 437.1 Sens (dBm) -63.9 -68.2 -71.6 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

Table 179 23 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) (ODU-B) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 596.3 516.8 437.1 Sens (dBm) -63.9 -68.2 -71.6 Max tx (dBm) 17 19 19 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

4-58

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 180 23 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -75.1 -78.5 -86.4 -92.8 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 22 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2

Table 181 23 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -72.7 -74.8 -83.4 -89.9 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 22 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7

Table 182 23 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -69.7 -72.9 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7 7

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-59

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 183 23 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7

Table 184 23 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 339.5 294.2 255.4 208.9 155.2 81.3 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 679.0 588.5 510.7 417.9 310.3 162.6 Sens (dBm) -62.1 -66.7 -70.7 -78.2 -83.7 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7 7

Table 185 23 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 696.4 603.6 510.7 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7

4-60

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Wireless performance in the 26 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 26 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 186 26 GHz FCC with 10 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 Sens (dBm) -73.8 -77.4 -81.1 -85.4 -91.6 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2

Table 187 26 GHz FCC with 20 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 114.5 99.3 84.0 68.8 55.7 27.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 229.1 198.5 168.0 137.5 111.4 55.5 Sens (dBm) -67.5 -71.6 -74.6 -78.1 -82.2 -88.6 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-61

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 188 26 GHz FCC with 40 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 231.7 200.8 170.0 143.2 111.4 55.7 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 463.5 401.7 339.9 286.3 222.7 111.4 Sens (dBm) -64.2 -68.4 -71.5 -76.2 -79.6 -85.8 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 23 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2 2 2 2

Table 189 26 GHz FCC with 40 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 477.1 200.8 170.0 Sens (dBm) -64.6 -69.4 -72.8 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 2 2 2

Table 190 26 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -75.1 -78.5 -86.4 -92.8 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 22 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7

4-62

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 191 26 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -72.7 -74.8 -83.4 -89.9 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 22 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7

Table 192 26 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -69.7 -72.9 -77.5 -80.8 -87.0 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7 7

Table 193 26 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-63

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 194 26 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 339.5 294.2 255.4 208.9 155.2 81.3 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 679.0 588.5 510.7 417.9 310.3 162.6 Sens (dBm) -62.1 -66.7 -70.7 -78.2 -83.7 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 22 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7 7

Table 195 26 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 696.4 603.6 510.7 Sens (dBm) -65.2 -70.8 -73.8 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7

4-64

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Wireless performance in the 28 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 28 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 196 28 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -74.6 -78.0 -81.7 -85.9 -92.3 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 20 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7

Table 197 28 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -72.2 -74.3 -78.8 -82.9 -89.4 Max tx (dBm) 17 17 20 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7

Table 198 28 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -64.2 -69.2 -72.4 -77.0 -80.3 -86.5 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 20 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7 7

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-65

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 199 28 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -64.7 -70.3 -73.3 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7

Table 200 28 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 339.5 294.2 255.4 208.9 155.2 81.3 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 679.0 588.5 510.7 417.9 310.3 162.6 Sens (dBm) -61.6 -66.2 -70.2 -73.9 -77.7 -83.2 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 20 22 25 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7 7 7 7

Table 201 28 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 696.4 603.6 510.7 Sens (dBm) -62.5 -67.0 -70.5 Max tx (dBm) 15 17 17 Min tx (dBm) 7 7 7

4-66

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Wireless performance in the 32 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 32 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29. Table 202 32 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -74.1 -77.5 -81.2 -85.4 -91.8 Max tx (dBm) 16 16 19 21 23 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6

Table 203 28 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -71.7 -73.8 -78.3 -82.4 -88.9 Max tx (dBm) 16 16 19 21 23 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6

Table 204 32 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -63.7 -68.7 -71.9 -76.5 -79.8 -86.0 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 19 21 23 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6 6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-67

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 205 32 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -64.2 -69.8 -72.8 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6

Table 206 32 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 339.5 294.2 255.4 208.9 155.2 81.3 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 679.0 588.5 510.7 417.9 310.3 162.6 Sens (dBm) -61.1 -65.7 -69.7 -73.4 -77.2 -82.7 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 19 21 23 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6 6

Table 207 32 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 696.4 603.6 510.7 Sens (dBm) -62.0 -66.5 -70.0 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6

4-68

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Wireless performance in the 38 GHz band


The following tables contain capacity, transmit power and sensitivity data for PTP 810 links operating in the 38 GHz band. For column definitions, refer to Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29.

Table 208 38 GHz FCC and Canada with 10 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 49.2 41.4 33.9 27.8 13.8 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 98.3 82.8 67.8 55.5 27.6 Sens (dBm) -70.8 -74.4 -78.1 -82.4 -88.6 Max tx (dBm) 16 16 20 20 21 Min tx (dBm) 1 1 1 1 1

Table 209 38 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 290.7 252.0 218.7 178.9 139.2 69.6 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 581.4 503.9 437.3 357.9 278.4 139.2 Sens (dBm) -59.7 -64.5 -68.7 -72.2 -75.4 -81.5 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 20 20 21 Min tx (dBm) 1 1 1 1 1 1

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-69

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 210 38 GHz FCC and Canada with 50 MHz bandwidth (XPIC) Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 596.3 516.8 437.1 Sens (dBm) -60.9 -65.2 -68.6 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 Min tx (dBm) 1 1 1

Table 211 38 GHz ETSI with 7 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 35.5 30.0 24.6 20.0 10.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 70.9 60.0 49.1 40.1 19.9 Sens (dBm) -73.1 -76.5 -84.4 -90.8 Max tx (dBm) 16 16 20 20 23 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6

Table 212 38 GHz ETSI with 14 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 71.9 60.9 49.8 40.2 20.0 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 143.8 121.7 99.6 80.4 40.1 Sens (dBm) -70.7 -72.8 -81.4 -87.9 Max tx (dBm) 16 16 20 20 23 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6

4-70

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Wireless specifications

Table 213 38 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 32QAM 0.83 16QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 168.3 145.9 123.5 104.5 81.3 40.5 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 336.7 291.8 246.9 209.0 162.6 81.0 Sens (dBm) -62.7 -67.7 -70.9 -75.5 -78.8 -85.0 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 20 20 23 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6 6

Table 214 38 GHz ETSI with 28 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 348.3 301.8 255.4 Sens (dBm) -63.2 -68.8 -71.8 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6

Table 215 38 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation Modulation mode 256 QAM 0.86 128 QAM 0.86 64 QAM 0.84 32 QAM 0.83 16 QAM 0.81 QPSK 0.81 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Cap 1+x (Mbps) 339.5 294.2 255.4 208.9 155.2 81.3 Cap 2+0 (Mbps) 679.0 588.5 510.7 417.9 310.3 162.6 Sens (dBm) -60.1 -64.7 -68.7 -76.2 -81.7 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 20 20 23 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6 6 6 6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-71

Wireless specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Table 216 38 GHz ETSI with 56 MHz channel separation (XPIC) Modulation mode 256QAM 0.86 128QAM 0.86 64QAM 0.84 F/R mode Yes Yes Yes Cap XPIC (Mbps) 696.4 603.6 510.7 Sens (dBm) -61.0 -65.5 -69.0 Max tx (dBm) 14 16 16 Min tx (dBm) 6 6 6

4-72

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Data network specifications

Data network specifications


This section contains specifications for the PTP 810 Ethernet interfaces.

Fast Ethernet specifications


The PTP 810 conforms to the Fast Ethernet specifications listed in Table 217. Table 217 Fast Ethernet specifications Feature Ethernet Speed Operation Bridging type Specification 100 Base-T Full-Duplex, Half-Duplex, Auto-Negotiation Store and forward switching, dynamic address learning, spanning tree protocol capable. Supports 802.1D-2004: Section 9 Encoding of bridge protocol data units. Section 14 Bridge Management (partial support via GUI and proprietary MIB). Section 16 Bridge Performance. Section 17 Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol. MAC address capacity The MMU supports two MAC addresses. One is for NMS and the other is for payload. In addition, internal Ethernet switches can learn up to 4096 addresses. 64 KB for Standard Master I/O module Min = 64 bytes Max = 2048 bytes for Standard Master I/O module VLAN support VLAN tagged packets may be passed through without modification. User configurable Port based and Tag based VLANs are also supported.

Buffering Packet Size

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-73

Data network specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Feature Quality of Service (QoS)

Specification QoS is implemented using weighted priority queues. Incoming packets are assigned to a priority queue based on one or more of the following criteria: -Incoming Port: port based priority allows assignment to a priority queue based upon the port the packet arrived on -802.1Q VLAN Tag Priority: packets are assigned to a priority queue based upon the priority tag field in the VLAN TAG. -DiffServ: packets are assigned to a priority queue based upon the value of the DS field of the IPv4 header (the DS field is the re- defined IPv4 TOS field) Priority Queues: 4

Flow Control

Flow control is supported in both full-duplex and half-duplex. Full-Duplex is implemented with respect for PAUSE packets as well as generation of PAUSE packets. Half-Duplex is implemented with back-pressure.

4-74

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Data network specifications

Gigabit Ethernet specifications


The PTP 810 conforms to the Gigabit Ethernet specifications listed in Table 218. Table 218 Gigabit Ethernet specifications Feature Ethernet Speed Operation Bridging type Specification 1000 Base-T Full-Duplex, Half-Duplex, Auto-Negotiation Store and forward switching, dynamic address learning, spanning tree protocol capable. Supports 802.1D-2004: Section 9 Encoding of bridge protocol data units. Section 14 Bridge Management (partial support via GUI and proprietary MIB). Section 16 Bridge Performance. Section 17 Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol. MAC address capacity The MMU supports two MAC addresses. One is for NMS and the other is for payload. In addition, internal Ethernet switches can learn up to 1024 addresses. 128KB for GigE Master I/O module Min = 64 bytes Max = 4000 bytes for GigE Master I/O module with S software version. Max = 9728 bytes for GigE Master I/O module with J software version. VLAN support VLAN tagged packets may be passed through without modification. User configurable Port based and Tag based VLANs are also supported.

Buffering Packet Size

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-75

Data network specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

Feature Quality of Service (QoS)

Specification QoS is implemented using weighted priority queues. Incoming packets are assigned to a priority queue based on one or more of the following criteria: Incoming Port: port based priority allows assignment to a priority queue based upon the port the packet arrived on. 802.1Q VLAN Tag Priority: packets are assigned to a priority queue based upon the priority tag field in the VLAN TAG. DiffServ: packets are assigned to a priority queue based upon the value of the DS field of the IPv4 header (the DS field is the re-defined IPv4 TOS field). Priority Queues: 4

Flow Control

Flow control is supported in both full-duplex and half-duplex. Full-Duplex is implemented with respect for PAUSE packets as well as generation of PAUSE packets. Half-Duplex is implemented with back-pressure.

4-76

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Network management specifications

Network management specifications


This section lists supported SNMP objects from the standard MIB-II, IF-MIB and BridgeMIB.

Standard SNMP MIBs


PTP 810 supports the following SNMP objects from the standard MIB-II, IF-MIB and Bridge-MIB:

MIBs
A Managed Information Base (MIB) file describes a type of device in a network as a data structure. The MMU SNMP agent supports the following MIBs. ccm_reg.mib: This MIB file contains the registration for CarrierComm enterprise OID and sub trees for CarrierComm products. ccm_SDIDU.mib: This is the main MIB file for the MMU product. ccm_SDIDU_v1Traps.mib: MMU product version 1 trap MIB file ccm_SDIDU_v2Traps.mib: MMU product version 2 trap MIB file

Etherlike-MIB.mib - This MIB contains generic Ethernet interface parameters. SONET-MIB.mib - This MIB contains parameters for configuring the SONET/SDH interface. RFC1573.mib - This MIB file contains access to interface parameters. RFC2493.mib - This MIB file contains performance history parameters. RFC1573.mib - This MIB file contains parameters for configuring SONET. RFC2558.mib - This MIB file contains parameters for configuring SONET data.

DS1-MIB.mib - This MIB file contains parameters for configuring DS1. IANAifType-MIB.mib - This MIB file contains parameters for accessing interface data using IANA textual convention. IF-MIB.mib - This MIB file contains parameters for accessing interface data. PerfHist-TC-MIB.mib - This MIB file contains parameters for accessing performance data. The SNMP agent interface uses these MIB files to configure the system.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-77

Network management specifications

Chapter 4: Reference information

SNMP Agent Parameters


The SNMP agent interface configurable parameters are described in the following sections.

WEB and CLI interfaces can be used to configure the SNMP parameters below. Change in any of the parameters below reconfigures the agent. If the agent is configured in v3 only or v1-v2-v3 mode, SNMPv3 admin user can configure the SNMP users. There are 3 possible levels of users. The SNMP agent does not support level based access if the agent is configured as v1 only or v2 only mode. In the case of v1 and v2 modes of operation, Level1 access is given to the read operation and Level4 access is given for the write operation. Thus, in v1 and v2 modes of operation, the user has full access to system configurations if a valid write community string is used.

SNMP Mode
The SNMP agent can be configured to operate in any of the following modes: disable v1 only v2 only v3 only v1-v2-v3

If the agent is configured to run as v1 only, v2 only or v3 only, then the user can access the agent only using SNMP v1, v2 or v3 respectively. If the agent is configured to operate in the v1-v2-v3 mode, then the user can access the agent using SNMP v1, v2 or v3. The SNMP agent is disabled by selecting the disable mode. In 1.4.18x non-encrypted version of the application, the v1-v2-v3 option is replaced by v1v2 option.

SNMP v1 and v2 provides a weak security by using the community strings. The user can always configure the SNMP agent to operate in v3 only mode, which uses authentication as well as encryption for secure transaction.

4-78

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Electromagnetic compliance

Electromagnetic compliance
This section describes how the PTP 810 complies with the regulations that are in force in various countries, and contains notifications made to regulatory bodies for the PTP 810.

Compliance testing
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by Cambium could void the users authority to operate the system. This system has achieved Type Approval in various countries around the world. This means that the system has been tested against various local technical regulations and found to comply.

Electrical safety compliance


The PTP 810 hardware has been tested for compliance to the electrical safety specifications listed in Table 219. Table 219 Electrical safety specifications Region USA Canada Europe Specification UL 60950-1 CSA C22.2 No.60950-1 EN 60950-1:2006, Amdt 11:2009 (This covers the essential requirements of the R&TTE Directive Article 3.1(a) Product Safety) International CB certified & certificate to IEC 60950-1: 2005 Edition 2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-79

Electromagnetic compliance

Chapter 4: Reference information

European Union compliance


RF performance
The PTP 810 system has been tested for compliance to harmonized European standard

ETSI EN 302 217-2-2 Fixed Radio Systems; Characteristics and requirements for point-topoint equipment and antennas; Part 2-2: Digital systems operating in frequency bands where frequency co-ordination is applied; Harmonized EN covering the essential requirements of article 3.2 of the R&TTE Directive.
This covers the essential requirements of R&TTE directive Article 3.2 Effective Use of the Spectrum.

Electromagnetic compatibility
The PTP810 System has also been tested for compliance to the electro-magnetic compatibility standards given below:

ETSI EN 301 489-4: Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM); ElectroMagnetic Compatibility (EMC) standard for radio equipment and services; Part 4: Specific conditions for fixed radio links, Broadband Data Transmission System Base stations, ancillary equipment and services. ETSI EN 301 489-1: Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM); ElectroMagnetic Compatibility (EMC) standard for radio equipment and services; Part 1: Common technical requirements.

The limits for radiated and conducted radiations of Class A have been applied.

This is a class A product. In a domestic environment this product may cause radio interference in which case the user may be required to take adequate measures. This covers the essential requirements of R&TTE directive Article 3.1(b) Electromagnetic Compatibility.

Non-ionizing radiation
Radiation Hazard requirements of the R&TTE directive are covered in Radiation hazard assessment on page 4-83.

Canada compliance
The PTP 810 system has been verified for compliance to RSS-GEN and the band specific Technical Requirements documents in the SRSP series.

4-80

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Electromagnetic compliance

United States compliance


The PTP 810 system has been tested for compliance to FCC Code of Federal Regulations

Title 47:

Part 2: Frequency Allocations and Radio Treaty Matters; General Rules and Regulations. Part 15: Radio Frequency Devices. Part 101: Fixed Microwave Services.

This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules and with RSS-GEN of Industry Canada. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-81

Electromagnetic compliance

Chapter 4: Reference information

Notifications
General notification
Where necessary, the end user is responsible for obtaining any national licenses required to operate this product and these must be obtained before using the product in any particular country. Contact the appropriate national administrations for details on the conditions of use for the bands in question and any exceptions that might apply. In order to reduce potential radio interference to other users, the antenna type and its gain should be so chosen that the Effective Isotropic Radiated Power (EIRP) is not more than that permitted for successful communication.

European Union notification


The PTP 810 is a Class 2 device as it operates on frequencies that are not harmonized across the EU. See http://www.ero.dk for further information. Hereby, Cambium Networks declares that the PTP 810 product complies with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC. The declaration of conformity may be consulted at the support web page (see Contacting Cambium Networks on page 2). This equipment is marked to show compliance with the European R&TTE directive 1999/5/EC (Figure 64). Figure 64 European Union compliance label

4-82

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Radiation hazard assessment

Radiation hazard assessment


This section evaluates the radiation levels produced by the PTP 810 products against ETSI and FCC standards.

ETSI method
This section evaluates the radiation levels produced by the PTP 810 products against the following standards:

1999/519/EC of 12 July 1999 on the limitation of exposure of the general public to


electromagnetic fields (0 Hz to 300 GHz).

EN 50385:2002 Product standard to demonstrate the compliances of radio base


stations and fixed terminal stations for wireless telecommunication systems with the basic restrictions or the reference levels related to human exposure to radio frequency electromagnetic fields (110 MHz to 40 GHz) general public.

EN 50383:2002 Basic standard for the calculation and measurement of


electromagnetic field strength and SAR related to human exposure from radio base stations and fixed terminal stations for wireless telecommunication systems (110 MHz to 40 GHz).

Exposure categories
EN 50385:2002 Clause 3.1 defines the restrictions on exposure to time-varying electric,
magnetic, and electromagnetic fields that are based directly on established health effects. Between 10 GHz and 40 GHz, the physical quantity is the power density.

1999/519/EC defines the exposure limit (Basic Restriction) to be considered for the general public. Annex II and Table 1 define this to be 10 W/m2.

Antenna directivity
The Cambium recommended antennas have Hi-Performance polar patterns in accordance with ETSI EN302 217-4-1 classes 2 and 3. They have gains in excess of 30 dB and beamwidths of less than 5 degrees. Thus, they provide high attenuation of radiated energy at the sides and rear of the antenna.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-83

Radiation hazard assessment

Chapter 4: Reference information

Calculation
Calculation is used to identify the Compliance Boundary; outside this boundary the radiation levels meet the Basic Restriction, which is defined in 1999/519/EC as 10 W/m2. The distance from the antenna at which the Power Flux Density limit is equal to some specified value is calculated using the Cylindrical Wave model as follows:

S=

P .180 Dd

Where S = Power density (W/m2), P = Maximum average transmit power capability of the radio (Watts), D = Antenna diameter (meters), d = Distance from point source (meters), = 3 dB antenna beamwidth (degrees). Rearranging terms to solve for distance yields:

d =

P .180 S D

Distances from antenna


Table 220 specifies calculated minimum separation distances for a range of frequency bands and antenna sizes at the peak of the antenna beam. At these and greater distances, the power density from the RF field is not considered to be hazardous. Table 220 PTP 810 minimum separation distances, ETSI method Band Antenna diameter 0.3 m (1 ft) 6 GHz 7 and 8 GHz 11 GHz 13 GHz 15 GHz 18 GHz 23 GHz 26 GHz 32 and 38 GHz N/A N/A N/A 1.6 m 1.8 m 2.1 m 2.0 m 2.4 m 2.4 m 0.6 m (2 ft) N/A 2.0 m 1.8 m 1.4 m 1.5 m 1.6 m 1.8 m 2.0 m 2.1 m 0.8 m (2.5 ft) N/A 2.2 m 2.2 m 1.4 m 1.6 m 1.7 m 2.0 m 2.3 m N/A 1.2 m (4 ft) 1.7 m 2.2 m 2.0 m 1.5 m 1.6 m 1.9 m 2.0 m 2.5 m N/A 1.8 m (6 ft) 1.8 m 2.1 m 1.8 m 1.4 m 1.6 m 1.6 m 2.0 m N/A N/A

4-84

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Radiation hazard assessment

These separation distances are significantly lower than those calculated by the method specified by the FCC. The ETSI method recognises that radiation is distributed across the antenna aperture and is not in reality a point source.

FCC method
Relevant standards (North America and EC) applicable when working with RF equipment are:

ANSI IEEE C95.1-1991, IEEE Standard for Safety Levels with Respect to Human Exposure to Radio Frequency Electromagnetic Fields, 3 kHz to 300 GHz.
US FCC limits for the general population. See the FCC web site at http://www.fcc.gov, and the policies, guidelines, and requirements in Part 1 of Title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations, as well as the guidelines and suggestions for evaluating compliance in FCC OET Bulletin 65. Health Canada limits for the general population. See the Health Canada web site at http://www.hc-sc.gc.ca/ewh-semt/pubs/radiation/99ehd-dhm237/limits-limites_e.html and Safety Code 6. ICNIRP (International Commission on Non-Ionizing Radiation Protection) guidelines for the general public. See the ICNIRP web site at http://www.icnirp.de/ and Guidelines for Limiting Exposure to Time-Varying Electric, Magnetic, and Electromagnetic Fields.

Calculation
FCC OET Bulletin 65 specifies the far-field method to calculate power density:

S=

PG 4 R 2

Where S = Power density (W/m2), P = Maximum average transmit power capability of the radio (Watts), G = Antenna gain, R = Distance from point source (meters). FCC Title 47 Part 1.1310 defines the exposure limit for the general population to be 10 W/m2 (1 mW/cm2) in the frequency range 1500 to 100,000 MHz. This defines an exposure time of 30 minutes. Higher levels are permitted for shorter periods of exposure. Rearranging terms to solve for distance yields:

R=

4 S PG

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

4-85

Radiation hazard assessment

Chapter 4: Reference information

Distances from antenna


For ODU deployments, Table 221 specifies calculated minimum separation distances for a range of frequency bands and antenna sizes at the peak of the antenna beam. At these and greater distances, the power density from the RF field is not considered to be hazardous. These tables are based on the worst case transmit power. Table 221 PTP 810 minimum separation distances, FCC method (ODU) Band Antenna diameter 0.3 m (1 ft) 6 GHz 7 GHz 8 GHz 11 GHz 18 GHz 23 GHz 26 GHz 38 GHz N/A 0.6 m (2 ft) N/A 0.8 m (2.5 ft) N/A 1.2 m (4 ft) 2.7 m (8.8 ft) 3.7 m (12.2 ft) 9.6 m (31.5 ft) 10.7 m (35.2 ft) 11.7 m (38.4 ft) N/A 1.8 m (6 ft) 4.2 m (13.6 ft) 5.6 m (18.4 ft) 14.0 m (46.0 ft) 14.9 m (48.9 ft) N/A N/A

N/A 2.9 m (9.6 ft) 3.0 m (9.9 ft) 3.4 m (11.2 ft) 4.0 m (13.2 ft)

1.9 m (6.3 ft) 4.8 m (15.8 ft) 5.4 m 17.8 ft) 5.9 m (19.4 ft) 7.4 m (24.3 ft)

2.7 m (8.9 ft) 6.3 m (20.7 ft) 7.1 m (23.3 ft) 8.0 m (26.3 ft) N/A

4-86

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Chapter 5: Installation
This chapter describes how to install and test the hardware for a PTP 810 link. Before starting the installation, refer to: Preparing for installation on page 5-2 describes the checks to be performed before proceeding with the installation.

To install the ODU and IF cables, refer to: Installing antennas and ODUs on page 5-5 describes how to install the antennas, ODUs and waveguide connections at each link end. Installing the IF and ground cables on page 5-38 describes how to install the IF cables and how to install grounding and lightning protection. Testing the ODU and IF cable on page 5-63 describes how to perform pre-power tests on the ODU, LPUs and IF cable.

To install the MMU and network connections, refer to: Installing the MMU on page 5-71 describes how to mount the MMU in the building or cabinet, and to connect it to ground, power supply and PC. Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links) on page 5-77 describes how to prepare the cables to connect the MMU to the customer and (optionally) management networks. It applies only to unprotected ends (1+0 and 2+0 links).

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-1

Preparing for installation

Chapter 5: Installation

Preparing for installation


Before starting the installation, perform the checks described in this section.

Safety precautions during installation


When developing a site, installing equipment, or performing maintenance, ensure that all national and local safety standards are followed by all personnel.

Ensure that personnel are not exposed to unsafe levels of RF energy. The units start to radiate as soon as they are powered up. Respect the safety standards defined in Radiation hazard assessment on page 4-83, in particular the minimum separation distances. Observe the following guidelines: Never work in front of the antenna when the MMU is powered. Always power down the MMU before connecting or disconnecting the drop cable from the MMU, ODU or LPU.

Grounding and lightning protection requirements


Ensure that the installation meets the requirements defined in Grounding and lightning protection on page 2-7.

Selecting installation options


Use the installation report to determine which installation options are required. Refer to Link planning on page 2-2. When installing a 1+1 Hot Standby link, refer to Planning 1+1 links on page 2-25 for an overview of alternative hardware configurations.

5-2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Preparing for installation

Preparing personnel
In no event shall Cambium Networks be liable for any injury or damage caused during the installation of the Cambium PTP 810. Ensure that only qualified personnel undertake the installation of a PTP 810 link. Ensure that all safety precautions are observed.

Preparing inventory
Perform the following inventory checks: Check that an installation report is available and that it is based on the principles described in Chapter 2: Planning considerations. Check that the correct components are available, as described Ordering components on page 2-39. Check the contents of all packages against their packing lists.

Preparing tools
Check that the tools listed in Table 222 are available. Table 222 Tools required for PTP 810 installation Equipment to be Installed MMU Tools Required Pozi screw driver (PZ1) Ground lug crimp tool (diameter 5mm) 8mm spanner Direct Mount ODU Remote Mount Lubricant (supplied) 17mm spanner Lubricant (supplied) Flexible Wave Guide Flexible Wave Guide hanger Allen key (supplied in the kit) 13mm spanner 5mm Allen key Flat bladed screw driver (6mm) or Pozi screw driver (PZ2)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-3

Preparing for installation

Chapter 5: Installation

Equipment to be Installed Coupler

Tools Required 6mm Allen key 2.5mm and 3mm Allen keys (supplied) Lubricant (supplied)

Antenna

17mm spanner 7 mm spanner (for tapered transition) Voltmeter and BNC lead Compass and GPS meter Inclinometer

Cable

Cable cutters Cable hoist Flat file to dress the cable inner core Wire brush to comb the braid Crimp tool Cambium part 66010063001 Torque wrench

5-4

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Installing antennas and ODUs


This section describes how to install the antennas, ODUs and waveguide connections at each link end. Use Table 223 to select installation procedures. Table 223 Selecting antenna and ODU installation procedures Hardware configuration 1+0 1+0 1+1 HSB 1+1 HSB 1+1 HSB SD 1+1 HSB SD Dual 1+0 Dual 1+0 2+0 co-polar 2+0 co-polar 2+0 cross-polar 2+0 cross-polar Antenna mounting Direct Remote Direct Remote Direct Remote Direct Remote Direct Remote Direct Remote Procedures to be performed Installing a direct mount antenna with one ODU on page 5-6. Installing a remote mount antenna with one ODU on page 5-10. Installing a direct mount antenna with two ODUs (via coupler) on page 5-21. Installing a remote mount antenna with two ODUs (via coupler) on page 5-28. Installing a direct mount antenna with one ODU on page 5-6. Repeat for the second antenna and ODU. Installing a remote mount antenna with one ODU on page 5-10. Repeat for the second antenna and ODU. Installing a direct mount antenna with one ODU on page 5-6. Repeat for the second antenna and ODU. Installing a remote mount antenna with one ODU on page 5-10. Repeat for the second antenna and ODU. Installing a direct mount antenna with two ODUs (via coupler) on page 5-21. Installing a remote mount antenna with two ODUs (via coupler) on page 5-28. Installing a direct mount dual-polar antenna with two ODUs on page 5-34. Installing a remote mount antenna with one ODU on page 5-10. Install two ODUs and waveguides and one dual-polar antenna, but connect both ODUs to the antenna via the waveguide ports. Installing a direct mount dual-polar antenna with two ODUs on page 5-34.
5-5

2+0 XPIC

Direct

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Hardware configuration 2+0 XPIC

Antenna mounting Remote

Procedures to be performed Installing a remote mount antenna with one ODU on page 5-10. Install two ODUs and waveguides and one dual-polar antenna, but connect both ODUs to the antenna via the waveguide ports.

Follow applicable health and safety rules for use of silicone grease. If necessary use the latex gloves supplied with the products.

If upgrading an unprotected link to 1+1 Hot Standby, mute the active unit before installing the coupler. For safety reasons this is required when working with the ODUs or when working close to the antenna. See Disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU on page 7-21.

When installing 1+1 Hot Standby links, observe that the ODUs are labeled Hi or Lo depending on the frequency sub-band. Install the two Hi ODUs at one end of the link and the two Lo ODUs at the other end.

Installing a direct mount antenna with one ODU


In the direct mount configuration, attach the ODU directly to the antenna (with Cambium ODU interface) via four latches. To install a direct mount antenna with a single ODU, proceed as follows: 1 Follow the antenna manufacturers instructions to attach the antenna to its bracket.

5-6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Polarization depends upon the antenna waveguide interface position. To change polarization, rotate the antenna transition, following the antenna manufacturers instructions.

Apply silicone grease to the O Ring of the antenna transition.

Remove the ODU waveguide interface dust cover.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-7

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Fit the ODU to the antenna transition, ensuring that the antenna and ODU waveguide interfaces align correctly. Observe the polarization of the antenna waveguide interface.

Secure the ODU to the antenna with the four latches, taking care to ensure they are correctly engaged.

Check that the antenna, mounting bracket and ODU are assembled.

5-8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Follow the manufacturers instructions to attach the assembly to the mast or pole.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-9

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Installing a remote mount antenna with one ODU


In the remote mount configuration, the antenna and ODU are attached to the mast separately, connected to each other via a flexible waveguide. The flexible waveguide is designed to isolate vibration and eliminate difficulties caused by misalignment.

The flexible waveguide must be protected from damage that may be caused by contamination, vibration or bending. When installing a flexible waveguide, observe the following precautions: Unpacking: To avoid damage to the waveguide, do not unpack it until required. When unpacked, protect the waveguide from dirt, dust or ingress of foreign objects. Vibration: Flexible waveguides may be damaged if subjected to excessive vibration or excessive bending. If a flexible waveguide is installed in a stressed (tensile) condition, vibration should be kept to a minimum, as the waveguide rubber jacket may become more susceptible to ozone and general environmental attack. Always use the waveguide hangers; two hangers should be used for the 900mm (3ft) flexible waveguide. Bend radius: Conform to the bend radii, maximum twist and torque settings specified in Flexible waveguide specifications on page 4-9. Static bend radius: When installing a flexible waveguide, pay attention to the static bend radius (quoted in the waveguide manufacturers data sheet). Static bend radius is the minimum bend that an assembly may be subject to without repeat movement (except as a consequence of small vibrations or axial expansions).

Before installation, check that the ODU, RMK, waveguide and antenna have compatible interfaces.

For a 2+0 cross-polar remote mount configuration, follow the procedures in this section to install two ODUs and waveguides and one dual-polar antenna, but connect both ODUs to the antenna via the waveguide ports (Figure 65).

5-10

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Figure 65 Dual-polar antenna in remote mount configuration

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-11

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Mounting ODU on pole using RMK


To mount the ODU on the pole using a remote mounting kit (RMK), proceed as follows: 1 Follow the manufacturers instructions to attach the RMK to the mast or pole.

Apply silicone grease to the O ring of the RMK transition.

Remove the ODU waveguide interface dust cover.

5-12

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Fit the ODU to the RMK transition, ensuring that the locating pegs on the RMK transition fit into the peg holes in the ODU waveguide interface.

Secure the ODU to the RMK with the four latches, taking care to ensure they are correctly engaged.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-13

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Check that the RMK and ODU are correctly mounted on the mast or pole.

Assembling the flexible waveguide hangers


To provide adequate support for a 900mm flexible waveguide, install two hangers. To assemble the flexible waveguide hangers, proceed as follows: 1 Check the flexible waveguide hanger kit contents.

Assemble the pole clip, making note of the angle of the slots in the metal strip.

5-14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Fit the rubber moulding clamp to the studding.

Use the 5mm Allen key to fit the pole clip to the studding.

Temporarily fit the rubber mouldings.

Check the finished assembly.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-15

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Attaching antenna and waveguide to pole


If the antenna is 11 GHz, fit a tapered transition between the antenna and waveguide as described in Mounting an 11 GHz antenna with tapered transition and waveguide on page 5-19. To mount the antenna on the pole and attach it to the ODU via the flexible waveguide, proceed as follows: 1 2 Follow the antenna manufacturers instructions to attach the antenna to its bracket and to the mast or pole. Check that the waveguide, antenna and RMK have compatible interfaces. Check that the mating surfaces are clean and free from damage.

3 4

Fit one of the O ring seals supplied with the waveguide kit to the flexible waveguide flange that has the O ring groove. Using the waveguide flange fitted with the O ring, fit the flexible waveguide to the remote mount. Ensure that the waveguide cavity orientation matches the opening in the RMK. Fit four shorter screws, using a spring washer and a plain washer on each screw. It is sometimes more convenient to complete this operation before the assembly is fitted to the mast, connecting the flexible waveguide to the antenna when fitting the remote mount to the mast.

5-16

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Fit the remote mount to the tower. Fit an O ring seal to the antenna interface and secure the plain flange of flexible waveguide to the antenna. Ensure that the waveguide cavity orientation matches the opening in the antenna. Secure the flexible waveguide using four of the shorter screws to the antenna. Fit each screw with a spring washer and a plain washer.

Fit the rubber inserts from the hanger kit to the flex waveguide.

Insert the rubber insert and flex waveguide into the hanger.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-17

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Fit the hanger cover and tighten.

When routing the flex waveguide ensure that the minimum bend radius is not exceeded.

5-18

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

10

Check the complete assembly.

Mounting an 11 GHz antenna with tapered transition and waveguide


When installing an 11 GHz remote mount antenna, fit a tapered transition between the antenna and the flexible waveguide. The tapered transition converts from the PDR100 waveguide flange on the antenna to the UBR120 flange on the flexible waveguide.

11 GHz antennas with a CPR90G interface need a different flexible waveguide and have the tapered transition next to the RMK not the antenna. Ensure that flanges are matched accordingly.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-19

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

To mount an 11 GHz antenna with taper transition and flexible waveguide, proceed as follows: 1 Mount the bracket on the antenna.

Remove the protective film from the antenna waveguide and fit the gasket, (supplied in the kit).

Use the 8 screws to fit the tapered transition to the antenna.

5-20

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Fit the seal to the tapered transition, (supplied in the kit).

Use the four screws supplied in the kit to fit the flexible waveguide to the tapered transition. It makes taping the joint easier if the four screws are inserted in the direction shown.

Use FT-TB fusion tape (Andrews part FT-TB) to water proof the junctions as shown.

Installing a direct mount antenna with two ODUs (via coupler)


In the direct mount configuration, attach the coupler (with ODUs) directly to the antenna (with Cambium ODU interface) via four latches.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-21

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

If the coupler is asymmetric, one side is embossed with the word MAIN and the other side with STANDBY (Figure 66). The MAIN side has lower loss. Ensure that the MAIN and STANDBY sides can still be identified after the ODUs are fitted, as this allows them to be connected to the correct modem in the MMU. Figure 66 Words embossed on coupler

Attaching coupler to antenna


To attach the coupler to the antenna, proceed as follows: 1 Follow the antenna manufacturers instructions to attach the antenna to its bracket.

5-22

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Check that the supplied coupler is the correct type for this installation. Check the contents of the coupler mounting kit.

Fit the correct spacers to each of the four legs: 11GHz - spacer length 27mm 18 GHz, 23 GHz, and 26 GHz - spacer length 7.75mm.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-23

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

For a 1+1 Hot Standby link, check that the circular transitions on the coupler have the same alignment (vertical or horizontal depending on the antenna polarity). If necessary, rotate the circular transitions according to the manufacturers instructions.

Take note of the word TOP embossed in the casting; ensure this edge is upper most when attached to the antenna.

Remove protective film from coupler antenna port.

5-24

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Apply silicone grease to the O Ring of the antenna transition.

Fit the coupler to the antenna by following this sequence: Initially, hand-tighten two of the diagonally opposed M8 bolts with the Allen key supplied in the kit. Using the latch clamp, clip the same two corners. Repeat the above on the remaining two diagonally opposed bolts and clips. Torque down all four M8 bolts to 18 Nm.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-25

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Attaching ODUs to coupler


To attach the ODUs to the coupler and mount the assembly on the pole, proceed as follows: 1 Remove protective film from the coupler ports.

2 3

Apply silicone grease to the O rings of the coupler transitions. Fit the ODUs to the coupler transitions, ensuring that the waveguide interfaces align correctly for vertical or horizontal polarization. Fit both ODUs such that handles are at the top and connectors at the bottom. For asymmetric couplers, check that the MAIN and STANDBY sides of the coupler can still be identified.

5-26

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Follow the manufacturers instructions to attach the assembly to the mast or pole.

Check the finished installation.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-27

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Installing a remote mount antenna with two ODUs (via coupler)


In the remote mount configuration, attach the antenna and coupler (with two ODUs) to the mast separately, connected to each other via a flexible waveguide. The flexible waveguide is designed to isolate vibration and eliminate difficulties caused by misalignment.

Protect the flexible waveguide from damage that may be caused by contamination, vibration or bending. Observe the precautions in Installing a remote mount antenna with one ODU on page 5-10.

Before installation, check that the ODUs, coupler, RMK, waveguide and antenna have compatible interfaces.

If the coupler is asymmetric, one side is embossed with the word MAIN and the other side with STANDBY (Figure 66). The MAIN side has lower loss. Ensure that the MAIN and STANDBY sides can still be identified after the ODUs are fitted, as this allows them to be connected to the correct MMUs.

Attaching coupler to RMK


To attach the coupler to the RMK, proceed as follows: 1 Ensure the correct RMK, coupler and flexible waveguide are present for the frequency band.

5-28

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Check that the supplied coupler is the correct type for this installation. Check the contents of the coupler mounting kit.

Fit the correct spacers to each of the four legs: 11GHz - spacer length 27mm 18 GHz, 23 GHz and 26 GHz - spacer length 7.75mm

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-29

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Check that the circular transition on the coupler is correctly aligned for remote mount bracket polarity (vertical or horizontal). If necessary, rotate the circular transition according to the manufacturers instructions.

Take note of the polarization marks on the remote mount bracket.

Take note of the word TOP embossed in the casting; ensure this edge is upper most when attached to the antenna.

5-30

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Remove the protective film from the coupler remote mount port.

Apply silicone grease to the O ring of the remote mount transition.

Fit the coupler to the remote mount bracket by following this sequence: Initially, hand tighten two of the diagonally opposed M8 bolts with the Allen Key supplied in the kit. Using the latch clamp, clip the same two corners. Repeat the above on the remaining two diagonally opposed bolts and clips. Torque down all four M8 bolts to 18Nm.

Assembling the flexible waveguide hangers


Assemble the hangers as described in Assembling the flexible waveguide hangers on page 5-14.
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
5-31

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Attaching antenna to pole


Follow the antenna manufacturers instructions to attach the antenna to its bracket and to the mast or pole.

Attaching ODUs to coupler


To attach the ODUs to the coupler and mount the assembly on the pole, proceed as follows: 1 Fit the flex waveguide to the remote mount bracket.

Fit assembly to pole.

5-32

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Connect the flexible waveguide to the antenna.

Remove protective film from coupler ports.

5 6

Apply silicone grease to the O rings of the coupler transitions. Fit the ODUs to the coupler transitions, ensuring that the waveguide interfaces align correctly for vertical or horizontal polarization. Fit both ODUs such that handles are at the top and connectors at the bottom. For asymmetric couplers, check that the MAIN and STANDBY sides of the coupler can still be identified.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-33

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Support the flexible waveguide with the waveguide hangers. Do not exceed the flexible waveguide minimum bend radius.

Check the finished installation.

Installing a direct mount dual-polar antenna with two ODUs


Direct mount dual-polar antennas are supplied with an orthogonal mode transducer (OMT) with two direct-mount interfaces.

To upgrade any standard antenna to a direct mount dual polar antenna, purchase an orthogonal mount kit (OMK) from Cambium.

5-34

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

To install a direct mount dual-polar antenna with two ODUs, proceed as follows: 1 2 Follow the manufacturers instructions to fit the antenna mounting bracket and fit the antenna to the orthogonal mode transducer. Remove protective film from the OMT transitions.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-35

Installing antennas and ODUs

Chapter 5: Installation

Apply silicone grease to the O rings of the OMT transitions.

Fit the ODUs to the transitions, ensuring that the waveguide interfaces align correctly for vertical or horizontal polarization.

Follow the manufacturers instructions to attach the assembly to the mast or pole.
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-36

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing antennas and ODUs

Place the supplied spirit level on the leveling flat and use it to achieve horizontal alignment of the antenna and OMT assembly.

To confirm that the assembly is level, place an inclinometer on the leveling flat and measure inclination angle. The example shows an inclination of 0.2.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-37

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Installing the IF and ground cables


This section describes how to install the IF cables and how to install grounding and lightning protection. When installing a 1+1 Hot Standby link, install and ground separate IF cables for the Primary and Secondary ODUs. When installing a 2+0 link, install and ground separate IF cables for the link A and link B ODUs. This task consists of the following procedures: Preparing IF cables on page 5-40. Fitting an N type or straight TNC connector on page 5-40. Connecting the ODU to the top LPU on page 5-44. Weatherproofing an N type connector on page 5-47. Hoisting the main IF cable on page 5-52. Installing and grounding the main IF cable on page 5-55. Making an IF cable ground point on page 5-57. Installing and grounding the IF cable at building entry on page 5-61.

When installing IF and ground cables, observe the following precautions: o o o Ensure that the IF and ground cable installation meets the requirements defined in Grounding and lightning protection on page 2-7. To provide effective protection against lightning induced surges, grounding cables must be installed without drip loops and pointing down towards the ground. To ensure that IF connections are not damaged by water ingress, all outdoor IF connectors must be protected from the weather with self-amalgamating and vinyl tape. Do not connect or disconnect the IF cable when the power supply is applied to the MMU. Always ensure the lightning protection units are connected the correct way round (Figure 67).

o o

5-38

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

Figure 67 Correct orientation of LPUs

ODU

Antenna

EQUIPMENT port

Top LPU
SURGE port

SURGE port

Bottom LPU
EQUIPMENT port

MMU

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-39

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Preparing IF cables
Prepare the following lengths of IF cable: ODU-LPU IF cable: To connect the ODU to the top LPU, use the braided cable assembly supplied in the coaxial cable installation assembly kit (Table 55), as this is pre-fitted with N type connectors. If this is not suitable, cut a short section of IF cable and fit N type connectors to both ends, as described in Fitting an N type or straight TNC connector on page 5-40. Main IF cable: Cut a length of IF cable to connect the top LPU to the bottom LPU. Slide one or more hoisting grips onto the top end of the cable, as described in Hoisting the main IF cable on page 5-52. Fit N type connectors to both ends, as described in Fitting an N type or straight TNC connector on page 5-40. LPU-MMU IF cable: Cut a length of IF cable to connect the bottom LPU to the MMU. Fit an N type connector to the LPU end, as described in Fitting an N type or straight TNC connector on page 5-40. For the MMU end, choose one of the following options: o o o To fit a right angle TNC male connector, follow the procedure Fitting a right angle TNC connector on page 5-44. To fit a straight TNC male connector, follow the procedure Fitting an N type or straight TNC connector on page 5-40. To fit an N type connector, follow the procedure Fitting an N type or straight TNC connector on page 5-40, then fit the N-Type to TNC Adapter (Cambium part number N000081L007).

Fitting an N type or straight TNC connector


Prerequisites: CNT-400 coaxial cable, 50 (IF cable) (Cambium part number 30010194001 or 30010195001), cut to length. Crimp tool for N-type and TNC connectors (Cambium part number 66010063001). For ODU or LPU connections: N type connector supplied in Coaxial cable installation assembly kit (Cambium part number WB3616). For MMU connections: TNC Male for CNT-400 braided cable (Cambium part number N000081L005A). Grease, ruler, file, wire brush, cable cutter.

5-40

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

To prepare an IF cable to receive an N type or straight TNC connector, proceed as follows: 1 Remove 21mm (0.827 inch) of the outer jacket:

Slide ferrule over braid, ensure the chamfer is towards the braid:

Comb braid straight with wire brush:

Fold braid around ferrule, ensuring that it is straight and equally spaced. Trim braid back to 9mm (0.354 inch):

Remove foam insulation and trim centre conductor to 6mm (0.236 inch):

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-41

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Chamfer the centre conductor at a angle of 45:

Failure to correctly chamfer the centre conductor will cause damage to the connector when assembling the cable into the connector.

Mark a line 22 mm from the end of the ferrule:

Daub grease onto the braid uniformly:

5-42

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

To crimp an N type or straight TNC connector to an IF cable, proceed as follows: 1 Insert the cable into connector. The cable centre conductor must be inserted into the inner contact fingers:

Ensure that the cable is not inserted beyond the line marked in Step 8. Crimp the connector body in the area shown:

Use the larger of the openings in the crimp tool:

Check the finished part:

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-43

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Fitting a right angle TNC connector


Prerequisites: CNT-400 coaxial cable, 50 (IF cable) (Cambium part number 30010194001 or 30010195001), cut to length. TNC Male Right Angle for CNT-400 braided cable (Cambium part number N000081L006A). Spanner, ruler, file, wire brush, cable cutter.

To fit a right angle TNC connector, follow manufacturers instructions.

Connecting the ODU to the top LPU


Perform this procedure to connect the ODU to the top lightning protection unit (LPU) via ground and IF cables, and to ground the LPU to the supporting structure (Figure 68). Figure 68 ODU and top LPU grounding

To connect and ground the ODU and top LPU, proceed as follows:

5-44

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

Attach one end of the ODU ground cable to the ODU.

Attach the other end of the ODU ground cable to the top LPU, under the LPU mounting nut. Attach one end of the LPU ground cable to the LPU, under the LPU mounting nut.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-45

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Attach one end of the ODU-LPU IF cable to the ODU.

Attach the other end of the ODU-LPU IF cable to the EQUIPMENT port of the top LPU.

5 6

Mount the top LPU on the supporting structure. Route and fasten the ODU ground cable and ODU-LPU IF cable. The ground cable should be routed downwards without any loops.

5-46

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

Attach the other end of the LPU ground cable to the grounding bar of the supporting structure.

Protect the N type connectors at the ODU and LPU from the weather by applying self-amalgamating and PVC tape, as described in Weatherproofing an N type connector on page 5-47.

Weatherproofing an N type connector


Use this procedure to weatherproof the N type connectors fitted to the ODU and LPU. Before weatherproofing the connectors, ensure that the installation has been tested as described in Testing the ODU and IF cable on page 5-63. These tests require connection and disconnection of the IF cables at various places.

Tighten N type connectors using a torque wrench, set to 1.7 Nm (15 lb in). If a torque wrench is not available, finger tighten the N type connectors. To weatherproof an N type connector, proceed as follows:

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-47

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Ensure the connection is tight, using a torque wrench (if available):

Wrap the connection with a layer of 19 mm (0.75 inch) PVC tape, starting 25 mm (1 inch) below the connector body. Overlap the tape to half-width and extend the wrapping to the body of the LPU. Avoid making creases or wrinkles:

Smooth tape edges:

5-48

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

Cut a 125mm (5 inches) length of rubber tape (self amalgamating):

Expand the width of the tape by stretching it so that it will wrap completely around the connector and cable:

Press the tape edges together so that there are no gaps. The tape should extend 25mm (1inch) beyond the PVC tape:

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-49

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Wrap a layer of 50 mm (2 inch) PVC tape from bottom to top, starting from 25 mm (1 inch) below the edge of the self-amalgamating tape, overlapping at half width.

Repeat with a further four layers of 19 mm (0.75 inch) PVC tape, always overlapping at half width. Wrap the layers in alternate directions: Second layer: top to bottom. Third layer: bottom to top. Fourth layer: top to bottom. Fifth layer: bottom to top. The bottom edge of each layer should be 25 mm (1 inch) below the previous layer.

5-50

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

Completed weatherproof connection:

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-51

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Hoisting the main IF cable


Use hoisting grips to hoist the main IF cable safely up a tower or building and provide permanent support so that mechanical connection to an antenna can be made. The correct hoisting grip for CNT-400 IF cable is Cambium part number 07009304001, used with the correct crimp tool SG-IT (Andrew part number 243333).

Failure to obey the following precautions may result in injury or death. Observe the following precautions: Use the hoisting grip to hoist one cable only. Attempting to hoist more than one cable may cause the hoisting grip to break or the cables to fall. Do not use the hoisting grip for lowering cable unless the clamp is securely in place. Do not reuse hoisting grips. Used grips may have lost elasticity, stretched, or become weakened. Reusing a grip can cause the cable to slip, break, or fall. Use hoisting grips at intervals of no more than 60 m (200 ft). Use the proper hoisting grip for the cable being installed. If the wrong hoisting grip is used, slippage or insufficient gripping strength will result.

Attaching the hoisting grip


Attach one or more hoisting grips to the main IF cable before fitting the N type connector to the top end (as described in Preparing IF cables on page 5-40). Attach one additional hoisting grip for each 60 m (200 ft) of cable.

5-52

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

To attach a hoisting grip to the main IF cable, proceed as follows: 1 Compress the grip ends towards each other and slide the grip heel (woven end) onto the cable (see photo). Place the hoisting grip(s) at the proper location on the cable before attaching the connector. Allow a sufficient length of cable leader to reach the antenna connector when cable hoisting and attachment of the grip handle is completed. Hold the heel with one hand and firmly slide the other hand along the grip to tighten it.

Slide the clamp onto the grip and position it 25 mm (1) from the heel.

Crimp the clamp with Andrew crimping tool 243333 at each hoisting grip clamp location.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-53

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Using the hoist line


Maintain tension on the hoisting grip during hoisting. Loss of tension can cause dangerous movement of the cable and result in injury or death to personnel on or near the tower. Also, do not release tension on the grip until after the cable has been fastened to the tower members. Attach the hoist line to the grip (Figure 69). Tie the cable leader to the hoist line so that the leader does not dangle. Apply tension slowly to the hoist line, allowing the hoisting grip to tighten uniformly on the cable. Hoist the main IF cable up to the ODU. Figure 69 Using the hoist line
N type connector

Minimum leader 1.5 m (5 ft)

Clevis

Cable hoist

When the cable is in position, fasten the grip handle to a tower member and remove the hoist line.

5-54

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

Installing and grounding the main IF cable


Perform this procedure to install and ground the IF cable from the top LPU to the building entry point (Figure 70). The IF cable must be grounded at the points specified in Protection requirements for a mast or tower installation on page 2-10. Figure 70 IF cable grounding on a mast or tower

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-55

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

To install and ground the main IF cable, proceed as follows: 1 Attach the N type connector at the top end of the main IF cable to the SURGE port of the top LPU.

Protect the N type connectors on the LPU from the weather by applying selfamalgamating and PVC tape, as described in Weatherproofing an N type connector on page 5-47. Lay the main IF cable as far as the building entry point, ensuring there is enough length to extend through the wall of the building to the bottom LPU. Attach the main IF cable to the supporting structure using the cable ties provided. Ground the IF cable at the points specified in Protection requirements for a mast or tower installation on page 2-10. Follow the procedure Making an IF cable ground point on page 5-57.

3 4 5

5-56

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

Making an IF cable ground point


Perform this task to connect the screen of the IF cable to the metal of the supporting structure using a cable grounding kit. The cable grounding kit for 1/4 and 3/8 cable (Figure 26) contains the following components: 1 x grounding cable with grounding 2 hole lug fitted (M10) 1 x self Amalgamating tape 1 x PVC tape 3 x tie wraps 2 x bolt, washer and nut

Install ground cables without drip loops and pointing down towards the ground, otherwise they may not be effective. To ground the IF cable to a metal structure using the Cambium grounding kit (part number 01010419001), proceed as follows: 1 Remove 60 mm (2.5 inches) of the IF cable outer jacket:

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-57

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Cut 38 mm (1.5 inches) of rubber tape (self amalgamating) and fit to the ground cable lug. Wrap the tape completely around the lug and cable:

Fold the ground wire strap around the drop cable screen and fit cable ties.

Tighten the cable ties with pliers.

Cut the surplus from the cable ties.

5-58

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

Cut a 38 mm (1.5 inches) section of self-amalgamating tape and fit to the ground cable lug. Wrap the self-amalgamating tape completely around the lug and cable.

Use the remainder of the self-amalgamating tape to wrap the complete assembly. Press the tape edges together so that there are no gaps:

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-59

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

Wrap a layer of PVC tape from bottom to top, starting from 25 mm (1 inch) below and finishing 25 mm (1 inch) above the edge of the self-amalgamating tape, over lapping at half width.

Repeat with a further four layers of PVC tape, always overlapping at half width. Wrap the layers in alternate directions: Second layer: top to bottom. Third layer: bottom to top. Fourth layer: top to bottom. Fifth layer: bottom to top. The edges of each layer should be 25mm (1 inch) above (A) and 25 mm (1 inch) below (B) the previous layer.

Prepare the metal grounding point of the supporting structure to provide a good electrical contact with the grounding cable clamp. Remove paint, grease or dirt, if present. Apply anti-oxidant compound liberally between the two metals.

5-60

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the IF and ground cables

10

Clamp the bottom lug of the grounding cable to the supporting structure using site approved methods.

Use a two-hole lug secured with fasteners in both holes. This provides better protection than a single-hole lug.

Installing and grounding the IF cable at building entry


Perform this procedure to install and ground the main IF cable at the building (or cabinet) entry point (Figure 71). Figure 71 Grounding at building entry
IF cable Ground cable

Master Ground Bar (MGB)

To MMU

External Ground Bar (EGB) Ground ring Lightning Protection Unit (LPU)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-61

Installing the IF and ground cables

Chapter 5: Installation

To connect the IF cable to the bottom LPU, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 4 5 6 Make an entry point into the building and run the main IF cable into the building. Ground the IF cable to the external ground bar outside the building entry point, as described in Making an IF cable ground point on page 5-57. Install the bottom LPU inside the building entry point. Ground the bottom LPU to the master ground bar. Connect the main IF cable (from the ODU) to the SURGE port of the bottom LPU. Connect the LPU-MMU IF cable to the EQUIPMENT port of the bottom LPU and run it to the location of the MMU.

5-62

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Testing the ODU and IF cable

Testing the ODU and IF cable


This section describes how to perform pre-power tests on the ODU, LPUs and the IF cable.

Recommended pre-power tests


After installation of the ODU, LPUs and the IF cable, but before connecting and applying power to the MMU, perform the following tests: Cable loss with ODU disconnected: Confirm that the total cable loss, including loss from the LPUs, is within acceptable limits. Cable loss with the ODU connected: Confirm that the cable contains no short circuit or open circuit. Distance to fault (DTF) return loss with the ODU connected: Confirm the position of the LPUs in the cable run and confirm that there are no other points of discontinuity in the cable. To detect any degradation over time, compare a current plot to a previously recorded plot, if available.

Test equipment
Use an RF cable analyzer such as an Anritsu Site Master to confirm that the installed cable between the ODU and the MMU has the correct loss and does not have any short or open circuits. If the cable is faulty, use this equipment to identify the location of a fault in the cable. Figure 72 is an example of a cable analyzer that is suitable for performing the tests described in this section.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-63

Testing the ODU and IF cable

Chapter 5: Installation

Figure 72 Example of a cable analyzer

Test preparation
Set up the equipment to perform the pre-power tests. Figure 73 is an example to show how this is done. In this example, there is a short length of cable from the analyzer (in place of the MMU) to the first LPU, a length of cable y from the first LPU to the second LPU (at the top of the tower) and a short length of cable from the second LPU to the ODU (0.7m long supplied in the accessory kit). Figure 73 Example of the cable test

Perform these tests in conjunction with the test equipment manufacturers instructions.

5-64

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Testing the ODU and IF cable

To prepare for pre-power testing, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 4 Connect the analyzer to the first LPU (Figure 73). Connect the first LPU to the second (Figure 73). Check that the second LPU is disconnected from the cable that leads to the ODU (Figure 73) (the second LPU and ODU are reconnected during testing). Power on the analyzer.

When these preparations are complete, perform the following tests: Testing cable loss on page 5-65. Measuring distance to fault on page 5-68.

Testing cable loss


The purpose of this test is to ensure that the total cable loss is within acceptable limits. Before performing this test, ensure that the test equipment is set up as described in Test preparation on page 5-64. To measure cable loss, proceed as follows: 1 2 Select the cable loss-one port mode of the cable analyzer (Figure 72). Set the frequency of measurement to: F1 = 100 MHz F2 = 400 MHz. 3 4 Calibrate the instrument for the selected frequencies, using the correct calibration kit. Before connecting the ODU, obtain a plot of cable loss and check that it is within the expected limits for the given cable length. Compare it to examples of good installations (Figure 74). Connect the ODU. Observe the effect of the ODU connection on the plot of cable loss. Compare it to examples of good installations (Figure 75). If there is little or no change to the plot when the ODU is connected, it indicates a short or open circuit on the cable. 7 Keep a copy of the cable loss plots so that they can be compared with subsequent plots to determine if there is any degradation with time.

5 6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-65

Testing the ODU and IF cable

Chapter 5: Installation

Cable loss example using a 14 meter cable


This example is for a cable run consisting of the following: 0.7m cable from the test equipment to the first LPU. The first LPU. 14m of cable between the two LPUs (length y in Figure 73). The second (mast mounted) LPU. 0.7m of cable from the LPU to ODU.

When testing cable loss, compare the before and after plots of cable loss: Figure 74 is a plot of cable loss taken before the ODU was connected. The plot shows an average cable loss of 1.57 dB. For a cable length of approximately 16m (14m +0.7m + 0.7m) with two LPUs, the table result is 1.42 dB, which is within the expected tolerance of +/- 10%. Figure 75 is a plot of cable loss taken after the ODU was connected.

Figure 74 Cable loss plot for a 14 meter cable with no ODU

5-66

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Testing the ODU and IF cable

Figure 75 Cable loss plot for a 14 meter cable with ODU connected

Expected cable loss


Table 224 quotes the expected cable loss for given cable lengths when the ODU is not connected. All loss figures have a tolerance of plus or minus 10%, for example, 1.76 dB means that the loss is expected to be between 1.58 and 1.94 dB. Table 224 Expected cable loss when ODU is not connected Cable Length (meters) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Cable Loss (+/- 10%) at 350 MHz (dB) 0.08 0.15 0.23 0.31 0.39 0.46 0.54 Cable Loss (+/- 10%) with two Lightning Protection Units fitted, at 350 MHz (dB) 0.3 0.37 0.45 0.53 0.61 0.68 0.76

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-67

Testing the ODU and IF cable

Chapter 5: Installation

Cable Length (meters) 8 9 10 20 30 40 50 100

Cable Loss (+/- 10%) at 350 MHz (dB) 0.62 0.69 0.77 1.54 2.31 3.08 3.85 7.7

Cable Loss (+/- 10%) with two Lightning Protection Units fitted, at 350 MHz (dB) 0.84 0.91 0.99 1.76 2.53 3.3 4.1 7.92

Measuring distance to fault


The distance to fault (DTF) test is used as a means of characterizing the cable installation, but can also be used to determine the location of a fault in an installation. Before performing this test, ensure that the test equipment is set up as described in Test preparation on page 5-64. To measure distance to fault, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 Select the DTF-return loss mode of the cable analyzer (Figure 72). Select DTF Aid. Use the up/down key to select and set the following: Cable type - select LMR400 (similar to CNT-400) or LMR600 (similar to CNT-600) as appropriate. F2 - select the highest frequency possible for the greatest resolution, 1600 MHz. D1 and D2 - set as appropriate for the specific installation. 4 5 6 7 Recalibrate the instrument. Before connecting the ODU, obtain a plot of DTF loss. Compare it to an example of a good installation (Figure 76). Connect the ODU. Observe the effect of the ODU connection on the DTF plot. Compare it to an example of a good installation (Figure 77).

5-68

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Testing the ODU and IF cable

Keep a copy of the DTF plots so that they can be compared with subsequent plots to determine if there is any degradation with time.

The absolute readings of DTF should be read with care, as many different variables affect both distance and amplitude accuracy.

DTF return loss example


This example shows typical DTF return loss in a good installation. The distances from the test equipment to first LPU (marker M2), and then the second LPU (marker M3) are clearly shown. The cable between them shows no discontinuity. There are two plots: Figure 76 is a plot of DTF return loss before the ODU is connected. The final peak (marker M1) is the position of the cable open circuit. Figure 77 is a plot of DTF return loss after the ODU is connected. The final peak remains in the same position but is now reduced in amplitude because less signal is reflected, as a consequence of the better match of the ODU.

Figure 76 DTF plot for a 17 meter cable with no ODU

Distance-to-fault
LPU+17M
0 -10 -20 dB -30 -40 -50
M 2 M M 3 1

M1: -5.03 dB @ 18.56 m

M2: -13.11 dB @ .63 m

M3: -17.41 dB @ 17.83 m

-60 0.0 2.5 5.0 7.5 10.0 12.5 15.0 Distance (0.0 - 25.0 M eter) 17.5 20.0 22.5 25.0

Resolution: 517 Std: --Date: 11/10/2009 Model: S311D

CAL:ON(COAX) Channel: N/A Time: 04:49:26 Serial #: 00936036

CW: OFF Ins.Loss:0.135dB/m Prop.Vel:0.850

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-69

Testing the ODU and IF cable

Chapter 5: Installation

Figure 77 DTF plot for a 17 meter cable with ODU connected

Distance-to-fault
ODU+LPU+17M
0 -10 -20 dB -30 -40 -50
M 2 M 3 M 1

M1: -16.41 dB @ 18.70 m

M2: -13.08 dB @ .63 m

M3: -17.50 dB @ 17.83 m

-60 0.0 2.5 5.0 7.5 10.0 12.5 15.0 Distance (0.0 - 25.0 M eter) 17.5 20.0 22.5 25.0

Resolution: 517 Std: --Date: 11/10/2009 Model: S311D

CAL:ON(COAX) Channel: N/A Time: 04:50:58 Serial #: 00936036

CW: OFF Ins.Loss:0.135dB/m Prop.Vel:0.850

5-70

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the MMU

Installing the MMU


This section describes how to mount the MMU in the building or cabinet, and to connect it to ground, power supply and PC.

To minimise radiated emissions, use screened Ethernet cable for all copper connections from the MMU Ethernet ports. This includes the Data port connection to any network switch and the Management port to any network switch.

Mounting the MMU


The MMU is designed to fit into 19" cabinets and equipment frames. The MMU kit contains the MMU, two MMU rack mounting brackets, and power connector.

To prevent the MMU from overheating, air must be able to pass freely over the chassis, especially the front panel of the MMU (the end where the connectors are located). To rack mount the MMU in a 19 inch cabinet rack, use the supplied mounting brackets to secure the chassis of the MMU to the rack cabinet (Figure 78). If mounting in an equipment frame, locate the mounting brackets in the middle of the MMU. To maintain good airflow and cooling, install the MMU in a slot that has blank spaces above and below the unit. Figure 78 MMU with rack mounting bracket (front mounting option shown)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-71

Installing the MMU

Chapter 5: Installation

To avoid damaging the RF cable, route it in such a way that the minimum bend radius for the selected cable is always exceeded. If cables are laid in an air-handling cavity, they must be Plenum rated.

A right angle IF cable connector (Cambium part number N000081L006A) can make it easier to install the MMU in the rack.

Grounding the MMU


Ground the MMU to a rack ground bar, master ground bar or other suitable ground using a minimum cable cross section of 10 mm2 (6AWG) (Figure 37). It is a condition of the safety approval that the unit is grounded. Attach the ground cable to either one of the two MMU ground connectors on the front panel (Figure 79). Figure 79 MMU ground connector

5-72

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the MMU

Connecting the MMU to the IF cable


For links requiring a dual modem MMU, repeat this procedure for the second ODU and MMU modem module. Connect the IF cable (from the bottom LPU) to the MMU modem module. The example (Figure 80) shows the N-Type to TNC Adapter. Figure 80 MMU IF cable connector (non-standard connector shown)

Connecting the MMU power supply


Use of a power supply with an inappropriate ground reference may cause damage to the MMU and/or the supply. The MMU is designed to operate normally with a reversed polarity with a floating -48 V dc power-supply. If the -48 V dc power-supply is ground referenced (not floating), then two problems can occur if the ground reference is connected to the -48 V dc input of the MMU power module: 1) If the MMU is properly grounded, then a power-supply short will occur. Damage to the rest of the MMU is unlikely, but the MMU's internal power supply module could be damaged. This would require replacement of the power supply module. 2) If the MMU is not properly grounded and the ODU is grounded, then a short or highcurrent path is likely. The high- current path scenario could affect components on the MMU modem module and also cause damage to the MMU power supply module.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-73

Installing the MMU

Chapter 5: Installation

Power supply redundancy


For a single modem MMU sourcing power to a single ODU, connect the MMU power supply module to a -48 V dc power supply capable of supplying a maximum of 2.1 amps. For either a dual modem MMU or a single modem MMU with a redundant power supply module, connect a power cable to both of the MMU power supply modules. If one of the power supply modules fails on a dual modem MMU, the remaining power supply module must be capable of potentially supplying power to the MMU and two active ODUs. This requires a 48 V dc power supply capable of supplying a maximum of 3.2 amps.

Preparing the MMU power cable


Assemble the MMU power cable, ensuring that the following requirements are met: If the power cable is under 3 meters (10 ft) in length and supplies -48 V dc, use wire size 16 AWG. Use a power cable that is long enough to avoid tension in the cable and provides a service loop for connection, but is not too long. To reduce tension on the MMU DC power connector, use stranded wire, not a solid conductor. Using the supplied power cable connector provided with the MMU, connect pin 2 (labeled -V) to the power supply terminal supplying -48V dc, and connect pin 1 (labeled RET) to the power supply return (Figure 81).

This connector has screw clamp terminals that accommodate 24 AWG to 12 AWG wire. At the opposite end of the MMU power cable, use a termination that is appropriate for the power supply being used.

Connect the MMU to its power cable (Figure 82). Figure 81 MMU DC power cable connector

5-74

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Installing the MMU

Figure 82 MMU with power cable connected

Powering up the MMU


To connect the MMU to its power supply, proceed as follows: 1 Connect the MMU power cable to the -48 V dc power supply. Place the voltmeter probes on the unconnected MMU end of the power cable, with the positive voltmeter probe on pin 2 (-V) of the cable connector and the negative probe on pin 1 (RET) (Figure 81). The connector terminal screw heads may be used as convenient monitor points. 2 Turn the -48 V dc supply on. Verify that the digital voltmeter reads -48 V dc when monitoring the cable points specified above. To achieve this reading, adjust the power supply output voltage or change the connections at the power supply. 3 Turn the -48 V dc supply off.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-75

Installing the MMU

Chapter 5: Installation

Plug the MMU power cable into the MMU front panel DC power connector (DC Input). Place the voltmeter probes on the cable connector terminal screw heads as per Step 1 above (Figure 81).

Before applying power, ensure that the antenna is directed safely. As the MMU does not have a power on/off switch, the digital radio begins transmitting as soon as power is applied. There can be up to 320 mW of RF power present at the antenna port. 5 Turn the -48 V dc power supply on. Verify that the reading on the digital voltmeter is as specified in Step 2 above.

5-76

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)


This section describes how to prepare the cables to connect the MMU to router ports, switch ports or other equipment in the customer and (optionally) management networks. It applies only to unprotected ends (1+0 and 2+0 links). When installing a 2+0 link, prepare separate network connections for the link A and the link B MMUs.

The MMU is not normally connected to the network equipment until antenna alignment is complete (as described in Task 13: Connecting link to the network on page 6-94). Choose from the following installation procedures: Installing an Ethernet data interface on page 5-78 Installing a fiber data interface on page 5-79 Installing a management interface on page 5-82 Installing an E1/T1 interface on page 5-83 Installing an XPIC interface on page 5-85

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-77

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Chapter 5: Installation

Installing an Ethernet data interface


To provide an Ethernet data interface, connect USER 10/100 port 1 or 2 (Master I/O module) to the network as shown in Figure 83. For pinout connections, refer to Table 81. Figure 83 Copper data interface connections

5-78

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Installing a fiber data interface


To provide a fiber data interface, connect the MMU Fiber SFP (GigE module) port to the network as shown in Figure 84. For fiber connections, refer to Table 83.

The SFP interface is only available if the MMU has a GigE Master I/O module. Figure 84 Fiber data interface connections
SFP module in MMU

Tx

Rx

MMU Tx port to Ethernet switch Rx port

MMU Rx port to Ethernet switch Tx port

SFP module in Ethernet switch

Tx

Rx

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-79

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Chapter 5: Installation

Connecting fiber cables to the MMU


To connect fiber cables to the MMU, proceed as follows: 1 Insert an SFP module into the SFP port of the GigE Master I/O module with the PCB connector down and label up.

Remove the protective caps from the LC connectors.

5-80

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Plug the LC connectors into the SFP module, ensuring they snap home.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-81

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Chapter 5: Installation

Installing a management interface


To provide a management interface, connect NMS 10/100 port 1 or 2 (Control module) to the network as shown in Figure 85. For pinout connections, refer to Table 84.

At the edge of a network, if the management network equipment is inaccessible, leave the MMU management port disconnected. Figure 85 Management interface connections

MMU Control Module NMS 10/100 port 1 or 2

RJ48 plug

Cat5e cable

Ethernet switch port

5-82

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Installing an E1/T1 interface


To provide an E1/T1 (RJ-48C) interface, connect E1/T1 port 1 or 2 (Master I/O module) to the telecommunications network as shown in Figure 86. For pinout connections, refer to Table 86. Figure 86 E1/T1 interface (RJ-48C)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-83

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Chapter 5: Installation

Alternatively, To provide an E1/T1 (molex 60-pin) interface containing 14 E1/T1 connections, E1/T1 port 3-16 (Master I/O module) to the telecommunications network as shown in Figure 87. For pinout connections, refer to Table 87.

The molex 60-pin interface is only available if the MMU has a Standard Master I/O module or an Expansion I/O module.

Figure 87 E1/T1 interface (molex 60-pin)

5-84

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Installing an XPIC interface


To provide an XPIC link, use an XPIC cable (Cambium part number N000081L004A) to connect the two modem modules of a dual modem MMU together using the XPIC Interface ports located on each modem module (Figure 88). Figure 88 XPIC interface

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

5-85

Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links)

Chapter 5: Installation

5-86

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment


This chapter describes how to configure a PTP 810 link and align its antennas. Observe the precautions in Preparing for configuration and alignment on page 6-2. Configure the two units by performing the following tasks: Task 1: Connecting to the unit on page 6-3 Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces on page 6-14 Task 3: Configuring wireless interface on page 6-24 Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces on page 6-38 Task 5: Configuring data orderwire on page 6-48 Task 6: Configuring protection on page 6-50 Task 7: Setting up SNMP agent on page 6-54 Task 8: Configuring alarms and messages on page 6-57 Task 9: Configuring syslog on page 6-62

When all equipment has been installed at both link ends, perform the following tasks: Task 10: Configuring quality of service on page 6-63 Task 11: Configuring VLAN on page 6-73 Task 12: LACP configuration on page 6-92 Task 13: Connecting link to the network on page 6-94 Task 14: Aligning antennas on page 6-98 Task 15: Reviewing configuration and performance on page 6-104

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-1

Preparing for configuration and alignment

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Preparing for configuration and alignment


Before proceeding with unit configuration and antenna alignment, perform the checks described in this section.

Safety precautions during configuration and alignment


All national and local safety standards must be followed while configuring the units and aligning the antennas.

Ensure that personnel are not exposed to unsafe levels of RF energy. The units start to radiate as soon as they are powered up. Respect the safety standards defined in Radiation hazard assessment on page 4-83, in particular the minimum separation distances. Never work in front of the antenna when the MMU is powered. Always power down the MMU before connecting or disconnecting the drop cable from the MMU, ODU or LPU.

Regulatory compliance during configuration and alignment


When configuring the units and aligning the antennas, follow all applicable radio regulations. For more information, refer to Electromagnetic compliance on page 4-79.

Selecting configuration options


Use the installation report to determine which configuration options are required. Refer to Link planning on page 2-2.

Purchasing license key


Before starting configuration of the MMU, purchase authorization key(s) for data throughput capacity or XPIC capability (if required). Refer to Ordering capacity upgrades and XPIC capability on page 2-40.

6-2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Task 1: Connecting to the unit


To connect the MMU to a PC for the purpose of initial configuration, perform the following procedures: Configuring the management PC on page 6-3 Updating the ARP table on page 6-6 Connecting to the PC and powering up on page 6-7

To log into the MMU for configuration purposes, use one of the following alternative methods: Logging into the web interface on page 6-7 Logging into the CLI interface on page 6-9

The remaining tasks in this chapter describe how to configure the MMU using the web interface only.

Configuring the management PC


To configure the local management PC to communicate with the PTP 810, proceed as follows:

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-3

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Display the Local Area Connection Properties dialog. The path to this dialog depends on Windows version and PC configuration, for example select: Control Panel, Network Connections, Local Area Connection, Properties.

6-4

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Select Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) and click on Properties. The Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) Properties dialog is displayed:

Enter an IP address that is valid for the 192.168.0.X network, avoiding: 192.168.0.0 and 192.168.0.1 A good example is 192.168.0.3 as shown.

Enter a subnet mask of 255.255.255.0. Leave the default gateway blank.

Click on OK.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-5

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

If the network adaptor supports advanced properties then configure Ethernet Speed and Duplex for automatic negotiation. One example, based on a Broadcom adaptor, is shown:

Updating the ARP table


All PTP 810 units are supplied by Cambium with the same default IP address. When the management PC is connected to a PTP 810 unit, it creates an association between the default IP address (192.168.0.1) and the MAC address of the PTP 810. If two or more PTP 810 units are being configured, then remove this association after each unit has been configured. To remove the association between IP address and MAC address in the ARP table of the management PC: open a command prompt window on the PC and enter this command: arp d 192.168.0.1 When this address is next used, the PC will connect it with the MAC address of the unit being configured and update the ARP table with the new association.

6-6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Connecting to the PC and powering up


To connect the MMU to the PC and power it up, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 4 Connect the MMU to an ODU for a single modem MMU or to two ODUs for a dual modem MMU. Connect the PC Ethernet port to the NMS 1 or NMS 2 port of the MMU using a straight-through or crossed Cat5e cable. Switch on the MMU power supply. Wait until the MMU Control Module Status LED shows green steady. This normally occurs within 3 minutes from applying power.

Logging into the web interface


If the management PC is connected to another LAN it may need to be configured to not use proxy servers for this IP address. To log into the MMU web interface, proceed as follows: 1 Start the web browser from the management PC. Use either Internet Explorer version 5.5 (or above) or Mozilla Firefox (latest version). The web interface also requires the use of Sun Java Runtime Environment 5.0 (or above). Type the default IP address of the unit into the address bar: 192.168.0.1 and press ENTER. A popup window prompts for user name and password entry:

Enter default user name administrator and password (Table 225), then select OK.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-7

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Upon successful authentication, the Starting Information page is displayed (Figure 89).

Table 225 Default usernames and passwords User Level Monitor Operator Administrator Username monitor operator administrator Password monitor col1ma d1scovery

Figure 89 Starting Information page

6-8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Logging into the CLI interface


View CLI pages using a window of 25 rows by 80 columns (25 x 80). A window of less than 25 x 80 will have incomplete content. The CLI provides a text based interface for configuring and monitoring the terminal. To access the CLI, use one of the following methods: Ethernet interface, Windows standard telnet client, or RS232 connection via a serial terminal.

Ethernet interface
To access the CLI via an Ethernet interface, proceed as follows: 1 2 Telnet / SSH to the terminal (using IP address of the terminal). Enter a user name and password at the login prompt.

Windows standard telnet client


To access the CLI via a Windows standard telnet client, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 Select menu option Start, Run. In the Run window type: telnet [IP address] Enter a user name and password at the login prompt.

RS232 connection via a serial terminal


To establish an RS232 connection using a serial terminal, proceed as follows: 1 2 Connect the Serial/Alarm port on the MMU to a COM port on the computer. Start a hyperterminal session and select the following COM port settings: Bits per second: 38400 Data bit: 8 Parity: None Stop bits: 1 Flow Control: None

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-9

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

For optimum viewing, use the following terminal and ASCII settings: Emulation: VT 100 Line Delay: 50 ms Character Delay: 10 ms Text Wrap: On

4 5

Power on the MMU. Once the boot process is complete, press the keyboard return key to receive a login prompt. Enter a user name and password at the login prompt.

Successful authentication
Upon successful authentication, the CLI General Information page is displayed (Figure 90). Switch to the Main Menu screen by pressing the M-key. Use the Main Menu to navigate through various interface screens.

Figure 90 CLI General Information page

Menu pages
Use the menu screens to navigate between functions. They display a list of navigation choices. Each choice is listed with a character encased within [ ] braces, or hotkey. Press the hotkey to switch to the corresponding page. For example, in the CLI Main Menu ( Figure 91), enter a / A, to switch to the General Information page.

6-10

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Figure 91 CLI Main Menu page

Further references to hotkey in this document will refer to the character encapsulated in [ ] brackets for the individual parameter.

Configurable pages
Configurable pages are used to set various parameters. For example, Figure 92 shows the Date and Time page.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-11

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 92 Example of a configurable CLI page

Parameters are listed with their values and a hotkey. Press the hotkey to configure the corresponding parameter. For example, enter a / A, to edit Date, then press Enter key. Some parameters may have a set list of values. For example, the SNTP Server Enable parameter has two values: Enabled and Disable. To edit this type of parameter, press the corresponding hotkey (in this case D), then press the Space Bar-key, to scroll through different values. Once the desired value is displayed, press the Enter key. If the parameter is displayed without a hotkey, it indicates a read-only parameter. All the CLI pages display the following message types: Navigation Message: Help message about possible navigation from the page. This is displayed at top left and top right of the page. Screen Message: Help message about the page. This is displayed at the 24 row. Access Message: Help message about how to access parameters of the page. This is th displayed at the 25 (last) row.
th

6-12

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 1: Connecting to the unit

In the CLI, there are two different types of parameter updates. Some parameters are updated individually and others are updated as a group: To perform an individual update: edit the parameter value and press the ENTER key. If update is successful, the message Updated Successfully is displayed. If the update fails, a failure message is displayed. To perform a group update: edit the parameter value, press the ENTER key and press the character specified for Update. If update is successful, the message Updated Successfully is displayed. If the update fails, a failure message is displayed.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-13

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces


This task consists of the following procedures: Configuring the IP interface on page 6-14 Reconnecting to the management PC on page 6-15 Configuring Serial Port on page 6-15 Configuring Ethernet payload on page 6-16 Configuring Ethernet network management on page 6-21

Configuring the IP interface


The IP interface allows users to connect to the PTP 810 web interface, either from a locally connected computer or from a management network. To configure the IP interface, select menu option Administration, Network Configuration, General. The General Network Configuration page is displayed (Figure 93). Update the attributes (Table 226) and select Update. To revert to previous values, select Reset. Figure 93 General Network Configuration page

6-14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Table 226 General Network Configuration attributes Attribute IP Address IP Netmask IP Gateway Ethernet Address DHCP Client Meaning The IP address of the MMU. The appropriate netmask depending on the class of the network. The gateway IP Address for the subnet. This should be on the same subnet as the IP Address of the MMU. The MAC or Hardware address of the terminal. Enabled means that network parameters are obtained dynamically from a DHCP server. The other parameters on the page cannot be modified when DHCP is enabled.

Reconnecting to the management PC


If the IP Address, IP Netmask and IP Gateway addresses of the unit have been updated to meet network requirements, then reconfigure the local management PC to use an IP address that is valid for the network. Refer to Configuring the management PC on page 63. When the IP address of the unit has been reconfigured, log in using the new IP address. Refer to Logging into the web interface on page 6-7. Access to the MMU can be recovered by restoring system defaults as described in Restoring system defaults on page 7-54.

Configuring Serial Port


A serial port is provided for basic control and provisioning of the MMU prior to establishing an Ethernet NMS connection. The IP address of the MMU can be read or set from this port. The serial port connector terminates in a high-density DB-15 connector. This connector is shared with the alarm interface. To configure the serial port, select menu option Administration, Serial Configuration. The Serial Configuration page is displayed (Figure 94). Select a suitable Data Baud Rate for the selected device. The default is 38,400 kbps (N,8,1). Select Update. To revert to previous value, select Reset.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-15

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 94 Serial Configuration page

Configuring Ethernet payload


To configure the Ethernet payload, select menu option Administration, Network Configuration, Ethernet Payload. The installed Master I/O module determines which Ethernet Payload page is displayed: Standard Master I/O module (Figure 95) or GigE Master I/O module (Figure 96), or GigE Master I/O module with an SFP module installed (Figure 97). Update the attributes (Table 227 and Table 228) and select Update. To revert to previous values, select Reset.

6-16

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Figure 95 Ethernet Payload page for MMU Standard Master I/O module

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-17

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 96 Ethernet Payload page for MMU GigE Master I/O module

6-18

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Figure 97 Ethernet Payload page for MMU GigE Master I/O module with an SFP module

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-19

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Table 227 Ethernet Payload attributes (Spanning Tree Configuration) Attribute Spanning Tree Mode Bridge Priority Max Age Hello Time Forward Delay Fast Hello Time Meaning Either IEEE 802.1w (RSTP) or Disabled. Bridge priority in range 0 to 61440 (default 32768). The maximum age in seconds in range 6 to 40 seconds (default 20 seconds). The time in range 1 to 10 seconds (default 2 seconds). The delay in range 4 to 30 seconds (default 15 seconds). Enables configuration of Hello Times between 600 and 900 milliseconds. Fast Hello Time is not interoperable with third party equipment such as switches and routers. The Ethernet priority for all ports and for the radio link(s).

Priority

Table 228 Ethernet Payload attributes (Ethernet Port Configuration) Attribute SFP Vendor Name Meaning Only available when an SFP module is installed. Displays the SFP module vendor name. SFP Link Type Only available when an SFP module is installed. Displays the SFP module link type: Optical or Electrical. Auto-Negotiation (*) Port Speed (*) Enable or Disable auto-negotiation. Speed of the Ethernet port (Mbps): Auto, 10 or 100 1000 (GigE Master I/O module only) Port Duplex (*) Flow Control (*) Half / Full The method of flow control employed: Disable or Symmetric Receive Only (GigE Master I/O module only) Transmit Only (GigE Master I/O module only) Master-Slave (*) Only available with GigE Master I/O module. Slave, Master or Auto

6-20

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Attribute Restart AutoNegotiation (*) Shutdown on Link Failure (*) Ethernet Trunk Mode

Meaning Enable or Disable checkbox Enable or Disable checkbox Only available when GigE Master I/O is installed and MMU is configured in East/East operational mode or 2+0 XPIC operational mode. Disable, 2+0 Trunk Port Aggregation or 4+0 Master. Select 2+0 Trunk Port Aggregation to enable Wireless Link Aggregation (see Wireless link aggregation on page 1-7).

Shutdown Radio Ports on Link Failure

Enable or Disable checkbox

Always enable Shutdown Radio Ports on Link Failure. This is a requirement for PTP 810. (*) Set these attributes for: Ports 1-2 (Standard Master I/O module installed); Ports 1-4 (GigE Master I/O module installed); SFP (SFP module installed).

Configuring Ethernet network management


To configure the Ethernet NMS related parameters, select menu option Administration, Network Configuration, Ethernet NMS. The Ethernet NMS page is displayed (Figure 98). Update the attributes (Table 229 and Table 230) and select Update. To revert to previous values, select Reset.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-21

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 98 Ethernet NMS page

6-22

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces

Table 229 Ethernet NMS attributes (Spanning Tree Configuration) Attribute Spanning Tree Mode Bridge Priority Max Age Hello Time Forward Delay Priority Meaning Either IEEE 802.1w (RSTP) or Disabled. Bridge priority in range 0 to 61440 (default 32768). The maximum age in seconds in range 6 to 40 seconds (default 20 seconds). The time in range 1 to 10 seconds (default 2 seconds). The delay in range 4 to 30 seconds (default 15 seconds). The Ethernet priority for all ports and for the radio link(s).

Table 230 Ethernet NMS attributes (Ethernet Port Configuration) Attribute Auto-Negotiation (*) Port Speed (*) Meaning Enable or Disable auto-negotiation. Speed of the Ethernet port (Mbps): 10 or 100 Port Duplex (*) Flow Control (*) Half / Full The method of flow control employed: Disable or Enable Shutdown Radio Ports on Link Failure Enable or Disable checkbox

(*) Set these attributes for both Ports (1-2).

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-23

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface


The Link Configuration Wizard handles the important configuration settings that must be set to comply with the individual license conditions. The Link Configuration Wizard consists of the following procedures: Viewing the configuration summary on page 6-24 Updating link configuration on page 6-25 Configuring APC and coupler loss compensation on page 6-34

Viewing the configuration summary


To view the configuration summary, select menu option Link Configuration, Configuration Summary. The current Summary of Configurations page is displayed (Figure 99). Review the summary. Figure 99 Summary of Configurations page

6-24

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Updating link configuration


Before updating link configuration, check that all license details are available, including: maximum transmit power, antenna gain, transmit and receive frequencies, channel bandwidth, and modulation mode. Select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration. This displays the first of the following series of Link Configuration pages: ODU Operational Mode IDU Operational Mode Payload Configuration ODU Tx Power Configuration ODU Channel Selection Adaptive Coding/Modulation Summary of Configurations (Redo or Update)

Use the last page in the series to choose whether to cancel (Redo) or apply (Update All) any change made in the first six Link Configuration pages.

In the Link Configuration pages, use only the Back and Next buttons to move to previous or next page. Do not use the browser back button.

If the selected parameters on the current page are not supported by the MMU terminal, an error message will be displayed on the next page. To correct the error, go back to the previous page and select a different value for that parameter.

ODU Operational Mode


The ODU Operational Mode page (Figure 100) is the first Link Configuration page (menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration). The ODU Operational Modes map to the PTP 810 link configurations as shown in Table 231. Update the ODU Operational Mode as required and select Next.

Table 231 also shows the number of sets of payload configuration and ODU parameters that are displayed for each ODU operational mode.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-25

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 100 ODU Operational Mode page

Table 231 Step 1: Link Configuration mapping to ODU Operational Modes Link Configuration ODU Operational Mode Payload configuration parameters displayed One set One set One set Two sets Two sets Two sets Two sets ODU parameters displayed

1+ 0 1+1 HSB 1+1 HSB SD Dual 1+0 2+0 Co-Polar 2+0 Cross-Polar 2+0 XPIC

Standard Protected Non-Diversity Protected Non-Diversity East/West East/East East/East 2+0 XPIC

One set One set One set Two sets Two sets Two sets Two sets

6-26

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

IDU Operational Mode


The IDU Operational Mode page (Figure 101) is the second Link Configuration page (menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration).

IDU Operational Mode means MMU Operational Mode. The IDU Operational Mode drop-down menu displays the installed and authorized modes that are available for use. These modes are populated from the authorized entries in the Modes file. Update the IDU Operational Mode as required and select Next.

Figure 101 IDU Operational mode page

In the Modes file, the IDU Operational Modes have the following format: [nnM] - [xxxQ / QPSK] - [E1 / T1] - [X] ; for example 56M-256Q-E1-X , where: Bandwidth (MHz): [nnM] = 7M, 10M, 14M, 20M, 28M, 30M, 40M, 50M, 56M, or 80M. Modulation: [xxxQ / QPSK] = 16Q, 32Q, 64Q, 128Q, 256Q or QPSK. TDM Channel Type: [E1 / T1] = E1, T1. XPIC: [X] = X (appended to IDU Operational Mode parameter only if this is a mode used by XPIC).

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-27

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Payload Configuration
The Payload Configuration page (Figure 102) is the third Link Configuration page (menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration). The configured payload capacity parameter is used to determine the E1/T1, STM-1 and Ethernet capacity over the wireless interface. The maximum number of E1/T1 links over the wireless interface is dependent on the TDM switch capacity of the Master I/O module, the number of termination ports, as well as the link capacity of the modulation mode. Available Ethernet payload capacity is automatically calculated following the selection of the desired TDM payload capacity. Ethernet input/termination capacity greater than 98.7 Mbps is not supported unless a GigE Master I/O module is installed. Update the TDM payload capacity as required and select Next.

The web interface displays 100 Mbps, but the maximum user data capacity for Fast Ethernet is 98.7 Mbps. Figure 102 Payload Configuration page

6-28

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

ODU Tx Power Configuration


The ODU Tx Power Configuration page (Figure 103) is the fourth Link Configuration page (menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration). Update the ODU Tx Configuration attributes (Table 232) and select Next.

Tx Power is limited by the ODU Maximum and Minimum values. The Tx Power level can be further restricted by the selected IDU Operational Mode. If a Tx Power level is entered that is above the maximum allowed Tx value (based on the ODU value or a more restrictive IDU Operational Mode file value), there is no explicit error message generated, but the entry will be rejected. Figure 103 ODU Tx Power Configuration page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-29

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Table 232 ODU Tx Power Configuration attributes Attribute Type Meaning HT means that the ODU is high transmit frequency. LT means that the ODU is low transmit frequency. The MMU obtains this attribute from the ODU; it cannot be updated from the web interface. Start Tx Power Tx Power Update Remote Tx Power The required starting Tx power of the ODU. The current Tx power of the ODU. This is automatically updated on completion of the Link Configuration Wizard. The starting Tx Power of the remote ODU in the link is automatically updated to match that of the local ODU.

ODU Channel Selection


The ODU Channel Selection page (Figure 104) is the fifth Link Configuration page (menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration). Select the Manual Frequency Entry radio button, then enter the ODU center Tx frequency value in units of GHz. The MMU will read the Tx Spacing configuration parameter from the ODU and display it along with calculating the corresponding ODU center Rx frequency.

Pre-configuration of the Tx frequency without an ODU attached to the MMU modem is not supported.

The MMU will only ensure that the center Tx frequency value is within the allowed frequency range of the ODU, but it will not protect against selecting a center Tx frequency that is so close to the high or low end points in the allowed Tx frequency range that the bandwidth of the channel will exceed the max. or min. values of the allowed Tx frequency range. Select Next.

6-30

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Figure 104 ODU Channel Selection page

Adaptive Coding/Modulation
The Adaptive Coding/Modulation page (Figure 105) is the sixth Link Configuration page (menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration).

Release 01-00 of the PTP 810 MMU does not support Adaptive Coding Modulation, but it does not block it either. Select the Disabled radio button and press Next. Figure 105 Adaptive Coding Modulation page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-31

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Summary of Configurations (Redo or Update)


The Summary of Configurations page with Redo and Update All buttons (Figure 106) is the last Link Configuration page (menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration). Choose whether to cancel or apply the configuration changes: To cancel all changes and retain existing configuration, select Redo. To apply all changes to the link configuration, select Update All. Wait for the update process to complete; it will take up to two minutes.

6-32

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Figure 106 Summary of Configurations page with Redo and Update All buttons

Configuring the ODU


Action to be taken on ODU communication failure
The ODU Tx Mute Configuration option is not available if the MMU is in 1+1 Hot Standby operation.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-33

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

To configure the action to be taken in the event of an ODU communication failure, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, ODU Tx Mute Config. The ODU Tx Mute page is displayed (Figure 107). This page is not available in the case of protected (1+1) operation. Click on the required Action on ODU Comm Failure radio button: Mute means that the ODU will be muted to prevent spurious transmission. Output Remains Same means that no action will be taken on failure.

Always select Output Remains Same. The Mute option does not allow ODU-A and ODUB to recover after a communication failure with the MMU. Figure 107 ODU Tx Mute page

Configuring APC and coupler loss compensation


To configure adaptive power control (APC) and coupler loss compensation, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, APC Configuration. The APC Configuration page is displayed (Figure 108).

APC and coupler loss compensation can be configured independently.

6-34

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Figure 108 APC Configuration page

APC
To configure APC, click on the Adaptive Power Control Enabled radio button and update the APC attributes (Table 233). Select Update. Table 233 APC attributes Attribute APC Meaning Enabled means that adaptive power control is enabled. Disabled means that adaptive power control is disabled. RSL Low Threshold RSL High Threshold RSL Maximum Threshold The Received Signal Level Low Threshold. The Received Signal Level High Threshold. The Received Signal Level Maximum Threshold.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-35

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Attribute CER Threshold

Meaning This represents a Channel Error Rate (CER) threshold at which the MMU will request the link partner to increase power. The SNR value on the Status Panel and Graphs is derived from the CER. As CER increases the SNR decreases. The CER Threshold is set to default at 10-5, which would be approximately a BER (Bit Error Rate) of 10-12. Maximum allowed transmit power. For Tx Power Maximum, use the values for the appropriate band as given in Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29 or in the LINKPlanner report. The default values from the modes file are not correct for all bands.

Tx Power Maximum

Tx Power Minimum

Minimum allowed transmit power. For Tx Power Minimum, use the values for the appropriate band as given in Capacity, transmit power and sensitivity on page 4-29 or in the LINKPlanner report. The default values from the modes file are not correct for all bands.

Step Size

The size of the step increments (dB) in which the APC algorithm will raise or lower the transmit power. Default is 1 dB. Enabled means that user modifications to the local MMU thresholds will be duplicated at the far end MMU.

Update Far End Threshold

Coupler Loss Compensation


In a 1+1 HSB configuration, when a coupler with asymmetric attenuation is used, the MMU supports the ability to compensate for coupler loss during HSB switching (assuming that this does not exceed the maximum power for the ODU or the MMU Operational Mode). To configure coupler loss compensation, set Coupler Nominal Power Side to East or West to select which modem is connected to the Primary ODU and enter the additional loss of the Secondary path into the Coupler Loss field (Table 234). Select Update.

6-36

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 3: Configuring wireless interface

Table 234 Coupler loss attributes Attribute Coupler Nominal Power Side Meaning Select East / West. This setting is used for 1+1 Hot Standby operation. It defines whether the East or West modem is connected to the Primary ODU. It should be set to the same value as Preferred ODU Selection (see Table 239). This defines the additional radio loss to the Secondary ODU compared to the Primary ODU. The MMU will ensure that the Secondary ODU increases its transmit power (up to the maximum configured transmit power) to compensate for any additional loss compared to the Primary ODU. If the Primary and Secondary ODUs are connected to a single antenna through an asymmetric coupler, set this to the difference between the Main and Standby coupler losses which are defined in Table 79. If the Primary and Secondary ODUs are connected to a single antenna through a symmetric coupler, set this to 0. If the Primary and Secondary ODUs are connected to separate antennas, set this to the difference between the gains of the two antennas.

Coupler Loss

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-37

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces


If only Ethernet interfaces are required, skip this task. Perform this task to configure the E1/T1 interfaces on the PTP 810 MMU. The MMU uses Channel Mapping to configure the TDM Switch to provide the required E1/T1 routing between the front panel ports and the RF modem links. For an overview description of E1/T1 Channel Mapping and the configuration of the TDM Switch, see E1/T1 switching on page 1-59. This task consists of the following procedures: Configuring channel mapping on page 6-38 Configuring E1/T1 ports on page 6-42 Configuring E1/T1 protection switching on page 6-45

Configuring channel mapping


To configure E1/T1 channel mapping, select menu option Link Configuration, Data Link, E1/T1 Channel Map. The E1/T1 Channel Map page is displayed (Figure 109). Depending on the operators requirements, there are two ways to configure channel mapping: Pre-defined: Select a pre-defined channel map from the E1/T1 Channel Map page. Custom mapping: Type the switch mapping into the E1/T1 Channel Map page.

Pre-defined channel maps


For pre-defined channel mapping, select an option (other than Custom) from the Channel Mapping Type drop-down list (Figure 109). Select Update. There are fourteen pre-defined channel maps. They are all intended to be examples to help in creating custom channel maps. The first eight mappings are general use cases that provision the MMU for looping back available interfaces, mapping various front panel ports to east mappings, mapping various front panel ports to west mappings and mapping various demuxed STM-1 channels to various front port mappings. STM-1 channels are not supported in PTP 810 01-00. The general purpose mappings supported in PTP 810 01-00 are listed in Table 235.

6-38

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Table 235 General purpose mappings Mapping Loopback All_East All_West 16_East_16_West 8_East_8_West Meaning All E1/T1 ports mapped to perform local interface loopback (LIU). All E1/T1 ports mapped to East modem. All E1/T1 ports mapped to West modem. Sixteen E1/T1 ports mapped to East modem and sixteen E1/T1 ports mapped to West modem. Eight E1/T1 ports mapped to East modem and eight E1/T1 ports mapped to West modem.

The general purpose mappings not supported in PTP 810 01-00 include STM1_East, STM1_West and STM1_FP.

The remaining six pre-defined channel maps involve multiple MMUs and are intended as examples for testing purposes. These complex mappings utilize internal cross-connections and require external cross-connections and are not within the scope of this document.

Figure 109 E1/T1 Channel Map page (pre-defined mapping)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-39

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

The contents of the selected Channel Mapping Type are displayed in the Channel Map field. The naming convention is described in Table 236. Table 236 Naming convention used in channel maps Designation En Wn MAn EXn Example E2 W3 MA4 EX2 Meaning East modem timeslot number. West modem timeslot number. Master IO card front panel port number. Expansion IO card front panel port number.

In the example shown in Figure 109, the MMU was configured in a 4-E1, 1+0 mode such that only the first four timeslots on the East modem are available (E1-E4). This is reflected in the four mappings containing E1-E4 listed under Valid Mappings. The additional mappings, pointing to unavailable modem timeslots, are grouped under the Unused Mappings.

Instead of creating a dedicated mapping for each mode, simply create a set of generic mappings. The software automatically ignores any mappings that do not apply to the current mode.

Custom channel maps


For custom channel mapping, select Custom from the Channel Mapping Type drop-down list (Figure 110). Type the channel mapping into the Channel Map field. Use the naming convention described in Table 236. Before selecting Update, ensure that: All available front panel ports are mapped. A modem timeslot is not mapped more than once. For pass-throughs, an East modem timeslot is mapped to a corresponding West modem timeslot.

Select Update. In the example shown in Figure 110, a switch mapping has been typed into the Channel Map display. This mapping configures the TDM Switch to connect the first four East timeslots to the first four Master IO front panel ports, and the first four West timeslots to Master IO ports 5-8. After selecting Update, the TDM Switch is reconfigured. The resulting screen is shown in Figure 111.

6-40

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Figure 110 E1/T1 Channel Map page (custom mapping)

Figure 111 E1/T1 Channel Map page (custom mapping updated)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-41

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

The resulting mapping in this example is grouped in the same way as in the pre-defined mapping example. Because the MMU is configured in a 4-E1, 1+0 mode, the West modem mappings are all set as unused. If the system is reconfigured to 2+0 operation, the west mappings are automatically connected and moved to the Valid Mappings list. The custom channel maps can continue to be edited. A pre-defined channel map can also be copied and pasted into the Channel Map field. The map can then be edited and updated: only the changed E1/T1 links will be affected. All other E1/T1 links will continue to pass data error free.

Channel map errors


The E1/T1 Channel Map page attempts to catch any errors. This is especially useful when editing custom channel maps. The system groups mappings into four basic categories: Valid Mappings: These are syntactically correct mappings which are valid with the current hardware and mode. Unused Mappings: These are syntactically correct mappings, but either the mode or the installed hardware makes them impossible to connect. If the mode is changed, or other hardware is installed (for example, a different Master IO card or an Expansion IO card is added), these mappings will be automatically moved to the valid list. Invalid Mappings: These mappings have a syntax error. They might refer to an invalid port number, or have a spelling mistake. Incomplete Mappings: This is a summary of all of the modem timeslots that are available in the current mode, but either do not have a mapping defined, or have an invalid mapping defined.

Configuring E1/T1 ports


Before configuring E1/T1 related parameters, ensure that the Master IO card is configured and present. Otherwise an error message will be displayed. To configure E1/T1 channel related parameters, select menu option Link Configuration, Data Link, E1/T1 Ports. The E1/T1 Configurations page is displayed (Figure 112). To configure a channel: tick the Apply Settings box, update the required parameters under New Settings (Table 237), then select Update. To revert to the previous values, select Reset.

6-42

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Figure 112 E1/T1 Configurations page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-43

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Table 237 E1/T1 Configurations attributes Attribute Physical Channel Meaning All configured channels are displayed with their current configurations. Inactive channels appear in grey. The number of available channels is dependent on the MMU configuration. MA means that the channel is a Master IO card front panel port. EX means that the channel is an Expansion IO card front panel port. Apply Settings Encoding When ticked, the parameters of this Physical Channel are displayed under New Settings. The encoding method used for this channel. B8ZS means Bipolar with Eight Zero Substitution. AMI means Alternate Mark Inversion. TX Data The type of TX data stream sent over this channel. Normal means that the channel transmits what is received on the front-panel port onto the RF link. All Ones means that the channel replaces the transmit data with a stream of all ones (1111111), effectively generating an alarm condition. This is useful in some debug contexts. Loopback The type of loopback employed over this channel. Normal means no loopback operation. Far means loopback E1/T1 signal received from RF Link back to RF Link. Near means loopback E1/T1 signal received on front-panel port back out the front-panel port. LOS Action The action to be taken when an LOS is detected at the input to the front-panel E1/T1 port. AIS means generate an AIS signal to be transmitted on the RF link for the E1/T1 channel. Nothing means transmit what is received on the frontpanel port on the RF link. LOS/AIS Detection LOS and AIS detection criteria based upon the specified standards (G.775, I.431/ETSI, T1.231 or I.431/T1.231). Depending on the channel type (E1/T1) configuration, the choices displayed will differ.
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-44

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Attribute Build Out

Meaning Build out criteria. Depending on the channel type (E1/T1) configuration, the choices displayed will differ.

Configuring E1/T1 protection switching


E1/T1 Protection Switching or SNCP-Like switching is a feature to provide the redundant path on failure.

PTP 810 only supports SNCP-like protection switching. Set the SNCP upon BER attribute to ON. To configure E1/T1 protection switching, select menu option Link Configuration, Data Link, E1/T1 Protection Switching. The E1/T1 Protection Switching page is displayed (Figure 113). Update the attributes (Table 238), then select Update. To revert to the previous values, select Reset. Figure 113 E1/T1 Protection Switching page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-45

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Table 238 E1/T1 Protection Switching attributes Attribute SNCP upon BER Trigger Threshold Meaning ON means that sub-network connection protection (SNCP) is enabled in E1/T1 path. Only available when SNCP upon BER is ON. Threshold parameter for BER, above which it triggers the protection switching by inserting AIS on the working path. Clear Threshold Only available when SNCP upon BER is ON. Threshold parameter for BER, below which it removes the AIS from the working path. Hold off Timer Only available when SNCP upon BER is ON. Wait duration by system to insert the AIS upon BER reached above the trigger threshold. Enable Protection Select All Hold off Enable means that E1/T1 protection switching is enabled. Apply this configuration to all channels rather than one selected channel. Only available when Enable Protection is Enable. Wait time to switch between the working to protection and vice versa after system finds fault with the current E1/T1 data path. Lockout of Protection Only available when Enable Protection is Enable. The system will never switch to protection path for the particular couplet. Forced Switch to Protection Only available when Enable Protection is Enable. The system will switch the data to protection path irrespective of protection path status. Only available when Enable Protection is Enable. The system will switch the data to working path irrespective of working path status. Only available when Enable Protection is Enable. The system will switch the data to protection path, only if the protection path works fine.

Forced Switch to Working

Manual Switch to Protection

6-46

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 4: Configuring E1/T1 interfaces

Attribute Manual Switch to Working

Meaning Only available when Enable Protection is Enable. The system will switch the data to working path, only if the working path works fine. Clears any local user command.

Clear

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-47

Task 5: Configuring data orderwire

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 5: Configuring data orderwire


Perform this task to configure a serial data orderwire channel over the wireless link. The MMU enables an auxiliary serial data orderwire (DOW) channel for control of external equipment. The channel will support operation at a rate of 64 kbps using the RS-422 protocol or 19.2 kbps using the RS-232 protocol.

Configuring orderwire
To configure data orderwire, select menu option Link Configuration, Data Link, Orderwire. The Voice Orderwire Configuration page is displayed (Figure 114). Select the value for the DOW Mode (RS-232 / RS-422). Select Update.

The Voice Orderwire Configuration page allows the configuration of both voice orderwire (VOW) and data orderwire (DOW), but VOW is not supported in PTP 810.

6-48

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 5: Configuring data orderwire

Figure 114 Voice Orderwire Configuration

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-49

Task 6: Configuring protection

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 6: Configuring protection


Perform this task if the PTP 810 link is to be protected. This task is the same for both 1+1 HSB and 1+1 HSB SD. This task consists of the following procedure: Configuring protection on page 6-50

Configuring protection
The Protection Configuration page is available only if the MMU is configured for 1+1 operation (that is, two Modem/IF Modules and two Power Supply Modules are installed in the MMU). To configure link protection, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Protection Configuration. The Protection Configuration page is displayed (Figure 115). Update the attributes (Table 239) and select Update.

Figure 115 Protection Configuration page

6-50

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 6: Configuring protection

Table 239 Protection Configuration attributes Attribute Power down ODU after switch Meaning Enabled means that the ODU is powered down after a protection switch. Use this option to ensure that the ODU that had a fault does not transmit outside of a licensed band. If 'Enabled' is selected and a protection switch occurs, the MMU will attempt to power up the ODU that had a fault automatically after 3 minutes (as stand-by ODU). It will automatically power down the ODU that had a fault if an alarm condition still exists. Select East or West. This defines whether the East or West modem is connected to the Primary ODU. This is the preferred ODU for transmitting and must be connected to the antenna or coupler with the lowest path loss. For 1+1 Hot Standby deployments where the ODUs are coupled to a common antenna, the Primary ODU must connect to the side of the coupler labeled MAIN. For 1+1 deployments where the ODUs are connected to separate antennas, the Primary ODU connects to the antenna with the highest gain. If the gains are equal, either ODU can be the Primary ODU. If the East modem is connected to the Primary ODU, set this to East. If the West modem is connected to the Primary ODU, set this to West. APS Switch (Automatic Protection Switch) Enabled means that 1+1 Hot Standby Tx switching is enabled. This would normally be set to enabled, but could be disabled to allow for system maintenance on a live link. Disabling this feature turns off the ODU Alarm, ODU Hot-Swap and Remote Switching. Remote Switching has a separate user configurable option for enabling and disabling. Remote Transmitter Switching is a method by which a 1+1 Hot Standby protected link can try to recover from a one way lock condition. For more information, refer to Remote transmitter switching algorithm on page 6-52. An update to enable or disable APS on the local MMU will likewise enable or disable APS on the remote MMU. User initiated transmit protection switch.

Preferred ODU

Remote Transmitter Switching

Update Remote APS Switch Switch Transmitting ODU

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-51

Task 6: Configuring protection

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Remote transmitter switching algorithm


The algorithm is visually explained in Figure 116. By enabling the feature, it allows a near end MMU to monitor the Lock Status of the remote MMU. If a one way link occurs due to, for example, a transmitter failure on the near side ODU that does not trigger an ODU alarm, the far end Lock Status will become Unlocked. The near end MMU will perform a protection switch to try to recover by switching to the stand-by ODU. In other words, the near end ODU may have a transmitter failure, but no issue with its receiver. In this case, it can still receive Lock Status information from the far side. The far side can, in effect, tell the near side that it is no longer locked (not receiving a signal). The near side will perform a protection switch based on this data if Remote Switching is enabled. The switching takes place at the system software application level. This feature is not designed as a fast protection switch but rather further redundancy to recover a link in a situation in which the ODU cannot self detect a transmit alarm condition.

6-52

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 6: Configuring protection

Figure 116 Remote transmit switch algorithm

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-53

Task 7: Setting up SNMP agent

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 7: Setting up SNMP agent


Perform this task to configure SNMP, if required.

Configuring SNMP agent


Perform this procedure to configure the system to generate Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) traps. To configure the SNMP agent, select menu option Administration, Network Configuration, SNMP. The SNMP Configuration page is displayed (Figure 117). Update the attributes (Table 226) and select Update. Figure 117 SNMP Configuration page

6-54

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 7: Setting up SNMP agent

Table 240 SNMP Configuration attributes Attribute SNMP Mode Trap Version Meaning Mode in which SNMP Agent is currently configured (v1-v2v3 / v1 only / v2 only / v3 only / Disabled) Trap Version in which SNMP Agent is currently configured (v1 / v2). A trap is an SNMP message issued by an SNMP agent that reports an event. The Trap Version parameter configures the SNMP trap version. The SNMP agent uses the specified version to send the traps to configured trap managers. Auth Trap Enable Enable/Disable sending of authorization traps to SNMP manager. When enabled, SNMP agent generates Authentication failure trap on authentication failure in any request. Read Community Community String used while reading data from the SNMP Agent in SNMP V1/V2 mode. A community string is an SNMP security password. The Read Community string is used in read operation of SNMP v1 or v2, and allows the SNMP manager to issue Get and GetNext messages. Write Community Community String used while writing data to the SNMP Agent in SNMP V1/V2 mode. The Write Community string is used in write operation of SNMP v1 or v2, and allows the SNMP Manager to issue Set messages. Trap Community Community String used while sending traps from the SNMP Agent. The Trap Community string allows the SNMP agent to issue Trap messages. SNMP Auth Password Password required for authorization while reading or writing data in SNMP V3 Mode. The SNMP Auth Password is used in only SNMP v3 mode of operation and is the authorization password for the admin user.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-55

Task 7: Setting up SNMP agent

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Attribute SNMP Priv Password

Meaning Privacy password required while reading or writing data in SNMP V3 Mode. The SNMP Priv Password is used in only SNMP v3 mode of operation and is the privacy password for the admin user.

Trap Manager #1 - #4

IP Addresses of the Trap Managers to which Traps are to be sent. Trap Manager configures the trap managers IP addresses. A maximum of four Trap managers can be configured. The SNMP agent sends the traps to all the configured trap managers.

The MMU implements SNMPv3 as follows: Auth Protocol: MD5 Priv Protocol: DES Security model: authPriv with authentication and with privacy

To access the MMU via SNMPv3 both Auth password and Priv password (passwords length >= 8 characters) are required. For the default security name admin, Auth and Priv passwords can be configured from Web GUI and SNMP Configuration.

6-56

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 8: Configuring alarms and messages

Task 8: Configuring alarms and messages


This task consists of the following procedures: Configuring generation of diagnostics alarms on page 6-57 Configuring alarm thresholds on page 6-59

Configuring generation of diagnostics alarms


To select which diagnostic alarms will be notified to the system administrator, select menu option Analysis, Alarms, Alarm Configuration. The Alarm Configuration page is displayed (Figure 118). The full list of alarms is described in Alarms on page V. Update attributes as required (Table 241) and select Update. To mask all alarms, select Check All Mask. To unmask all alarms, select Uncheck All Mask. To activate E-mail notification for all alarms, select Check All Mail. To deactivate E-mail notification for all alarms, select Uncheck All Mail.

PTP 810 does not support E-mail notification for alarms. Select Uncheck All Mail to deactivate this feature.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-57

Task 8: Configuring alarms and messages

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 118 Alarm Configuration page

6-58

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 8: Configuring alarms and messages

Table 241 Alarm Configuration attributes Attribute Description Mask Meaning Displays the description of the alarm. If an alarm is active (set), the description of that alarm is red in color. Masking of a particular alarm. If checked , that particular alarm will be ignored. A masked alarm being ignored means the alarm will not appear in the Analysis, Alarms, Active page or in the Analysis, Alarms, History page from the time that the alarm was masked. The alarms will also not appear in the Alarm screens of the CLI. If checked, upon occurrence of this alarm the configured users are notified by E-mail. Displays the type of the alarm (Critical / Major / Info). Maps alarm output to one of the four external alarm outputs.

E-mail Severity AL1 AL4

Configuring alarm thresholds


To configure alarm threshold parameters, select menu option Analysis, Alarms, Threshold. The Alarm Threshold page is displayed (Figure 119). Update attributes as required (Table 242) and select Update.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-59

Task 8: Configuring alarms and messages

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 119 Alarm Threshold page

6-60

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 8: Configuring alarms and messages

Table 242 Alarm Threshold attributes Attribute RSL Alarm Threshold SNR Threshold Max/Min MMU Temperature Max/Min ODU Temperature (East and West) External Alarm Signal Level Meaning Threshold value for RSL alarm (in dBm units). Threshold value for Signal/Noise alarm (in dB units). Threshold values for temperature alarm (in Celsius units). Threshold values for temperature alarm (in Celsius units).

Select Active Low or Active High. These correspond to the four external alarm inputs available on the Control Module DB15 connector: pins 9, 14, 10 and 15 and they default to active low. Each alarm input can be configured to be active high (pulled down to GND with a 10K resistor) or active low (pulled up to +5 VDC with a 10K resistor). Voltage swings on these alarm inputs should not exceed 0 to 5 VDC.

Jumper positions
Based on the External Alarm Signal Level radio button selection, the external alarm input jumper positions are displayed on the Alarm Threshold page (Figure 119). The Control Module has configurable shunt jumpers to control the active polarity of these signals. The diagram above identifies which jumpers to manipulate as required when the Active Low or Active High state is selected. The jumpers shown on the Alarm Threshold page represent the jumpers located on the left side, top of the controller card. These jumpers have to be physically placed to match the picture shown on this page. Operators can change these jumper settings at their discretion to be driven by the specific external devices at a particular operator site (such as a sensor indicating a door open to the building where the MMU is located).

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-61

Task 9: Configuring syslog

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 9: Configuring syslog


Perform this task when system logging is required. For more information on syslog, refer to Managing event notification messages on page 720.

Configuring system logging (syslog)


Only users with Administrator access rights are permitted to configure the syslog client. To configure system logging, select menu option Administration, Network Configuration, Syslog Server Configuration. The Syslog Configuration page is displayed (Figure 120). Update the attributes as required (Table 243), then select Update. Figure 120 Syslog Configuration page

Table 243 Syslog Configuration attributes Attribute Syslog Server Syslog Facility Meaning The IP Address of the Syslog server. If unsure contact your network administrator. Syslog facilities in accordance with the standard UNIX Syslog facilities Local0 Local7, which are eight facilities identified for customized auditing.

6-62

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Task 10: Configuring quality of service


Perform this task when configuration of Ethernet Quality of Service is required. This task consists of the following procedures: Setting QoS priority method on page 6-63 Setting QoS port priorities on page 6-66 Setting QoS VLAN p-bit tag priorities on page 6-68 Setting QoS DiffServ DSCP priorities on page 6-69 Setting QoS switch priorities on page 6-71

Setting QoS priority method


To choose which QoS priority method is to be enabled, select menu option Administration, QoS Configuration, Global Settings. The installed Master I/O module determines which QoS Global Configuration page is displayed.

Standard Master I/O module


For an MMU with the Standard Master I/O module installed, the QoS Global Configuration page is displayed as shown in Figure 121. Update the attributes as required (Table 244), then select Update. Figure 121 QoS Global Configuration page (Standard Master I/O module)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-63

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Table 244 QoS Global Configuration attributes (Standard Master I/O module) Attribute Port Priority VLAN p-bit Tag Priority DiffServ Priority Priority Resolution Meaning Enabled or Disabled. Enabled or Disabled. Enabled or Disabled. Only available when both VLAN p-bit TAG Priority and DiffServ Priority are Enabled. Resolves which QoS protocol (VLAN pbit TAG or Diffserv) will be used to determine the priority queue. If VLAN p-bit TAG is selected as the Priority Resolution, the pbit will be used to determine the priority queue on a packet that has both p-bit and DSCP field. On a packet that has no pbit (because it is not VLAN tagged), the DSCP field will be used to determine the priority queue. If Diffserv is selected as the Priority Resolution, only the DSCP field will be used to determine the priority queue on a packet, while p-bit will be ignored. Queue Scheduling Policy The queue scheduling policy: Strict Priority Scheme or Weighted Fair Queuing Scheme.

GigE Master I/O module


For an MMU with the GigE Master I/O module installed, the QoS Global Configuration page is displayed as shown in Figure 122. Update the attributes as required (Table 245), then select Update.

6-64

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Figure 122 QoS Global Configuration page (GigE Master I/O module)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-65

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Table 245 QoS Global Configuration attributes (GigE Master I/O module) Attribute Port Priority VLAN p-bit Tag Priority DiffServ Priority High Queue Preempt Meaning Select Enabled / Disabled. Select Enabled / Disabled. Select Enabled / Disabled. Select Enabled / Disabled. High Queue Preempt services the highest priority queue, interrupting the weighted fair queuing, as needed. When the highest priority queue is empty, the remaining queues are serviced per the weighted fair queuing algorithm and configured weights. Set the number of Tx packets per round (1-49) for each priority queue weight.

Priority Queue Weight 0 - 3

Setting QoS port priorities


Use the QoS Port Priority Map page to map traffic from Ethernet (FE or GE) ports to specific priority queues. To set the QoS port priority mappings, select menu option Administration, QoS Configuration, Port Priority. The installed Master I/O module determines which QoS Port Priority Map page is displayed.

Standard Master I/O module


For an MMU with the Standard Master I/O module installed, the QoS Port Priority Map page is displayed as shown in Figure 123. Use this page to configure the QoS priority for front panel Ports 1 and 2 and the East and West radio ports. Enter the frame priority for each port (0 Low - 3 High). Select Update.

6-66

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Figure 123 QoS Port Priority Map page (Standard Master I/O module)

GigE Master I/O module


For an MMU with the GigE Master I/O module installed, the QoS Port Priority Map page is displayed as shown in Figure 124. Use this page to configure the QoS priority for front panel Ports 1 4, the SFP port priority (available only if the SFP module is installed) and the East and West radio ports. Enter the frame priority for each port (0 Low 7 High). Select Update.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-67

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 124 QoS Port Priority Map for GigE Master I/O module

Setting QoS VLAN p-bit tag priorities


Use the QoS VLAN p-bit Tag Priority Map page to map VLAN tagged packets to specific priority queues based upon the priority field in the VLAN tag (IEEE 802.1Q). To set the QoS VLAN p-bit tag priority mappings, select menu option Administration, QoS Configuration, VLAN p-bit Tag Priority. The QoS VLAN p-bit Tag Priority Map page is displayed (Figure 125). Both the Standard Master I/O module and the GigE Master I/O module display the same version of this page. Enter the frame priority for each tag. The GigE Master I/O module supports prioritization values of 0-7. The Standard Master I/O module supports prioritization values of 0-3. The default frame priority values for tag priorities will differ with the installed Master I/O module. Select Update.

6-68

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Figure 125 QoS VLAN p-bit Tag Priority Map page

Setting QoS DiffServ DSCP priorities


Use the QoS DiffServ DSCP Map page to map IPv4 packets to specific priority queues based upon the DS field in the IPv4 header (see RFC 2474). To set the QoS DiffServ DSCP mappings, select menu option Administration, QoS Configuration, DiffServ Priority. The installed Master I/O module determines which QoS DiffServ DSCP Map page is displayed.

Standard Master I/O module


For an MMU with the Standard Master I/O module installed, the QoS DiffServ DSCP Map page is displayed as shown in Figure 126. Use this page to configure the QoS DiffServ DSCP Priority Map for DSCP Priority 0 DSCP Priority 63. Enter the Tx queue for each DSCP priority (0 Low 3 High). Select Update.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-69

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 126 QoS DiffServ DSCP Map page (Standard Master I/O module)

GigE Master I/O module


For an MMU with the GigE Master I/O module installed, the QoS DiffServ DSCP Map page is displayed as shown in Figure 127. Use this page to configure the QoS DiffServ DSCP Priority Map for DSCP Priority 0 DSCP Priority 63. Enter the switch priority for each DSCP (switch priority: 0 Low 7 High). The Switch Priority is an intermediate internal eight-level priority value which is assigned to the packets as they ingress the switch. Select Update.

6-70

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Figure 127 QoS DiffServ DSCP Priority Map for GigE Master I/O module

Setting QoS switch priorities


Use the QoS Switch Priority Map page used to configure an MMU with the GigE Master I/O module installed. To set the QoS switch priority mappings, select menu option Administration, QoS Configuration, Switch Priority. The Switch Priority to Tx Priority Queue Map page is displayed (Figure 128).

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-71

Task 10: Configuring quality of service

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Use this page to configure the QoS Switch Priority to Tx Priority Queue Map for Switch Priority 0 Switch Priority 7. Enter the Tx queue for each switch priority (0 Low 3 High). Select Update. Figure 128 Switch Priority to Tx Priority Queue Map (GigE Master I/O module)

6-72

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Task 11: Configuring VLAN


Perform this task when configuration of Ethernet Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) is required. For an overview of VLAN operation, see Ethernet bridging in the customer network on page 1-38. This task consist of the following procedures: Configuring global VLAN options on page 6-73 Configuring static VLANs on page 6-75 Configuring port based VLANs on page 6-77 Configuring MSTPs on page 6-88 Mapping VLANs to MSTP instances on page 6-91

To assist with VLAN configuration, two example VLAN configurations are provided in Example VLAN configurations on page 6-78.

Configuring global VLAN options


To configure global VLAN options, select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuration, Global VLAN Configuration. The Global VLAN Configuration page is displayed (Figure 129). Update the attributes (Table 246) and select Update.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-73

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 129 Global VLAN Configuration page

Table 246 Global VLAN Configuration attributes Attribute VLAN Management Default VLAN ID Default Priority Meaning Select VLAN operation (Disable, Single Tag, Double Tag (Stag+Ctag), Double Tag (Ctag+Ctag). For each port select the default VLAN ID for packets that are untagged on ingress. For each port select the default VLAN Priority for packets that are untagged on ingress.

6-74

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Attribute Ingress Policy

Meaning For each port select the Ingress Policy (Admit All, Admit Tag Only) to be used for each port. Either all frames will be admitted or only 802.1Q frames will be admitted for ingress on the specified port. This configuration is only available when configured for Single Tag operation. For each port select the Egress Policy (Remove, Dont Remove) to be used for each port. Either the 802.1Q tag will be removed or it wont be removed when the frame egresses on the specified port. This configuration is only available when configured for Single Tag operation. For each port select the Port Double Tag Mode (Network, User) to be used for each port. This selection is only available when configured for Double Tag operation.

Egress Policy

Port Double Tag

Configuring static VLANs


To configure static VLANs, select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuratio, Static VLAN Configuration. The Static VLAN Configuration page is displayed with the currently configured VLANs in the Current Static VLAN Entries table (Figure 130). By default, all the ports are included in a Default VLAN with VLAN ID 1. To add a new static VLAN entry, select Add New VLAN. To edit a static VLAN entry, click on the pencil icon in the Edit column on the appropriate static VLAN entry row. To remove a static VLAN entry, click on the red X in the Delete column on the appropriate static VLAN entry row.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-75

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 130 Static VLAN Configuration

For new or edited static VLANs, the Add/Edit VLAN Configuration page is displayed (Figure 131). Update the attributes (Table 247) and select Update. Figure 131 Add/Edit VLAN Configuration

6-76

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Table 247 Add/Edit VLAN Configuration attributes Attribute VLAN ID VLAN Name Port Meaning The VLAN ID of the static VLAN entry. A descriptive name for the static VLAN entry. Include means the port is included in the static VLAN entry. Exclude means the port is excluded from the static VLAN entry. East/West For the VLAN ID, select whether to include or exclude the East modem port and the West modem port as part of the VLAN.

Configuring port based VLANs


To configure port based VLANs, select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuration, Port Based Forwarding. The Port Based Forwarding Mode page is displayed (Figure 132). Select the appropriate checkboxes to enable forwarding between ports. Select Update. Figure 132 Port Based Forwarding Mode page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-77

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Example VLAN configurations


To assist with VLAN configuration, two example VLAN configurations are provided here. The first example gives the procedures for a Static Tag Based VLAN configuration. The second example gives the procedures for a Port Based VLAN configuration.

Static tag based VLAN configuration


When configuring the 2+0 with trunk mode, do not perform this procedure. See Link Aggregation on page 7-25. This example shows the procedure to configure a Static Tag Based VLAN using the Single Tag VLAN Mode with the following configuration requirements: LAN Port 1 and East Port in one VLAN with VLAN ID 2. LAN Port 2 and West Port in another VLAN with VLAN ID 3. Untagged packets that ingress on LAN port 1 is added a tag with VLAN ID 2. Untagged packets that ingress on LAN port 2 is added a tag with VLAN ID 3.

To configure these requirements, proceed as follows: 1 Select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuration, Global VLAN Configuration. Set VLAN management to Single Tag and select Update.

6-78

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Configure the Default VLAN ID and Default Priority of the LAN Ports. The MMU used Default VLAN ID and Default Priority to tag the untagged frames that ingress the port.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-79

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Configure the Ingress Policy: either to admit 802.1Q frames only, or to admit all frames for ingress on each port.

6-80

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Configure the Egress Policy, that is, whether or not to remove the 802.1Q tag when frames egress on the LAN Port.

Select Update.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-81

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

To define ports to be included in the VLAN, select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuration, Static VLAN Configuration in the left panel. By default, all the ports are included in a Default VLAN with VLAN ID 1.

Default VLAN is not required, so exclude it from the network. Click on the Edit icon to bring up the Add/Edit VLAN Configuration page. Exclude the ports from the Default VLAN before including them in another VLAN. When finished, select Update.

6-82

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Select Add New VLAN. Create a new VLAN with VLAN ID 2. Include LAN Port 1 and East Port in this VLAN. When finished, select Update.

Select Add New VLAN. Create a new VLAN with VLAN ID 3. Include LAN Port 2 and West Port in this VLAN. When finished, select Update.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-83

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

This is the final state of the Static VLAN Configuration page with the new VLANs defined for the Single Tag VLAN.

Port Based VLAN Configuration


This example shows the procedure to configure a Port Based VLAN using the Port Based Forwarding Mode with the following configuration requirements: LAN Port 1 is grouped with LAN Port 4 & East Port. LAN Port 2 is grouped with LAN Port 3 & West Port. LAN Port 3 is grouped with West Port. LAN Port 4 is grouped with East Port. Any Packet (Untagged, Single or Double Tagged) ingressing at LAN Port 1 can only be forwarded out of LAN Port 4 & East Ports respectively. Any Packet (Untagged, Single or Double Tagged) ingressing at LAN Port 2 can only be forwarded out of LAN Port 3 & West Ports respectively. Any Packet (Untagged, Single or Double Tagged) ingressing at LAN Port 3 can only be forwarded out of West Port. Any Packet (Untagged, Single or Double Tagged) ingressing at LAN Port 4 can only be forwarded out of East Port.

To configure these requirements, proceed as follows:

6-84

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Navigate to Administration, VLAN Configuration, Port Based Forwarding Mode in the left panel. When Port Based Forwarding Mode is configured for the first time then the default configuration will be displayed.

Include the East port in the forwarding group of LAN Port 1. The bidirectional mapping marked in Port 1 row of Port Connection Table shown below indicates that packets ingressing at LAN Port 1 can only be forwarded to East Port & those ingressing at East Port can only be forwarded to LAN Port 1.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-85

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Include the West port in the forwarding group of LAN Port 2. The bidirectional mapping marked in Port 2 row of Port Connection Table shown below indicates that packets ingressing at LAN Port 2 can only be forwarded to West Port & those ingressing at West Port can only be forwarded to LAN Port 2.

Include the West port in the forwarding group of LAN Port 3. The bidirectional mapping marked in Port 3 row of Port Connection Table shown below indicates that packets ingressing at LAN Port 3 can only be forwarded to West Port & those ingressing at West Port can also be forwarded to LAN Port 3 in addition to LAN Port 2.

6-86

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Include the East port in the forwarding group of LAN Port 4. The bidirectional mapping marked in Port 4 row of Port Connection Table shown below indicates that packets ingressing at LAN Port 4 can only be forwarded to East Port & those ingressing at East Port can also be forwarded to LAN Port 4 in addition to LAN Port 1.

Edit the LAN Port 1 forwarding group so as to include LAN Port 4. This is required in order to forward packets ingressing at LAN Port 1 to LAN Port 4 in addition to East Port.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-87

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Edit the LAN Port 2 forwarding group so as to include LAN Port 3. This is required in order to forward packets ingressing at LAN Port 2 to LAN Port 3 in addition to West Port.

Press the Update button to complete the Port Based VLAN configuration.

Configuring MSTPs
The IEEE 802.1s Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol (MSTP) defines an extension to RSTP to further develop the usefulness of virtual LANs (VLANs). This Per-VLAN Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol configures a separate Spanning Tree for each VLAN group and blocks all but one of the possible alternative paths within each Spanning Tree. To configure MSTPs, select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuration, MSTP Configuration. The MSTP Configuration page is displayed. If no current MSTP instances exist (for example because the user is defining an MSTP instance for the first time), the page is as shown in Figure 133. If at least one MSTP instance has already been created, the page is as shown in Figure 134. Update the attributes (Table 248). To create a new instance, select Create. To update an instance, select Update. To delete an instance, select Delete.

6-88

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Figure 133 MSTP Configuration page (when no MSTP instances exist)

Figure 134 MSTP Configuration page (when MSTP instances exist)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-89

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Table 248 MSTP Configuration attributes Attribute Configuration Name Meaning The name identifying the VLAN to MSTI mapping. Bridges must share the name and revision (see below), as well as the VLAN-to-MSTI mapping configuration in order to share spanning trees for MSTI's (Intra-region). The name is at most 32 characters. The revision of the MSTI configuration named above. This must be an integer between 0 and 65535. This defines the initial value of remaining Hops for MSTI information generated at the boundary of an MSTI region. It defines how many bridges a root bridge can distribute its BPDU information to. Valid values are in the range 6 to 40 hops. In this drop down menu the user can select the STP MSTI bridge instance to configure or can select create to create a new instance. When a new instance is to be created this field is used to identify that particular instance. When a new instance is to be created this field sets the priority of this bridge for that particular instance. Allows port priority configuration which affects the topology of instance X only.

Revision Maximum Hops

Instance

MST Instance ID Instance Priority Instance X port priority configuration

6-90

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 11: Configuring VLAN

Mapping VLANs to MSTP instances


To map VLANs to MSTP instances (MSTIs), select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuration, MSTP Instance VLAN. The MSTP Instance to VLAN Map page is displayed (Figure 135). A VLAN can only be mapped to one MSTI. Bridges must share the same VLAN-to-MSTI mapping configuration in order to share spanning trees for MSTIs (Intra-region).

Use the Search option to find a specific VLAN ID to be mapped. Click on the radio buttons to configure the mappings, then select Update.

Figure 135 MSTP Instance to VLAN Map page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-91

Task 12: LACP configuration

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 12: LACP configuration


Perform this task to configure a LACP aggregate link using two Gigabit Ethernet ports.

LACP configuration is only available on MMUs with the GigE Master I/O Module installed. The MMU supports IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) on the frontpanel GigE ports. Within the IEEE 802.3ad standard, LACP provides a method to control the bundling of several physical ports together to form a single logical channel. LACP allows a network device to negotiate an automatic bundling of links by sending LACP packets to the peer (directly connected device that also implements LACP).

Configuring LACP
To configure LACP, select menu option Administration, LACP Configuration. The LACP Configuration page is displayed (Figure 136). Update the attributes as required (Table 249) and select Update. To delete an aggregator, set the LACP Mode to Disabled on all ports belonging to that aggregator. Figure 136 LACP Configuration page

6-92

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 12: LACP configuration

Table 249 LACP Configuration attributes Attribute System Priority LACP System Timeout Meaning The global LACP priority value. The range is 1-65535. The administrative LACP timeout. Short means a short timeout value. Long means a long timeout value. LACP Mode The administrative LACP control method. Passive means that the port prefers not to transmit LACPDUs unless its partner's control value is Active LACP. Active means that the port prefers to participate in the protocol regardless of the partner's control value. Disabled means that that LACP is disabled at this port. Port Priority Port Admin Key The LACP priority value for the port. The range is 1-65535. The operational Key value assigned to the port. The range is 1-65535. Ports with the same admin key will join one aggregator.

Viewing LACP status


To view the current LACP port status, select LACP Status. The LACP Status page is displayed (Figure 137). This shows the current LACP port status based on the MMU LACP parameter settings in the LACP Configuration page, and the partner device configuration. Figure 137 LACP Status page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-93

Task 13: Connecting link to the network

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 13: Connecting link to the network


Perform this task to connect to the network and set the system clock.

Ensure that the network security requirements are configured before connecting the PTP 810 to the network. Otherwise, security may be compromised. To configure user account or HTTP (SSL), refer to Managing user accounts and security on page 7-27. This task consists of the following procedures: Connecting to the network on page 6-94 Setting the real-time clock on page 6-95

Connecting to the network


To complete and test the network connections, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 Disconnect the local PC from the MMU management port at each MMU. Connect the MMUs to the network equipment using the cables that were prepared in Preparing network connections (1+0 and 2+0 links) on page 5-77. Check that each of the MMUs is reachable from the network management system by opening the web interface to the management agents, or by requesting ICMP echo response packets using the Ping application. The network management system will normally be geographically remote from the site, so it may be necessary to request that this action is completed by coworkers at the management centre. Alternatively, it may be possible to use remote login to the management system. Check that the data network operates correctly across the wireless link. This may be by requesting ICMP echo response packets between hosts in the connected network segments, or by some more structured use of network testing tools. For a 1+1 Hot Standby link: Initiate a protection switch at one end of the link (as described in Forcing protection switches on page 7-23) and check that the data network operates correctly across the wireless link (as described in the previous step). Initiate a switch back to the primary ODU. Repeat for the other end of the link.

6-94

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 13: Connecting link to the network

Check that the wireless interface is enabled at both ends, as described in Enabling the ODU on page 7-22. For a 1+1 Hot Standby link, check that both units are enabled at each end.

Select menu option Analysis, Alarms and check that there are no active alarms on any unit. For more information, see Managing alarms on page 7-15.

Setting the real-time clock


The clock supplies accurate date and time information to the MMU. It can be set to run with or without a connection to a network time server (SNTP): In the absence of an SNTP server connection, set the clock to run manually. The clock is battery backed and will continue to operate for several days after the MMU is switched off. The battery is installed on the Control Module. If an SNTP server connection is available, set the clock to synchronize with the server time at regular intervals.

Setting the real-time clock manually


To set the MMU clock to keep time without connecting to a networked time server, select menu option Administration, Device Information, Set Date & Time. The Set Date & Time page is displayed. Set the SNTP Server Enable attribute to Disabled (Figure 138). Review and update the date and time parameters (Table 250), then select Update.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-95

Task 13: Connecting link to the network

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 138 Set Data & Time page (SNTP disabled)

Table 250 Manual clock attributes Attribute SNTP Server Enable SNTP Server Address Time Zone Date Format Date Time Meaning SNTP Server Client (Enabled / Disabled). Client Server Address. Time difference from GMT. Date format (US, European, Generic). Current terminal date. Current terminal time.

6-96

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 13: Connecting link to the network

Setting the real-time clock to synchronize using SNTP


To set the clock to synchronize with a networked time server, select menu option Administration, Device Information, Set Date & Time. The Set Date & Time page is displayed. Set the SNTP Server Enable attribute to Enabled (Figure 139). Review and update the SNTP Server Address, Timezone and Date Format attributes (Table 251), then select Update. Figure 139 Set Data & Time page (SNTP enabled)

Table 251 SNTP clock attributes Attribute SNTP Server Enable SNTP Server Address Time Zone Date Format Date Time Meaning SNTP Server Client (Enabled / Disabled). Client Server Address. Time difference from GMT. Date format (US, European, Generic). Current terminal date. Current terminal time.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-97

Task 14: Aligning antennas

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 14: Aligning antennas

Do not start antenna alignment until it is safe for the antennas to radiate RF, that is, until the antennas and ODUs have been installed on the masts or poles and no personnel are in front of the antennas.

Before starting alignment, ensure that the installation report contains the required settings, and disable APC. For background on the alignment process, refer to Introduction to antenna alignment on page 6-98. Check that the requirements in Prerequisites for alignment on page 6-99 have been met. For a 1+1 Hot Standby link with two antennas at each end of the link, perform Aligning protected antennas on page 6-99. For an unprotected link, or for a 1+1 Hot Standby link that uses ODU couplers, perform Aligning a pair of antennas on page 6-100.

Introduction to antenna alignment


Licensed microwave links use parabolic dish antennas which have narrow beam widths ranging from 4.7 down to 0.5. Beam width depends on antenna gain, larger gain antennas having narrower beam widths. It is most important that all PTP 810 antennas are precisely aligned at the centre of the main beam. If antennas are not aligned at the centre of the main beam, performance will be dramatically reduced. The alignment process requires the elevation angle (vertical plane) and azimuth angle (horizontal plane) to be adjusted. Antenna assemblies provide a mechanism for independently adjusting in both planes whilst the antenna mounting bracket is securely mounted to the mast. Please refer to the instructions provided with the antenna. Alignment is achieved by monitoring the receive signal strength indicator (RSSI). This is provided at the ODU BNC socket in the form of a dc voltage (RSSI Voltage). The BNC refresh rate is set to 1 second.

6-98

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 14: Aligning antennas

Prerequisites for alignment


Before starting alignment, confirm the following: The antennas, cables and MMUs have been installed at both ends of the link. A link planning report is available (for example, from LINKPlanner). It should include predicted RSSI voltage ranges (or received signal levels) and bearings for both ends of the link. If the report specifies predicted receive signal levels (dBm) but not voltages, then convert dBm to volts using the formula or graph in RSSI output on page 4-6. Two voltmeters with BNC connectors are available. No personnel are in front of the antennas.

Aligning protected antennas


For a 1+1 Hot Standby link with two antennas at each end of the link, align each of the following three pairs by following Aligning a pair of antennas on page 6-100: 1 2 3 Align the Tx Hi primary antenna to the Tx Lo primary antenna. Do not make any further adjustments to the two primary antennas. Align the Tx Hi secondary antenna to the (now fixed) Tx Lo primary antenna. Align the Tx Lo secondary antenna to the (now fixed) Tx Hi primary antenna.

Step 3 can be performed before step 2, if preferred.

Aligning dual-polar antennas


Perform alignment with either the Horizontal units muted or the Vertical units muted. Take RSSI readings on the unmated units. After alignment, check that the difference in receive power is within tolerance specified in the link planning report. For more information, refer to the antenna manufacturers instructions.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-99

Task 14: Aligning antennas

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Aligning a pair of antennas


Connect the MMUs to a management PC and open the web interfaces at both ends of the link. For more information, see Connecting to the PC and powering up on page 6-7 and Logging into the web interface on page 6-7. Antennas are aligned by monitoring ODU output voltage and receive power. Align each pair of antennas by using Step 5, Step 6 and Step 7 of the Installation Wizard, as described in the following procedures: Starting antenna alignment on page 6-100 Aligning antennas on page 6-100 Completing alignment on page 6-103

Starting antenna alignment


The MMU does not provide a separate mode of operation for antenna alignment. Perform antenna alignment while the MMU is in an operational mode. At both ends of the link, check that the correct IDU Operational Mode and ODU Operational Mode have been configured. If necessary, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration and click through the steps of the Link Configuration Wizard.

Aligning antennas
During the alignment process, ensure that antenna waveguide and coaxial components are not strained beyond their minimum bend radii.

Preparing for alignment


To prepare the antennas for alignment, proceed as follows at both link ends: 1 2 Using the instructions provided with the antenna, set the elevation and azimuth adjustment mechanisms to the centre of the range. Using the instructions provided with the antenna, adjust the position of the antenna mounting bracket such that the antenna is pointing at the other end of the link. Use a compass and the bearing provided by the planning report. Once the antenna is in position, resecure the mounting bracket.

6-100

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 14: Aligning antennas

Connect a suitable voltmeter to the RSSI connector. Figure 15 shows the location of this connector for the ODU. Connect the center of the RSSI connector to the positive terminal of the voltmeter. Use the voltmeter to monitor the RSSI voltage during alignment.

Aligning one end


Align the antenna at one end of the link while keeping the antenna at the other end of the link stationary. To find the correct elevation and azimuth angles at one end, proceed as follows: 1 Perform a complete sweep of the elevation range of the antenna by adjusting the elevation angle incrementally. The extent of the sweep depends upon antenna gain. Measure RSSI voltage at each point in the sweep. The resulting plot of voltage against elevation should be symmetrical. Record the elevation angle that appears to be at the axis of symmetry, as this is likely to be the correct angle for aligning with the other antenna (Figure 140).

Figure 140 shows the axis of symmetry occurring at a voltage peak. However, it is possible for the axis of symmetry (and therefore the correct elevation angle) to occur at a voltage trough (Figure 141). 3 4 5 Set the elevation angle to the axis of symmetry, as identified in the plot. Perform a complete sweep of the azimuth range of the antenna and record the resulting plot of voltage against azimuth. Set azimuth angle to the centre of the range over which the maximum RSSI voltage is recorded.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-101

Task 14: Aligning antennas

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Figure 140 Symmetrical relationship between voltage and alignment

Figure 141 Typical RSSI voltage peaks and troughs

6-102

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 14: Aligning antennas

Aligning the other end


Repeat the above procedure at the other end of the link. Record the RSSI voltage at both ends of the link. If the voltage at either end of the link is not in the range predicted by the planning report, repeat alignment until this is the case.

Post-alignment actions
In a 1+1 Hot Standby link, the tolerances in the ODUs may result in the Receive Power delta between the primary and secondary ODUs at same end of the link being different from the delta predicted by the network designer. Configurations using a single antenna may have up to 5 dB additional delta when compared with the design value. Where separate antennas are used, the tolerances may increase if either path incurs any Excess Path Loss. When alignment is complete at both ends, proceed as follows: 1 At each end of the link in turn, lock off and tighten all the adjustment bolts as per the instructions provided with the antenna and check that the RSSI voltage does not change. If it does change, repeat alignment for the affected end. Check that the following requirements are met: a. RSSI voltage at both ends is within the range predicted by the planning report. b. East /West Modem status in the Status Panel is Locked. c. RSL at both ends of the link is within the range predicted by the planning report. 3 If any of the above requirements are not met, antenna alignment is not complete; refer to troubleshooting section Trouble establishing a wireless link on page 8-8.

Completing alignment
The installation process has been completed. The transmitter is now enabled. To review the current link status, look at the Status Panel displayed on the right side of the GUI.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-103

Task 15: Reviewing configuration and performance

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

Task 15: Reviewing configuration and performance


Perform this task after antenna alignment is complete. This task consists of the following procedures: Reviewing system configuration attributes on page 6-104 Monitoring link performance on page 6-105

Reviewing system configuration attributes


To review and update the system configuration of a PTP 810 link, select menu option Link Configuration, Configuration Summary. The Summary of Configurations page is displayed (Figure 142). Review the configuration parameters. Update any incorrect configuration parameters by following the procedures in this chapter. Save a backup copy of the link configuration. Figure 142 Summary of Configuration page

6-104

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Task 15: Reviewing configuration and performance

Monitoring link performance


For at least one hour of operation after alignment is complete, the link should be monitored to check that it is achieving predicted levels of performance. To check performance, view the Status Panel displayed on the right side of the GUI. Monitor the following parameters: Tx Power Far End Tx Power RSL Far End RSL Signal/Noise Alarm Status Modem Status

Use the System Status panel (Figure 146 and Figure 147) to verify that the Modem(s) are Locked and that the RSL, Far End RSL and Signal/Noise parameters display a green bar indicating acceptable link margin. PTP LINKPlanner provides a prediction of the RSL in the form of an installation report.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

6-105

Task 15: Reviewing configuration and performance

Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment

6-106

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Chapter 7: Operation
This chapter describes how to operate a PTP 810 link. The following topics are described in this chapter: Web-based management on page 7-2 describes the layout and the main menu options of the PTP 810 web-based management interface. Managing alarms and events on page 7-15 describes how to manage PTP 810 system alarms and events. Disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU on page 7-21 describes how to disable, enable, mute and unmute an ODU. Managing 1+1 Hot Standby links on page 7-23 describes how to manage 1+1 links, and how to force protection switches and inhibit protection switching. Managing 2+0 Co-Polar, Cross-Polar & XPIC links on page 7-25 describes how to manage 2+0 Cross-Polar, 2+0 Co-Polar and 2+0 XPIC aggregation links. Managing user accounts and security on page 7-27 describes how to manage user accounts, and how to configure the unit to operate in HTTPS (SSL) secure mode. Managing performance on page 7-31 describes how to view and manage PTP 810 system statistics and diagnostics. Saving, restoring and rebooting on page 7-51 describe how to save and restore the system configuration, and how to reboot the unit. Restoring system defaults on page 7-54 describes how to restore the MMU system default parameters. Viewing device information on page 7-57 describes how to view MMU general device and serial number information, and how to modify MMU device name related information. Upgrading the system on page 7-60 describes how to enter an authorization key to increase data capacity or implement XPIC, and how to install a new software version. Removing and installing modules on page 7-67 describes how to remove and install the individual MMU modules.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-1

Web-based management

Chapter 7: Operation

Web-based management
This section describes the layout and the main menu options of the PTP 810 web-based management interface.

Accessing the web interface


The web interface is best viewed using a screen resolution of at least 1024 x 768 pixels. The web pages have been tested with Internet Explorer 7, Internet Explorer 8, Firefox 3 and Firefox 3.5. Other browsers have not been tested. The web interface also requires the use of Sun Java Runtime Environment 5.0 or above. To access the web interface, type the IP address of the unit into the browser address bar and press ENTER. A popup window (Figure 143) will prompt for a user name and password. Enter a user name and password then select OK. The web interface initial is displayed in its initial state (Figure 144). Select View Status Panel. Figure 143 System Administration Login page

7-2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Web-based management

Figure 144 Web interface without status panel

Layout of the web interface


The web interface consists of three panels (Figure 145). The navigation tree menu is displayed in the left panel of the page. The specific page selected by using the menu is displayed in the center panel of the page. The status panel is displayed in the right panel of the page. The menu selections used for configuration, along with their corresponding center panel pages, are described in the tasks that follow in this chapter.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-3

Web-based management

Chapter 7: Operation

Figure 145 Web interface with status panel

Viewing the system status


To view the system status, select menu option Home. In addition, be sure that the Status Panel is visible by clicking on the View Status Panel text box displayed in the right panel of the web interface. The Home page displays the IP address and name of the MMU along with the system uptime (Figure 145). The Status Panel gives the user a view of the operation of the PTP 810 from the wireless link perspective (Figure 146). The content of the Status Panel will display either one or two modem links depending upon the configuration of the PTP 810. Figure 146 and Figure 147 contain examples of various configurations. The status panel page provides the modem and alarm status of the MMU (Table 252).

7-4

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Web-based management

Figure 146 Status panel examples (Standard and 2+0 XPIC) Standard 2+0 XPIC

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-5

Web-based management

Chapter 7: Operation

Figure 147 Status panel examples (Protected Non-diversity, East/East and East/West) Protected Non-diversity East/East East/West

7-6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Web-based management

Table 252 Status panel modem and alarm status indicators Indicator Alarm Meaning Alarm Status: Red indicates that one or more alarms are outstanding. Green indicates that no alarms are outstanding. Click on the colored disk to view the Active Alarms Page. MODEM, EAST MODEM, WEST MODEM MMU modem configuration: MODEM is displayed when the standard ODU operational mode is configured. EAST MODEM and WEST MODEM are displayed when ODU operational modes using two modems are configured. Locked, Unlocked, NA Status of the modem(s): Locked means that the link is established (up). Unlocked means that the link is not established (down). NA means that the modem is inactive. Transmitter ACTIVE, STANDBY, OFF, ON Current status of the ODU: ACTIVE means that the ODU transmitter and receiver are both on. STANDBY means that the ODU Transmitter is off but the receiver is on. OFF means that the ODU is off. ON means that the ODU is on but not configured. TX Power Far End TX Power RSL Far End RSL Signal/Noise Tx Freq and Rx Freq Transmitting power of the local ODU in dBm. Transmitting power of the remote ODU in dBm. Received signal level of the local ODU in dBm. Received signal level of the remote ODU in dBm. Signal noise value in dB. If the modem is unlocked, this is displayed as N/A. The upper limit of 25.5 dB is a good level. Transmit frequency and receive frequency in GHz. When East and West modems are configured, Tx Freq and Rx Freq are displayed for both modems. Modulation mode of the link from a single modem (Modem) or from two modems (East mode and West mode).
7-7

Mode, East mode, West mode


phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Web-based management

Chapter 7: Operation

Indicator Local IP Local Host Remote IP Remote Host

Meaning IP address of the local MMU. Product name of the local MMU (PTP810). IP address of the remote MMU. Product name of the remote MMU (PTP810).

7-8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Web-based management

Using the menu options


All web pages contain the menu navigation bar on the left hand side (Figure 148). The menu is used to navigate to other web pages. Figure 148 Menu bar

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-9

Web-based management

Chapter 7: Operation

Table 253 lists the procedures that may be performed from each menu option. Many of these procedures are part of the initial configuration and alignment process described in Chapter 6: Configuration and alignment. Some of the menu options are hardware module or system configuration dependent and wont be visible in the menu of a MMU that does not have a specific hardware module installed or system configuration deployed.

Table 253 Procedures performed from each menu option Menu Option Description View Starting Information and Status Panel Task or procedure Accessing the web interface on page 7-2 Viewing the system status on page 7-4

Home

Administration NetworkConfiguration General SNMP SyslogServer Email

Configure general network related parameters Configure SNMP related parameters Configure Syslog IP Address and Syslog Facility Configure E-mail related parameters Configure Ethernet NMS related parameters Configure Ethernet Payload related parameters Configure general VLAN related parameters Configure Static VLAN Table Configure Port Based Forwarding groups Configure multiple spanning trees

Configuring the IP interface on page 6-14 Configuring SNMP agent on page 6-54 Configuring system logging (syslog) on page 6-62 Configuring generation of diagnostics alarms on page 657 Configuring Ethernet network management on page 6-21 Configuring Ethernet payload on page 6-16 Configuring global VLAN options on page 6-73 Configuring static VLANs on page 6-75 Configuring port based VLANs on page 6-77 Configuring MSTPs on page 688

EthernetNMS EthernetPayload VLANConfiguration GlobalVLANConfiguration StaticVLANConfiguration PortBasedForwardingMode MSTPConfiguration

7-10

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Web-based management

Menu Option

Description Configure multiple spanning tree VLAN mapping Configure LACP related parameters Configure general QoS related parameters Configure frame priority map Configure 802.1Q tag priority map Configure DiffServ DSCP priority map Configure QoS Switch Priority to Tx Priority Queue map Configure data baud rate for RS-232 serial port Configure HTTP Access and CLI Access security protection (SSL/SSH) Display model number and active application version Modify terminal device information Set date, date format, time, time zone Display all module names, part numbers, serial numbers Used to reprogram the software images. Add users to the MMU with associated password

Task or procedure Mapping VLANs to MSTP instances on page 6-91 Configuring LACP on page 6-92

MSTPInstanceVLANMap LACPConfiguration QoSConfiguration GlobalSettings PortPriority VLANpbitTagPriority DiffServPriority SwitchPriority

Setting QoS priority method on page 6-63 Setting QoS port priorities on page 6-66 Setting QoS VLAN p-bit tag priorities on page 6-68 Setting QoS DiffServ DSCP priorities on page 6-69 Setting QoS switch priorities on page 6-71 Configuring Serial Port on page 6-15 Configuring HTTP (SSL) on page 7-30

SerialConfiguration SecurityConfiguration

DeviceInformation General DeviceNames SetDateandTime SerialNumbers

General device information on page 7-57 Device name and owner information on page 7-58 Setting the real-time clock on page 6-95 Serial number information on page 7-58

Maintenance Reprogramming AddUser

Installing new software versions on page 7-63 Creating user accounts on page 7-27

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-11

Web-based management

Chapter 7: Operation

Menu Option

Description Delete users from the MMU or change password of users View event log of the MMU and clear it when required Reboot the MMU or selected modules Restore a saved configuration or store existing configuration

Task or procedure Deleting user accounts on page 7-28 Viewing event log of MMU access on page 7-29 Rebooting on page 7-53 Saving the system configuration on page 7-51 Restoring the system configuration on page 7-52 Restoring system defaults on page 7-54 Entering an authorization key on page 7-60 Viewing the configuration summary on page 6-24 Configuring APC and coupler loss compensation on page 6-34 Configuring the ODU on page 6-33 Viewing the configuration summary on page 6-24 Configuring the ODU on page 6-33 Disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU on page 721

DeleteUser ViewEventLog Reboot RestoreConfiguration

RestoreDefaults LinkConfiguration Authorization ConfigurationSummary RadioLink APCConfiguration ODUTxMuteConfig

Restore system defaults on MMU Enter an Authorization Key View system configuration summary Configure APC parameters Configure ODU Transmit Mute parameter on unprotected links Configure link operating mode and modulation mode Configure enable/disable and mute/unmute of ODUs

LinkConfiguration ODUConfiguration

ProtectionConfiguration

Configure protection parameters

Configuring protection on page 6-50 Managing 1+1 Hot Standby links on page 7-23

DataLink E1/T1ChannelMap

Modify E1/T1 channel map settings

Configuring channel mapping on page 6-38


phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-12

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Web-based management

Menu Option

Description Configure settings of physical E1/T1 channels Configure protection switching priority of E1/T1 channels Configure DOW operating mode

Task or procedure Configuring E1/T1 ports on page 6-42 Configuring E1/T1 protection switching on page 6-45 Configuring orderwire on page 6-48

E1/T1Ports E1/T1ProtectionSwitching

Orderwire Analysis Alarms Active AlarmConfiguration

Displays active alarms information Configure alarm attributes

Managing alarms on page 7-15 Configuring generation of diagnostics alarms on page 657 Managing alarms on page 7-15 Configuring alarm thresholds on page 6-59

History Threshold

Displays alarm history information Configure alarm thresholds related to temperature, SNR, Min. RSL Graph East/West RSL Graph East/West SNR Graph East/West Tx Power Graph East/West RF error seconds Graph East/West tap indices Graph East/West modulation constellation Graph East/West ODU and MMU temperature Data switch statistics

Graphs RSL Signal/Noise TxPower RFLinkPerformance EqualizerTaps Constellation Temperature EthernetSwitch NMSStatistics

Viewing wireless link performance on page 7-31 Viewing wireless link performance on page 7-31 Viewing wireless link performance on page 7-31 Viewing wireless link performance on page 7-31 Viewing wireless link performance on page 7-31 Viewing wireless link performance on page 7-31 Viewing wireless link performance on page 7-31 Viewing Ethernet switch statistics on page 7-42
7-13

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Web-based management

Chapter 7: Operation

Menu Option

Description NMS switch statistics NMS spanning tree status Payload spanning tree status Enable BERT testing across a link Enable loopback testing across a link Logout of MMU GUI

Task or procedure Viewing Ethernet switch statistics on page 7-42 Viewing Ethernet switch statistics on page 7-42 Viewing Ethernet switch statistics on page 7-42 BERT mode on page 8-18 Performing a loopback test on page 8-15 Logging out on page 7-14

PayloadStatistics NMSSTPStatus PayloadSTPStatus BERTMode Loopback Logout

Logging out
To maintain security, always log out at the end of a session by selecting menu option Logout. In the case of Internet Explorer, the logout link will close the browser. For other browsers, the user may have to close the browser manually.

7-14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing alarms and events

Managing alarms and events


This section describes how to manage PTP 810 system alarms and events. This section contains the following procedures: Managing alarms on page 7-15. Managing SNMP traps on page 7-20. Managing event notification messages on page 7-20.

Managing alarms
Whenever system alarms are outstanding, the Alarm status LED at the top of the Status Panel turns red. The Status Panel and its Alarm status LED are visible from all web pages. Click on the Alarm status LED (or menu option Analysis, Alarms, Active) to view the active alarms. If the Alarm status LED turns green, it indicates that the outstanding alarms have been cleared. A change of state in most alarms generates an SNMP trap. The alarm configuration procedure is described in Task 8: Configuring alarms and messages on page 6-57. The example in Figure 149 shows the Alarm status LED in the Status Panel set to red and the Active Alarms displayed in the center panel. Figure 149 Active Alarms page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-15

Managing alarms and events

Chapter 7: Operation

The list of alarms and their descriptions are provided in Alarms on page V. This list of alarms is in the form of a table that includes five columns of status information associated with each alarm. This status information is as follows: Affected Component The name of the MMU module card affected by the alarm, for example Modem Upper (West Modem), Modem Lower (East Modem), Controller, Master IO, Expansion IO or Power Supply; or the system component affected by the alarm. for example IDU, ODU, or Link Partner IDU. Description The description of the event that triggered the alarm. LED to RED The name of the module (if any) whose front panel status LED will turn red when the alarm is activated. The Controller, Master I/O, Expansion I/O, Power Supply and Modem cards all have a front panel status LED. Alarm Code The number of the alarm code (if any) that will be flashed by the front panel status LED of the Controller card (see Controller card status LED on page 7-16). Severity The relative severity of the alarm code. The severity is categorized as either Info, Major or Critical.

Controller card status LED


The controller card status LED is the primary front panel indicator of alarms. An alarm is generated when a specific condition is identified and is cleared when the specific condition is no longer detected. The status alarm LED of the controller card can operate in two ways: Solid on Flashing to indicate an alarm code

Alarms on page V provides a complete list of alarms and indicates whether the alarm is solid or will flash a code. When an alarm with a code is posted, the following sequence of events occurs: 1. The controller status LED turns orange for 5 seconds. 2. The controller status LED turns off for 5 seconds. 3. The controller status LED flashes orange the number of times specified by the first digit of the alarm code. 4. The controller status LED turns off for 3 seconds. 5. The controller status LED flashes orange the number of times specified by the second digit of the alarm code. Steps 2-5 are repeated for each alarm posted. The entire process is repeated as long as the alarms are still posted.

7-16

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing alarms and events

Modem card status LED


The modem card status LED indicates the modem status as described in Table 254. Table 254 Modem card status LED LED Green solid Orange solid Green blink Orange blink Red blink Red solid Status Active Locked Link Standby Locked Link (1+1 Non-Diversity Only) Low SNR Unlocked ODU 48 V power is disabled ODU Power Fault. Occurs when the 48 V to the Modem Module is low or excessive current is being drawn from the 48 V. In either case, the 48 V will be disabled by the hardware. Modem Hardware Fault. Occurs when any of the power-on self tests failed or IF Power Fault or Digital Power Fault detected during normal operation.

Alarm History
The Alarm History page is shown in Figure 150. To view the alarm history, select menu option Analysis, Alarms, History. This page lists alarms that have occurred and their description, status and time. A maximum of 300 alarms can be displayed. If the alarm history exceeds 300 alarms, the oldest alarms will be overwritten. The MMU stores the latest 200 alarms in non-volatile memory. The following items are displayed on this page: Description Displays the description (name) of the alarm. Status Displays the status of the alarm (set/reset). Time Displays the time at which this particular alarm was set/reset.

To clear the alarm history records, select Clear History. To export the alarm history to a local Alarm History.csv file, select Export to CSV.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-17

Managing alarms and events

Chapter 7: Operation

Figure 150 Alarm History page

ODU alarms
In the case of an ODU Fault Lower, ODU Fault Upper, or a Protection Switch alarm resulting from an ODU failure condition, the Active Alarms and Alarm History messages will indicate the fault code from the ODU. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library will be added to the alarm text in the Active Alarms and Alarm History. Table 255 lists the ODU alarms that are reported by the MMU along with the associated fault code and description. These alarms and fault codes are common to both ODU-A and ODU-B. Table 255 ODU Alarms ODU Alarm Rx Synth Lock Tx Synth Lock IF Synth Lock Lockout Alarm Fault Code 00 01 03 05 Description This indicates a failure of the Rx RF synthesizer in the ODU. This indicates a failure of the Tx RF synthesizer in the ODU. This indicates a failure of the IF synthesizer in the ODU. The connected device is not a Cambium branded ODU.

7-18

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing alarms and events

There are additional ODU alarms used to report degraded ODU status that are not reported by the MMU. These alarms include: 1) the Cable Alarm used to indicate that the IF signal strength has fallen outside the target voltage range, 2) the Cable Attenuator Adjustment alarm which is active when the ODU is executing the cable compensation procedure (typically on power-up or hard reset), and 3) the Tx Power Degraded alarm which is triggered if the Tx Output power has fallen more than 3 dBm below the commanded power.

XPIC alarms
Table 256 describes the MMU alarms that are specific to XPIC. Table 256 XPIC Alarms Alarm Name Signal/XPI Threshold Low Lower Signal/XPI Threshold Low Upper Alarm Description The XPIC signal-to-cross polarization interference ratio is below the minimum operational level of the link as set during configuration (see Configuring alarm thresholds on page 6-59). Upper / Lower is an indication of the modem card location in the MMU chassis. Fault detection is done via modem status polling, comparing user configured threshold value with threshold value in configuration table. Polling interval 5 seconds. XPIC is not providing cancellation, that is, XPIC has lost phase lock with the XPI signal. If this alarm is triggered when the Signal/XPI ratio is greater than 25 dB, the cross-polar interfering signal is too low to need to be cancelled and will not affect the operation of the link. Under this condition the alarm should be treated as informational only. Cancelling of the XPI signal usually occurs when the Signal/XPI ratio is between 10 and 25 dB. However, if the signals are impaired, for example due to high phase noise, then the alarm could be triggered, indicating a problem on the link. Equally, when the Signal/XPI ratio is below 10 dB, there is unlikely to be sufficient discrimination for effective cancellation and the alarm indicates a problem on the link. The Signal/XPI ratio is included in the Signal/Noise graph (Figure 158). Upper / Lower is an indication of the modem card location in the MMU chassis. Fault detection is done via modem status polling. XPIC Cable Interface Error Lower XPIC Loss of Link status of the modem card has unlocked indicating that the intermodem hi-speed cable interface has

XPIC Unlock Lower and XPIC Unlock Upper

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-19

Managing alarms and events

Chapter 7: Operation

Alarm Name XPIC Cable Interface Error Upper West Modem XPIC FPGA Not Available East Modem XPIC FPGA Not Available

Alarm Description been disconnected. Upper / Lower is an indication of the modem card location in the MMU chassis. This alarm is raised when the ODU operational mode is 2+0 XPIC and the Active Image in the Modem West FPGA is not the XPIC FPGA. This alarm is raised when the ODU operational mode is 2+0 XPIC and the Active Image in the Modem East FPGA is not the XPIC FPGA.

Managing SNMP traps


The PTP 810 supports SNMP v2 and SNMP v1 remote management of traps. To configure SNMP traps, refer to Task 7: Setting up SNMP agent on page 6-54. View SNMP traps using the IP address of one of the configured trap managers.

Managing event notification messages


When system logging is enabled, log entries are transmitted to a syslog server. System logging (syslog) on page 1-54 describes the system logging feature. To configure system logging, refer to Task 9: Configuring syslog on page 6-62. To enable system logging, select menu option Administration, Network Configuration, Syslog Server. The Syslog Configuration page is displayed (Figure 120). The MMU will send syslog information to the syslog server where it can be accessed for viewing.

7-20

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU

Disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU


This section describes how to disable, enable, mute and unmute an ODU.

Disabling the ODU


Disabling an ODU means turning off power to the ODU. With no power, both the transmitter and the receiver of the ODU are disabled. Do this before starting maintenance work near the antenna. To disable an ODU, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, ODU Configuration. The ODU Configuration page is displayed (Figure 151). Select the ODU (East / West) to be disabled, then select Disable ODU. The power to the selected ODU is disabled and the Transmitter Status in the Status Panel displays OFF. Figure 151 ODU Configuration page

In a 1+1 Hot Standby link, disable protection switchover before disabling wireless transmission (see Enabling and disabling fault protection on page 7-24). Otherwise, a switchover to the inactive unit may occur when the wireless interface is muted. Re-enable protection switchover after wireless transmission is re-enabled.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-21

Disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU

Chapter 7: Operation

Enabling the ODU


Enabling an ODU means turning on power to a disabled ODU. To enable an ODU, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, ODU Configuration. The ODU Configuration page is displayed (Figure 151). Select the ODU (East / West) to be enabled, then select Enable ODU button. The power to the selected ODU is enabled and the Transmitter Status in the Status Panel no longer displays OFF.

Muting the ODU


Muting an ODU means that the ODU transmitter is disabled but the ODU receiver is still enabled. This is used in 1+1 HSB protection where one ODU is actively transmitting while the ODU used for protection has its transmitter muted, but still has its receiver active for configurations like spatial diversity. To mute an ODU (when MMU is in 1+1 HSB operation), select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, ODU Configuration. The ODU Configuration page is displayed (Figure 151). Select the ODU (East / West) to be muted, then select Mute ODU. The selected ODU is muted and the Transmitter Status in the Status Panel displays STANDBY.

Unmuting the ODU


Unmuting an ODU means enabling the transmitter at a muted ODU. To unmute an ODU, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, ODU Configuration. The ODU Configuration page is displayed (Figure 151). Select the ODU (East / West) to be unmuted, then select Unmute ODU. The selected ODU is unmuted and the Transmitter Status in the Status Panel no longer displays STANDBY.

7-22

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing 1+1 Hot Standby links

Managing 1+1 Hot Standby links


This section describes how to manage 1+1 Hot Standby links.

Forcing protection switches


Protection switches may be forced for a variety of reasons, for example: During maintenance operations. During software or hardware upgrades. To investigate error conditions that have not resulted in a protection switch. To confirm that the inactive unit remains fully functional.

To avoid loss of service, force protection switches only if link planning indicates that the unit(s) are capable of operating a satisfactory link. After a protection switch has been initiated, if work is to be carried out on the newly inactive unit, ensure that fault protection is temporarily disabled until the activity is completed. To force a protection switch, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Protection Configuration. Click on the Switch Transmitting ODU button on the Protection Configuration page (Figure 115). Monitor the Status Panel to verify that the ACTIVE ODU switches to STANDBY and the STANDBY ODU switches to ACTIVE.

Enabling revertive and non-revertive switching


For a 1+1 Hot Standby link, either revertive or non-revertive protection switching must be enabled. For non-revertive switching, the failed modem/ODU is marked as failed, powered down, and re-powered every three minutes to check for failure. If a failed alarm condition still exists, the modem/ODU is disabled again for three minutes. If it no longer fails, the modem/ODU is set for standby operation. For revertive switching, the failed modem/ODU pair is put directly into standby. Automatic reversion to the originally active modem is not supported. To enable non-revertive protection switching, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Protection Configuration. Select the Enabled radio button of the 'Power down ODU after switch' parameter. To enable revertive protection switching, select the Disabled radio button of the 'Power down ODU after switch' parameter.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-23

Managing 1+1 Hot Standby links

Chapter 7: Operation

Enabling and disabling fault protection


The Protection Configuration page (Figure 115) can be used to enable or disable fault protection switching during the operation of the link. When switching is disabled, a fault will not cause a protection switch, but the user may still manually switch. This feature is intended to be used during maintenance actions where the user does not wish faults to change which MMU/ODU is active.

This may be a required state with Spatial Diversity to prevent transmission through a non-compliant diverse antenna. To enable and disable fault protection, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Protection Configuration. To enable or disable fault protection switching at the local end of the link, select the Enabled or Disabled radio button of the APS Switch parameter. To enable or disable fault protection switching at the remote end of the link, select the Enabled or Disabled radio button of the Update Remote APS Switch parameter. To enable or disable protection switching triggered by remote end Lock Status information, select the Enabled or Disabled radio button of the Remote Transmitter Switching parameter.

Selecting preferred transmitting ODU


The Protection Configuration page (Figure 105) can be used to select the East or West ODU as the preferred transmitting ODU. This setting is used, for example, when an asymmetric coupler is being used in the antenna configuration. The ODU associated with the path in the coupler that has the lower loss is typically selected as the preferred ODU. To configure the preferred ODU, select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Protection Configuration. Select the East or West radio button of the Preferred ODU parameter. Press the Update button to reconfigure the preferred ODU.

7-24

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing 2+0 Co-Polar, Cross-Polar & XPIC links

Managing 2+0 Co-Polar, Cross-Polar & XPIC links


This section describes how to manage 2+0 Co-Polar, 2+0 Cross-Polar, and 2+0 XPIC links. In all three of these link configurations, two wireless links are used to transmit E1/T1 channels and Ethernet data between the MMUs located at the end points of the link. Channel mapping is used to divide the E1/T1 traffic between both wireless links. The operation of these links with Ethernet payload depends on the Master I/O card that is deployed.

GigE Master I/O operation


When a GigE Master I/O module is deployed, the MMU can be configured to support either Segregation or Link Aggregation of the Ethernet payload. Segregation is the default Ethernet payload configuration.

Segregation
In Segregation, the MMUs front panel GigE ports are grouped into two groups of two ports. There are two methods for segregation configuration. The first method is to use RSTP. Select menu option Administration, Network Configuration, Ethernet Payload. Using the Spanning Tree Mode pulldown menu, select IEEE 802.1w (RSTP) (see Configuring Ethernet payload on page 6-16). Traffic from group 1 (port 1 and port 2) is sent across the East radio link and traffic from group 2 (port 3 and port 4) is sent across the West radio link. The second method is to use port forwarding. Select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuration, Port Based Forwarding and select the appropriate checkboxes to perform port based VLAN configuration (see Configuring port based VLANs on page 6-77).

Link Aggregation
In Link Aggregation, the MMUs front panel GigE ports share the aggregate bandwidth. The MMUs internal Layer 2 Ethernet switch load balances packets between the two radio links. To enable Link Aggregation select menu option Administration, Network Configuration, Ethernet Payload. Using the Ethernet Trunk Mode pulldown menu, select 2+0 Trunk Port Aggregation (see Configuring Ethernet payload on page 6-16). When 2+0 Trunk Port Aggregation is enabled, the MMUs VLAN configuration features are disabled. However, the MMU does provide transparent forwarding of VLAN tagged and untagged traffic, including traffic forwarding between front panel ports.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-25

Managing 2+0 Co-Polar, Cross-Polar & XPIC links

Chapter 7: Operation

Standard Master I/O operation


The Standard Master I/O module does not support Link Aggregation as described above for the GigE Master I/O module. The Standard Master I/O module includes two front panel Fast Ethernet ports which can be configured to support Segregation using port based forwarding or MSTP/RSTP. The traffic from one port is sent over the East link and the traffic from the other port is sent over the West link. To perform port based forwarding select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuration, Port Based Forwarding and select the appropriate checkboxes (see Configuring port based VLANs on page 6-77). To perform MSTP select menu option Administration, VLAN Configuration, MSTP Configuration and input the required configuration parameters (see Configuring MSTPs on page 6-88).

Link outage considerations


In the event of a failure of a 2+0 Co-Polar or 2+0 Cross-Polar link, maximum throughput will be reduced by one-half. In the case of Link Aggregation, the Ethernet traffic on the failed link will be automatically re-routed to the remaining link. In the case of Segregation, the Ethernet traffic on the failed link will be dropped. The E1/T1 channels mapped across the East RF link will take priority during a link outage of either the East or West RF links. The E1/T1 channels mapped across the West RF link will be dropped during the link outage, and the Ethernet throughput will be reduced to what is available on the East RF link. QoS can be used to ensure high priority Ethernet traffic is transmitted on the remaining available Ethernet throughput.

To maximize protection of E1/T1 channels, map as many E1/T1 channels as possible to the East modem. The 2+0 XPIC operational mode requires both links to remain active for proper operation. If a transmitter on an ODU fails, the other link will continue to operate, but the overall throughput will be reduced by one-half. However, if a receiver on an ODU fails, the reference signal required to cancel XPI will not be available and the remaining link will unlock if the XPI is too high. There is no XPIC fallback protection, so the link will fail.

7-26

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing user accounts and security

Managing user accounts and security


This section describes how to manage user accounts in operational PTP 810 links. It also describes how to configure the unit to operate in HTTPS (SSL) secure mode.

Creating user accounts


The MMU supports one administrator account and up to six user accounts. Multiple users may access the MMU with three defined levels of access: Administrator (administrator), Operator (Level 2) and Monitor (Level 1). Creating or updating user accounts may only be performed by a user with access level of Administrator. To create a new user account, select menu option Administration, Maintenance, Add User. The Add User page is displayed (Figure 152). Enter the users attributes (Table 257) and select Add to create the new user account. Figure 152 Add User page

Table 257 Add User attributes Attribute User Name Meaning The users name (maximum 15 characters). User Name must start with an alphanumeric character and be followed by letters, numbers or other characters from the POSIX portable character class. Group The users access level (Level 1 or Level 2).

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-27

Managing user accounts and security

Chapter 7: Operation

Attribute Password

Meaning The users password (maximum 15 characters). Password must start with an alphanumeric character and be followed by letters, numbers or other characters from the POSIX portable character class.

Confirm Password

Repetition of the users password.

Deleting user accounts


To delete a user account, select menu option Administration, Maintenance, Delete User. The Delete User page is displayed (Figure 153). In the Delete User section of the page, choose User Name from the drop-down list and select Delete. Figure 153 Delete User page

7-28

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing user accounts and security

Changing a password
To change a users password, select menu option Administration, Maintenance, Delete User. The Delete User page is displayed (Figure 153). In the Change Password section of the page, choose User Name from the drop-down list, enter New Password and Confirm Password (Table 257), and select Change.

A user may change the password of any user whose access level is less than or equal to his own.

Viewing event log of MMU access


The event log shows the history of terminal access to the MMU in the form of a table listing users and their time of login. This log is non-volatile and available across MMU reboots. To view the event log and clear it when required, select menu option Administration, Maintenance, View Event Log. The Event Log page is displayed (Figure 154). To clear the log, select Clear. Figure 154 Event Log page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-29

Managing user accounts and security

Chapter 7: Operation

Configuring HTTP (SSL)


Perform this procedure if the unit is required to operate in HTTP(SSL) mode. To configure HTTPS (SSL), select menu option Administration, Security Configuration. The Security Configuration page is displayed (Figure 155). Update the attributes (Table 258) and select Update. To revert to previous values, select Reset. Figure 155 Security Configuration page

Table 258 Security Configuration attributes Attribute HTTP Access Meaning The type of HTTP Access (HTTP / HTTP(SSL) / Disabled). HTTP(SSL) refers to the S-HTTP protocol, which uses SSL. There is a default certificate within the MMU for data encryption purposes. Command Line Interface The type of CLI Access (CLI over Telnet / CLI over SSH / Disabled).

7-30

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

Managing performance
This section describes how to view and manage PTP 810 system statistics and diagnostics. To assist in managing PTP 810 performance, the GUI provides a number of graphs of the wireless link performance and tables of the Ethernet switch statistics.

Viewing wireless link performance


To review the graphs of the wireless link performance of a PTP 810 link, select menu option Analysis, Graphs. Based on the ODU Operational Mode configuration, the number of graphs displayed will differ. Select any one link (that is, East or West) to view the graph of that parameter. The X-axis time range can be selected to be either 1, 2, 4, 12 or 24 hours. If 1 hour is selected, it will plot the graph using the last hour of data. The resolution of the data plotted is one value per 90 seconds. When the mouse is moved over the graph area, the corresponding value at the mouse point will be displayed under the graph area. This enables the user to easily read X and Y values.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-31

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

RSL Graph
This screen graphs the East modem RSL, West modem RSL, or both for the time period selected (Figure 156). Figure 156 RSL Graph

7-32

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

Signal/Noise Ratio Graph


This screen graphs the East modem SNR, West modem SNR, or both for the time period selected (Figure 157). The SNR measurement is capped at a maximum of 25.5 dB.

When XPIC is enabled, the SNR is the resultant SNR after cross polar interference cancellation. Figure 157 Signal Noise Ratio Graph

When XPIC is enabled, the SNR graph includes a plot of Signal/XPI (Figure 158). Signal/XPI measures the ratio of the wanted receive signal level to the cross polar interfering signal level in dB. This is prior to the effect of cross polar interference cancellation. Like SNR, the value is capped at 25.5 dB.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-33

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

Figure 158 XPIC SNR Graph

7-34

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

Tx Power Graph
This screen graphs the East modem Tx Power, West modem Tx Power, or both for the time period selected (Figure 159). Figure 159 Tx Power Graph

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-35

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

RF Link Performance Graph


This screen graphs the East modem RF Link Performance or the West modem RF Link Performance for the time period selected. A variety of error second statistics are displayed (Figure 160). Figure 160 RF Link Performance Graph

The statistics displayed are as follows: ES (Errored Seconds): A second in which at least one errored block is measured. SES (Severely Errored Seconds): A second in which more than 30% of Errored Blocks are measured. BBE (Background Block Errors): The number of Errored Blocks measured during a time period without SES. UAS (Unavailable Seconds): The period during which the link is out of service. It is detected counting the number of consecutive SES. The Unavailability is declared when 10 consecutive SES are detected on the radio link and removed when 10 consecutive non-SES are detected.
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-36

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

ESR (Errored Seconds Ratio): The ratio of Errored Seconds to available seconds. SESR (Severely Errored Seconds Ratio): The ratio of Severely Errored Seconds to available seconds. BBER (Background Block Errors Ratio): The ratio of Background Block Errors to blocks in available seconds. SUSPECT (Suspect Interval): A 15 minute interval in which the data is suspect due to one of the following user actions: o o o o o o Date and Time change SNTP parameter change System power up Link Reconfiguration Modem module extraction, insertion or not present Master IO module insertion

TIME_ELAPSED (Elapsed Time): The amount of time that has elapsed in the current 15 minute interval. This value is more relevant to SNMP retrieval of current interval data than the value displayed in the graph.

Equalizer Taps Graph


This screen graphs the East modem Equalizer Taps or West modem Equalizer Taps (Figure 161). When XPIC mode is enabled, the Equalizer Taps graph includes XPIC plot data in the graph (Figure 162). Figure 161 Equalizer Taps Graph

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-37

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

Figure 162 XPIC Equalizer Taps Graph

7-38

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

Constellation Graph
This screen graphs the East modem Constellation or West modem Constellation (Figure 163). When XPIC mode is enabled, the East or West Constellation graph includes Pre-XPIC constellation plot data in the provided graph (Figure 164). Figure 163 Constellation Graph (256 QAM)

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-39

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

Figure 164 XPIC Constellation Graph (256 QAM)

7-40

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

Temperature Graph
This screen graphs the temperature of the MMU (shown as SDIDU), East ODU and West ODU over the time period selected. It also displays the current temperature of the MMU, East ODU and West ODU (Figure 165). Figure 165 Temperature Graph

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-41

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

Viewing Ethernet switch statistics


The MMU provides Ethernet switch statistics and STP status information for both NMS and payload. These statistics and status information are displayed in tables described in more detail below.

NMS switch statistics


To review the NMS switch statistics, select menu option Analysis, Statistics, NMS Switch. The NMS Switch Statistics screen is displayed (Figure 166). Press the Clear button to clear the data and start accumulating again. Figure 166 NMS Switch Statistics page

7-42

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

The MMU provides the following Ethernet statistics for the Front-Panel NMS Ports as well as the radio link. The NMS Switch Statistics page (Figure 166) provides statistics and Tx/Rx Frames and Bytes per port in the switch. Each Port column lists the statistics related to the specified Front-Panel Port of the Master IO. The CPU column displays the statistics for the CPU port. This port will send and receive "management" packets for the Spanning-Tree Protocol. All packets transmitted and received on the CPU port will be reported, including HTTP, SNMP, and Telnet traffic. The Radio Link(s) column (East, West, or East & West) displays the statistics for the Radio Link port(s). The radio link refers to the RF link connected to the switch port. All packets sent and received over the radio link will be displayed in this column.

This page provides the attributes described in Table 259. Table 259 NMS Switch Statistics attributes Attribute Spanning Tree Status Meaning Current Spanning Tree Port state: Offline - Ethernet cable is disconnected. Blocking - Port does not forward frames. Port will forward BPDU. Learning - Port does not forward frames. Port will learn source address from frames received. Forwarding - Port will forward frames. Rx Bytes Rx Bytes/sec TX Bytes TX Bytes/sec Rx Frames Rx Frames/sec TX Frames TX Frames/sec Errors Errors/sec Cumulative bytes received into the MMU from the front panel or the radio link. Bytes per second received into the MMU. Cumulative bytes transmitted by the MMU out the front panel or the radio link. Bytes per second transmitted by the MMU. Cumulative frames received into the MMU. Frames received per second into the MMU. Cumulative frames transmitted by the MMU. Frames transmitted per second by the MMU. Cumulative number of packets received in error by the MMU. These packets are discarded. Number of packets received in error per second.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-43

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

Attribute Collisions

Meaning Cumulative number of collisions on the Ethernet interface. Only valid when at least one interface is configured for halfduplex. Number of collisions per second on the Ethernet interface. Only valid when at least one interface is configured for halfduplex.

Collisions/sec

Payload switch statistics


To review the Payload switch statistics, select menu option Analysis, Statistics, Data Switch. The Data Switch Statistics page is displayed (Figure 167). Press the Clear button to clear the data and start accumulating again. Figure 167 Data Switch (payload port) Statistics page

7-44

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

The MMU provides the following Ethernet statistics for the Front-Panel Payload Ports as well as the radio link. The data switch statistics screen provides statistics and Tx/Rx Frames and Bytes per port in the switch. Each Port column lists the statistics related to the specified Front-Panel Port of the Master IO. The CPU column displays the statistics for the CPU port. This port will send and receive "management" packets for the Spanning-Tree Protocol. The Radio Link(s) column (East, West, or East & West) displays the statistics for the Radio Link port(s). The radio link refers to the RF link connected to the switch port. All packets sent and received over the radio link will be displayed in this column.

This page provides the attributes described in Table 260. Table 260 Data Switch (payload port) attributes Attribute STP Status Rx Bytes Rx Bytes/sec TX Bytes TX Bytes/sec Rx Frames Rx Frames/sec TX Frames TX Frames/sec Errors Errors/sec Collisions Meaning Displays the Spanning-Tree Protocol status. Cumulative bytes received into the MMU from the front panel or the radio link. Bytes per second received into the MMU. Cumulative bytes transmitted by the MMU out the front panel or the radio link. Bytes per second transmitted by the MMU. Cumulative frames received into the MMU. Frames received per second into the MMU. Cumulative frames transmitted by the MMU. Frames transmitted per second by the MMU. Cumulative number of packets received in error by the MMU. These packets are discarded. Number of packets received in error per second. Cumulative number of collisions on the Ethernet interface. Only valid when at least one interface is configured for halfduplex. Number of collisions per second on the Ethernet interface. Only valid when at least one interface is configured for halfduplex.

Collisions/sec

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-45

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

Ethernet NMS STP status


To review the system NMS STP status information, select menu option Analysis, Ethernet Switch, NMS STP Status. The Ethernet NMS status screen is displayed (Figure 168). Figure 168 Ethernet NMS IEEE 802.1w RSTP Status page

The Ethernet NMS Configuration allows for Spanning Tree Mode to be set as IEEE 802.1w (RSTP). When the Spanning Tree Mode selected is IEEE 802.1w RSTP, the NMS STP Status screen is active and provides system NMS status information for the IEEE 802.1w RSTP standard. The MMU provides the following Ethernet status for IEEE 802.1w RSTP and Front-Panel NMS Ports as well as the radio link. Table 261 Ethernet NMS IEEE 802.1w RSTP Status attributes Attribute Bridge Identifier Root Bridge Identifier Designated Bridge Identifier Root Path Cost Meaning Unique bridge identifier (ID) containing a configurable priority number and MAC address. The bridge identifier with the smallest (lowest) bridge ID. The bridge identifier for the Tx bridge. Path cost from the Tx bridge to the root bridge for the spanning tree instance.

7-46

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

Attribute Root Port

Meaning Root port for the spanning tree instance. Each Port column list the status and role related to the specified Front-Panel NMS Port of the Master IO. The Radio Link(s) column (east, west, or East & West) displays the status and role for the Radio Link port(s). The radio link refers to the RF link connected to the switch port.

Ethernet Payload xSTP status


The MMU Ethernet Payload Configuration allows for Spanning Tree Mode to be set as IEE 802.1w (RSTP) or IEEE 802.1s (MSTP). When either Spanning Tree Mode is selected the Payload xSTP Status screen is active and provides system payload status information for the selected IEEE 802.1 standard. To review the system Payload xSTP status information, select menu option Analysis, Ethernet Switch, Payload STP Status. The Ethernet Payload page is displayed, either for RSTP (Figure 169) or for MSTP (Figure 170). Figure 169 Ethernet Payload IEEE 802.1w RSTP page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-47

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

Figure 170 Ethernet Payload IEEE 802.1s MSTP page

The MMU provides the Ethernet status attributes described in Table 262 for MSTP/RSTP and Front-Panel Payload Ports as well as the radio link.

7-48

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Managing performance

Table 262 Ethernet Payload attributes Attribute Configuration Name Meaning Variable length string encoded within a fixed field of 32 octets, conforming to RFC 2271's definition of SnmpAdminString. Revision level, an unsigned integer encoded within a fixed field of 2 octets. A 16-octet signature of type HMAC-MD5 created from the MST Configuration table. One of a number of Spanning Trees calculated by MSTP within an MST Region. Priority of the Spanning Tree instance. Allocation of defined VLAN to Spanning Trees. Unique bridge identifier (ID) containing a configurable priority number and MAC address. The bridge identifier with the smallest (lowest) bridge ID. The bridge identifier for the Tx bridge. Path cost from the Tx bridge to the root bridge for the spanning tree instance. Root port for the spanning tree instance. Common spanning tree bridge identifier (ID) as the single bridge in a Region whose CIST Root Port is a Boundary Port or the Bridge Identifier of the CIST Root if that is within the Region. Common spanning tree path cost to the CIST Regional Root. Each Port column list the status and role related to the specified Front-Panel NMS Port of the Master IO. The Radio Link(s) column (east, west, or East & West) displays the status and role for the Radio Link port(s). The radio link refers to the RF link connected to the switch port.

Revision Configuration Digest Instance Instance Priority Included VLANs Bridge Identifier Root Bridge Identifier Designated Bridge Identifier Root Path Cost Root Port CST Regional Root

CST Internal Root Path Cost

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-49

Managing performance

Chapter 7: Operation

Maintaining the system


Once installed, a PTP 810 link should require little or no maintenance.

Yearly maintenance
Recommended yearly physical maintenance: Check cables for corrosion, chafing etc. Check waterproofing. Check ground points for corrosion, tightness etc. 1+1 Hot Standby link maintenance

For a 1+1 Hot Standby link, consider a controlled switchover to the inactive unit (once every three months), to confirm that it is fully functional.

This can cause a short interruption to traffic and should be scheduled accordingly to minimize the effects.

7-50

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Saving, restoring and rebooting

Saving, restoring and rebooting


This section describes how to save and restore the system configuration, and how to reboot the unit. This section contains the following procedures: Saving the system configuration on page 7-51 Restoring the system configuration on page 7-52 Rebooting on page 7-53 Checking the recovery version on page 7-53

Saving the system configuration


The PTP 810 MMU supports a limited ability to save system configuration information. The Store Configuration feature of the MMU is designed to store general non-volatile configuration parameters, VLAN configuration parameters and STM Trace message configuration parameters. It is intended primarily for use in replicating the same custom configuration across several MMUs with identical hardware and software versions. This feature is supported only from the Web GUI.

The process for restoring a PTP 810 MMU to a previously saved configuration is described in Restoring the system configuration on page 7-52. To save the current configuration, select menu option Administration, Restore Configuration. The Store/Restore Configuration page is displayed (Figure 171). Select Download the Configuration to store the set of configurations. A dialogue box indicating save option is displayed with the file name config_info.bin. Save the configuration file to a PC hard drive which can be used for restoring configurations. Figure 171 Save/Restore Configuration page

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-51

Saving, restoring and rebooting

Chapter 7: Operation

Restoring the system configuration


Perform this procedure to restore a PTP 810 MMU to a previously saved configuration. Refer to Saving the system configuration on page 7-51 for instructions on when and how to save the configuration.

Licensed capabilities
The authorization key is not restored automatically if the configuration file is saved and then loaded on the same unit. When restoring configuration to a PTP 810 unit, ensure that a valid authorization key is installed as well. For instructions, see Entering an authorization key on page 7-60.

Restoring from the configuration file


To restore the system configuration from file, select menu option Administration, Restore Configuration. The Store/Restore Configuration page is displayed (Figure 171). Select Browse and navigate to the PC folder containing the saved configuration file named config_info.bin. Select the Upload the Configuration tab. The configuration file is uploaded and used to reconfigure the new unit to the same state as the old unit. After uploading the configuration file, do an IDU Reboot, see Rebooting on page 7-53, or power cycle the MMU to restore the configuration.

Attributes excluded from store and restore


The following system configuration attributes that were part of the configuration are not stored or restored automatically. These configuration attributes will retain their previous configuration values following a Restore Configuration operation. General Network Configuration: o o o IP Address IP Netmask IP Gateway Serial numbers Device Names: Device Name Host Name Model Number Owner
7-52

Device Information: o o

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Saving, restoring and rebooting

Contact Description Location Reprogramming Information: o o Version numbers and bank information Software components

Authorization key.

Rebooting
To reboot the MMU, select menu option Administration, Reboot. The System Reboot page is displayed (Figure 172). This screen enables the operator to reboot the MMU or certain devices within the MMU. It will display a list of devices and the operator can select depending on the availability and configuration of devices. To reboot the MMU, select the IDU device. Click the Reboot button. The reboot progress message is displayed. On completion, the unit restarts. Figure 172 System Reboot page

Checking the recovery version


To confirm the recovery software version, select menu option Administration, Maintenance, Reprogramming and note the Active software images highlighted in green.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-53

Restoring system defaults

Chapter 7: Operation

Restoring system defaults


This section describes how to restore the MMU system defaults. There are two procedures that can be performed to restore the MMU parameters to their default values. One procedure requires the operator to press the CALL button of the Master I/O module during power up to restore system defaults. The other procedure uses the Restore System Defaults page from the GUI menu.

Power on reset to system defaults


The MMU may be reset to system defaults during power up. A power on reset restores the MMU parameters to their default values (see Table 263). To perform a power on reset, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 4 5 Power on the MMU. Toward the end of system bootup, the MMU will flash the controller card LED an alternating red and green pattern for a five second period. Make sure the CALL button of the Master I/O module is not active at the start of this five second period. While the LED is flashing the alternating red and green pattern, press the CALL button. Release the call button within one second after the LED stops flashing. The MMU parameters will be restored to their system default values.

Restore system defaults page


The MMU may be reset to system defaults using the Restore System Defaults page from the GUI menu. Clicking the Restore button on this page restores the MMU parameters to their default values (see Table 263). To restore system defaults using the Restore System Defaults page, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 4 Navigate to Administration, Restore Defaults. The Restore System Defaults page is displayed (Figure 173). Click on the Restore button. The MMU parameters will be restored to their system default values.

7-54

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Restoring system defaults

Figure 173 Restore System Defaults page

System default parameter values


Table 263 lists the MMU parameters and their default values that are restored during a restore system defaults procedure. Table 263 MMU system default parameters MMU parameter IP Address IP Netmask IP Gateway DHCP Enable SNTP Server Address SNTP Server Enable Timezone Date Format UPL STP status UPL Bridge Priority UPL Max Age UPL Hello Time UPL Forward Delay Read Community Write Community Trap Community Trap Manager #1 Trap Manager #2
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Default value 192.168.0.1 255.255.255.0 192.168.0.2 Disable 0.0.0.0 Disable 0 European DISABLED 32768 20 2 15 public private public 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0
7-55

Restoring system defaults

Chapter 7: Operation

MMU parameter Trap Manager #3 Trap Manager #4 Auth Trap Enable Trap Version SNMP Mode Auth Password Priv Password SMTP Enable SMTP Server IP SMTP Port SMTP Username SMTP Password e-mail #1 e-mail #2 e-mail #3 HTTP Access Type Command Line Interface Syslog Server Syslog Facility Data Baud rate

Default value 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 Disable V1 v1-v2-v3 <blank field> <blank field> Disable 0.0.0.0 25 <blank field> <blank field> <blank field> <blank field> <blank field> HTTP CLI over Telnet 0.0.0.0 Local 1 38400

7-56

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Viewing device information

Viewing device information


This section describes how to view MMU general device and serial number information, and how to modify MMU device name related information.

General device information


To view general device information, select menu option Administration, Device Information, General. The read-only terminal information is displayed on the Device Information page (Figure 174). Review the attributes (Table 264). Figure 174 Device Information page

Table 264 Device Information attributes Attribute Model Number Chassis Serial Number Application Version Date Time Meaning Model number of the terminal. Chassis serial number assigned during manufacturing. Active application version information. Current date. Current time.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-57

Viewing device information

Chapter 7: Operation

Serial number information


To review Part Number, Revision and Serial Number information for the various cards in the MMU, select menu option Administration, Device Information, Serial Numbers. This read-only information is displayed on the Serial Number Information page (Figure 175). Figure 175 Serial Number Information page

The following cards numbers are displayed: Controller card, Master IO card, Expansion IO card (displayed only if Expansion card installed), Power Supply cards, Modem cards, IF cards, ODU, chassis, and SFP module (displayed only if SFP module installed). The Part Number is a combination of four numbers for the module type and four numbers for the module revision xxxx-yyyy. The first four numbers xxxx can be used to determine the type of module installed such as the '4130-yyyy' for a GigE Master IO Module.

Device name and owner information


To modify MMU device name related information, select menu option Administration, Device Information, Device Names. The device name and owner related parameters are displayed with their current values on the Device Names page (Figure 176). Update the attributes (Table 265) and select Update.

The Device Name and Owner values are displayed at the top of each web interface page. These attributes can be used to give a personalized appearance to the web interface.

7-58

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Viewing device information

Figure 176 Device Names page

Table 265 Device Names attributes Attribute Device Name Host Name Model Number Owner Contact Description Location Meaning The name of the device. The host name of the device. The host name should not contain any spaces. MMU model number. The name of the device owner. The contact information of owner. The device description. The device location.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-59

Upgrading the system

Chapter 7: Operation

Upgrading the system


This section describes how to enter an authorization key to increase data capacity or implement XPIC. It also describes how to install a new software version.

Entering an authorization key


Perform this task to increase the data throughput capacity of the MMU (it is shipped with capacity 10 Mbps) or to install XPIC capability. Before performing this task, obtain the necessary authorization key(s), as described in Ordering capacity upgrades and XPIC capability on page 2-40. Only one authorization key can be entered and made active in the MMU at any time. To enter an authorization key, select menu option Link Configuration, Authorization. The Authorization Key page is displayed (Figure 177). Update the attributes (Table 266) and select Update. To revert to previous values, select Reset. If the entered authorization key is valid, Key accepted is displayed. Otherwise Invalid Key is displayed. To authorize XPIC capability, enter an XPIC authorization key for the System Level as well as the East Modem and West Modem using the Slot Name parameter. When XPIC is enabled correctly with all three keys, the East and West Modem XPIC entries are displayed in the list of Authorized Features (Figure 178).

The MMU enables only those modulation modes in which: Maximum throughput capacity of modulation mode (channel size and modulation) is less than or equal to authorization key capacity.

7-60

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Upgrading the system

Figure 177 Authorization Key

Table 266 Authorization Key attributes Attribute Slot Name Meaning The device for which the authorization key will apply (System Level / East Modem / West Modem). The default selection is System Level. The authorization key provided by PTP License Key Generator. In the MMU the Authorization Key setting for Embedded Payload Configuration is always enabled and cannot be changed.

Auth Key Embedded Payload Authorization

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-61

Upgrading the system

Chapter 7: Operation

Attribute Authorized Features

Meaning Displays the list of features that are enabled by a specific authorization key. Figure 177 displays the list of features enabled by a 1+x Authorization Key.

Figure 178 XPIC Authorization Key

7-62

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Upgrading the system

Installing new software versions


This task consists of the following procedures: Checking the installed software version on page 7-63 Installing a new software version on page 7-65

Ensure that the correct units are upgraded, as units cannot easily be downgraded afterwards. If the link is operational, ensure that the remote end of the link is upgraded first using the wireless connection, and then the local end can be upgraded. Otherwise, the remote end may not be accessible.

Checking the installed software version


The MMU software consists of a number of software images associated with the various modules that are installed in the MMU. To check the installed software image versions, select menu option Administration, Maintenance, Reprogramming. The Reprogramming page is displayed (Figure 179). Two banks of MMU software versions are displayed for each software image. The Active software images are highlighted in green.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-63

Upgrading the system

Chapter 7: Operation

Figure 179 Reprogramming page

The Reprogramming page is used to reprogram / upgrade the MMU software. This screen enables the user to upgrade the Kernel, Application, Controller FPGA, Master I/O FPGA, ODU, Boot Loader, ODU East/West firmware and Modem East/West firmware images. This screen also allows the user to upgrade the following: Modes: The Modes file is a customized list that defines the modes of the MMU. Channels: The Channels file is a customized channels file that is uploaded onto each MMU.

Go to the support web page (see Contacting Cambium Networks on page 2) and navigate to Point-to-Point Software and Documentation. Check that the latest software image versions are the same as the installed software image versions. To upgrade to new image versions, perform Installing a new software version on page 765.

7-64

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Upgrading the system

Installing a new software version


MMU software versions must be the same at both ends of the link. Install the new software version at the remote end of a link before the local end. For a 1+1 Hot Standby link, if there are modem firmware or modem FPGA images that need new versions, install the new software versions in the inactive modems and force a protection switch to them before installing new versions in the active modems. This approach maximizes system availability. To swap the Active and Passive firmware images for a given module, proceed as follows: 1 2 For each module that needs its software image to be swapped, select the square radio button located at the left side of the Image column. To swap the Active and Passive software images for the selected modules, select Toggle.

To upload a new software image, proceed as follows: 1 Go to the support web page (see Contacting Cambium Networks on page 2) and navigate to Point-to-Point Software and Documentation. Download and save the required software image. Use an FTP client and connect to the MMU via IP address. Enter command ftp <IP address of MMU>. Enter the administrator username and password when prompted. Set the mode to binary by entering bin. To upload the file, enter the command put <filename> and wait for the upload to complete. Exit the FTP client. Log into the MMU web interface and select menu option Administration, Maintenance, Reprogramming. The Reprogramming page is displayed (Figure 179). For the software images being upgraded, click on the square radio button located at the left side of the Image column, then select Toggle. When done, there should be a red dot next to each firmware image being upgraded. Some firmware upgrades, such as the kernel, application, FPGA or ODU images, require that a reboot be performed before the upgrades are configured in the MMU. Select menu option Administration, Reboot and wait for the reboot to complete.

2 3 4 5 6 7 8

9 10 11

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-65

Upgrading the system

Chapter 7: Operation

12

Some firmware upgrades, such as the modes file, require that a new link configuration be performed before the upgrades are configured in the MMU. To achieve this: a. Select menu option Link Configuration, Radio Link, Link Configuration. b. Create a new link configuration. c. In the Summary of Configuration page, select Update All and wait for the link configuration to complete.

13

When the reboot or link configuration is complete, there should be green dots next to each firmware image that was upgraded in the MMU.

To update the ODU East/West firmware images, proceed as follows: 1 Rename the ODU software image filename to east_odu_fw.s19 if the ODU is connected to the east modem or west_odu_fw.s19 if the ODU is connected to the west modem. FTP one file at a time to the MMU. Administrator login credentials are required to perform this operation. The ODU firmware will be installed in the inactive bank. Toggle the ODU firmware bank of the MMU. Reboot the ODU for the uploaded ODU firmware to become active.

2 3 4

To enable XPIC, load the XPIC license authorization key and verify that the software image for the XPIC library is Active on both the Modem East FPGA and Modem West FPGA.

The spare Control Module is by default installed with the Standard Master I/O FPGA image. If a different Master I/O module (for example GigE Master I/O) is installed in an MMU where a spare Control Module needs to be installed, then reload the appropriate firmware image for the existing Master I/O module, toggle the Master IO FPGA bank and perform a Reboot of the MMU.

7-66

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Removing and installing modules

Removing and installing modules


This section describes the procedure to be performed to install or remove the various modules in the MMU. There may be up to eight modules installed in a single MMU chassis. Figure 180 shows the front panel of the MMU with each module labelled. The PTP 810 01-00 release does not support the Mini I/O module. Figure 180 MMU Modules

All the modules of the MMU are inserted from the front panel of the MMU chassis. All of the modules are hot swappable. Any module plugged into the MMU may be replaced without powering down the MMU.

Preparing to remove and install a module


To avoid damaging MMU modules, take the following precautions before performing any procedure on the MMU: Modules are static sensitive and should only be handled in an ESD-safe environment. Always place the cards on a clean, anti-Static surface. When packaging modules for shipment or storage, place in an ESD bag. When removing a module, remove existing front panel connections to the module.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-67

Removing and installing modules

Chapter 7: Operation

Removing a module
No loss of user data occurs during a replacement of the Control Module, but the IP addresses will need to be reprogrammed. Replacing a standby Modem module or Power Supply module used in a 1+1 protection configuration will not cause user traffic disruption or loss of lock.

Replacing a Master I/O module or an Expansion I/O module will result in user traffic disruption. To remove a module, remove the two thumbscrews on either side of the module. Figure 181 shows the locations of the thumbscrews. Figure 181 Thumbscrew Locations

Thread thumbscrew(s) into hole(s) shown in Figure 182. Remove the module by grasping the thumbscrew(s) and pulling the module straight out of the MMU. Both thumbscrews should be used for all modules except the Power Supply which only has one threaded hole. Figure 182 Threaded Hole Locations

7-68

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Removing and installing modules

Installing a module
To install a module, proceed as follows: 1 Line up the module board with the guides in the chassis and slide the module into the MMU. Figure 183 shows a photo of the guides. As the module face plate comes flush with the face of the MMU, connectors on the back of the module will engage with the MMU backplane. It is possible to encounter interference from adjacent module front panels. If this occurs, loosen the thumbscrews holding the neighboring panels and shift them as necessary to ensure fit. Install thumbscrews on either side of the module as shown in Figure 181. Make front panel connections to the module. Verify proper operation of the unit. If the Control Module has been changed, reprogram the IP addresses (see Task 2: Configuring IP and Ethernet interfaces on page 6-14).

2 3 4 5

Figure 183 Guides

Guide

Installing dual modem upgrade kit


The dual modem upgrade kit consists of a second Modem module and Power Supply module that need to be installed into an existing single modem MMU. An operating MMU will not need to be powered down or cause user traffic disruption while installing these two modules. To install the dual modem upgrade kit, proceed as follows:
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)
7-69

Removing and installing modules

Chapter 7: Operation

1 2 3 4 5 6 7

Remove the thumbscrews on either side of the faceplates that cover the location for the second Power Supply module and Modem module. Remove the faceplates that cover the location for the second Power Supply module and Modem module. Install the second Power Supply module and Modem module using the Installing a module procedure on page 7-69. Supply power to the new Power Supply module. Install the additional antenna, ODU and IF cable planned for use with the second modem using the procedures from Chapter 5: Installation. Connect the IF cable to the new Modem module. Depending on the planned configuration of the MMU, a license key upgrade may need to be purchased and/or a new Authorization Key may need to be entered using the procedures from Entering an authorization key on page 7-60. Review the MMU Reprogramming screen (see Figure 179) to ensure the correct Modem and ODU software images are in place using the Installing new software versions procedures on page 7-63. Toggle or upload software images as needed. Reconfigure the MMU wireless interface to the desired operational mode using the Task 3: Configuring wireless interface on page 6-24.

Software images stored on MMU modules


The software images that are displayed on the MMU Reprogramming screen (see Figure 179) are not all stored on the same module in the MMU. This has a direct impact on which software images may need to be toggled or reloaded depending on which module cards are replaced or installed. Specific toggling/reloading requirements are dependent on specific replacement/installation scenarios. It is important to review the Reprogramming screen to ensure that the expected software components are in place after any hardware modification is completed. Table 267 lists the MMU software images along with the modules where these images are stored. Table 267 MMU software images and module storage MMU software image Kernel Application Controller FPGA Master IO FPGA
7-70

Module where software image is stored Control Module Control Module Control Module Control Module
phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Removing and installing modules

MMU software image ODU Modes Channels ODU East Firmware ODU West Firmware Bootloader Modem East Firmware Modem East FPGA Modem West Firmware Modem West FPGA Expansion IO FPGA

Module where software image is stored Control Module Control Module Control Module ODU (ODU firmware version is displayed by the MMU) ODU (ODU firmware version is displayed by the MMU) Control Module Modem Module Modem Module Modem Module Modem Module Expansion IO Module

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

7-71

Removing and installing modules

Chapter 7: Operation

7-72

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
This chapter describes how to identify and correct faults in a PTP 810 link. The following topics are described in this chapter: Trouble connecting to the web management interface on page 8-2: perform this task if any problems are encountered when connecting to the PTP 810 web interface. Trouble establishing a wireless link on page 8-8: perform this task if any problems are experienced with a newly installed (or operational) wireless link. Trouble bridging Ethernet data traffic on page 8-12: perform this task if any problems are encountered when attempting to send Ethernet data traffic over an established wireless link. Trouble bridging E1/T1 traffic on page 8-15: perform this task if any problems are experienced with E1/T1 channels in a newly installed (or operational) link. Trouble managing remote unit on page 8-20: perform this task if any problems are encountered when trying to manage the remote unit.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-1

Trouble connecting to the web management interface

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Trouble connecting to the web management interface


Perform this task if any problems are encountered when connecting to the PTP 810 web interface.

Check the MMU power supply status LED


The MMU power supply status LED shows the presence of the DC supply within the MMU. Check the state of the MMU power supply status LED and take action as described in Table 268. Table 268 MMU power supply status LED checks MMU power supply status LED state Green steady Off Likely cause and action Continue at Check the MMU status indicator on page 83. The DC supply may be absent or the MMU may be faulty. Continue at Check the DC supply to the MMU on page 8-2. When both power supply modules are installed, the LED will turn to red on the faulty supply. The DC supply may be absent or the MMU may be faulty. Continue at Check the DC supply to the MMU on page 8-2.

Red

Check the DC supply to the MMU


Check the DC supply at the MMU using a suitable voltmeter and take action as described in Table 269. Table 269 DC supply checks when MMU power supply status LED is off or red DC supply state Absent or less than 41 V Reversed polarity Likely cause and action Check the AC supply, power converters, wiring, circuit breakers and fuses as appropriate. The MMU power supply module could be damaged. Correct the polarity, then replace the MMU Power Supply module.

8-2

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Trouble connecting to the web management interface

DC supply state Correct polarity and within the range 41 V to 60 V.

Likely cause and action The MMU has an internal power supply fault. Replace the MMU Power Supply module.

Check the MMU status indicators


The MMU status indicators show if the MMU has a hardware fault or is operating in normal mode. Additionally, in normal mode it indicates if the wireless link is locked or unlocked. Check the state of the MMU status indicator and take action as described in Table 270. Table 270 MMU status indicator checks MMU status indicator state Controller card status LED is Orange steady or flashing an alarm code in Orange. Controller card status LED is flashing an alarm code in Red. Likely cause and action The controller card is operating in normal mode. Continue at Check the NMS port Ethernet connection on page 8-3. This is an indication of a controller card fault, which may impair ability to connect to the web management interface. Replace the controller card.

Check the NMS port Ethernet connection


Check the state of the NMS port indicators and take action as described in Table 271. Table 271 NMS port indicator checks NMS port indicator state Green steady Off Likely cause and action The Ethernet link is locked. Continue at Check IP network connection on page 8-4. The Ethernet link is unlocked. Continue at NMS port indicator is off on page 8-4.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-3

Trouble connecting to the web management interface

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

NMS port indicator is off


If the NMS port indicator is off, it means that the Ethernet link is unlocked. If the NMS port is connected to a management network, check the following: The associated network equipment (workstation, PC, router, switch etc.) is powered up and operating correctly. The Ethernet port in the associated equipment is enabled. The Ethernet cable between the MMU and the network equipment is connected and is not damaged. If possible, substitute a known good Ethernet cable.

If the NMS port is connected directly to a PC, check the following: The Ethernet port in the PC is enabled. The Ethernet cable between the MMU and the PC is connected and is not damaged. If possible, substitute a known good Ethernet cable.

If these steps fail to resolve the problem, continue at Restoring system defaults on page 754.

Check IP network connection


If the NMS port indicators are illuminated but the IP address of the MMU is unknown, use a hyperterminal connection via a serial cable to set the IP address (see Using a serial port connection to set the IP address on page 8-5). If the IP address of the MMU is known, send a sequence of ICMP Echo Request packets to the MMU management agent using the Ping program at the command line interface of the management PC or workstation. If the MMU responds then the command line will appear similar to this: C:\ping 169.254.1.1 Pinging 169.254.1.1 with 32 bytes of data: Reply Reply Reply Reply from from from from 169.254.1.1: 169.254.1.1: 169.254.1.1: 169.254.1.1: bytes=32 bytes=32 bytes=32 bytes=32 time=1ms time<1ms time<1ms time<1ms TTL=64 TTL=64 TTL=64 TTL=64

Ping statistics for 169.254.1.1: Packets: Sent = 4, Received = 4, Lost = 0 (0% loss), Approximate round trip times in milli-seconds: Minimum = 0ms, Maximum = 1 ms, Average = 0ms

8-4

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Trouble connecting to the web management interface

If the MMU fails to respond then the command line will appear similar to this: C:\ping 169.254.1.1 Pinging 169.254.1.1 with 32 bytes of data: Request Request Request Request timed timed timed timed out. out. out. out.

Ping statistics for 169.254.1.1: Packets: Sent = 4, Received = 0, Lost = 4 (100% loss),

Check the Ping response and take action as described in Table 272. Table 272 Ping response checks Ping response Reply Request timed out Likely cause and action The IP network is providing connectivity between the PC and MMU. Continue at Check browser settings on page 8-5. There is no IP connectivity. Check network configuration including IP addresses, gateway address, subnet masks, VLAN membership in network equipment between the PC and the MMU. Check if the PC can reach other equipment in the same network. If these steps fail to resolve the problem, continue at Power on reset to system defaults on page 7-54.

Check browser settings


If there is IP connectivity between the MMU and the management PC or workstation, but web-pages cannot be displayed, check that browser settings are appropriate for the PTP 810 web interface (see Logging into the web interface on page 6-7).

Using a serial port connection to set the IP address


To set the IP address using a serial port connector, proceed as follows: 1 Connect the Serial/Alarm port on the MMU (Table 85) to a COM port on the computer.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-5

Trouble connecting to the web management interface

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Start a hyperterminal session and select the following COM port settings: Bits per second: 38400 Data bit: 8 Parity: None Stop bits: 1 Flow control: None

The following terminal and ASCII settings are recommended for best viewing: Emulation: VT100 Line delay: 50 ms Character delay: 10 ms Text wrap: On

4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13

Connect to the MMU. Once the connections complete, power on the MMU. Once the boot process is complete, press the keyboard return key to receive a login prompt. Log in with the username and password. Press the M-key to navigate to the Main Menu. Press the B-key to navigate to Administration. Press the A-key to navigate to Network Configuration. Press the A-key to navigate to General. Press the A-key to navigate to IP Address. Enter the new IP address and press the D-Key to update. If the IP address has been entered correctly enter Y when prompted. If necessary, use the same menus to set the IP Netmask and IP Gateway. Close the hyperterminal connection.

Unable to access MMU using HTTPS


Verify that the IP address of the MMU can be pinged. Verify that the HTTP Access in the Security Configuration page is set to HTTP (SSL) (see Configuring HTTP (SSL) on page 7-30). Verify that Use SSL 2.0 and Use SSL 3.0 options are selected in the Security options of the browser. Re-attempt to login to the Web interface using HTTPS.

8-6

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Trouble connecting to the web management interface

Unable to access MMU using Telnet


Verify that the IP address of the MMU can be pinged. Verify that Telnet is enabled (see Configuring HTTP (SSL) on page 7-30). Re-attempt to access the MMU using the procedure given in Logging into the CLI interface on page 6-9.

Unable to access MMU using SSH


Verify that the IP address of the MMU can be pinged. Verify that SSH is enabled (see Configuring HTTP (SSL) on page 7-30). Re-attempt to access the MMU using the procedure given in Logging into the CLI interface on page 6-9.

Unable to access MMU using serial port


Verify that the serial cable between the MMU and the PC is properly connected and is not damaged (Table 85). If possible, substitute a known good serial cable. Verify that the serial port is properly configured (see Configuring Serial Port on page 615). Re-attempt to access the MMU using the procedure given in Logging into the CLI interface on page 6-9.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-7

Trouble establishing a wireless link

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Trouble establishing a wireless link


Perform this task if any problems are experienced with a newly installed (or operational) wireless link.

Connect to the web management interface


See Trouble connecting to the web management interface on page 8-2.

Check for proper link configuration and connectivity


If the MMU is not properly configured on both ends of a link or if the MMU is not properly connected to the ODU, there will be problems in installing a wireless link. If a problem occurs in installing a wireless link, check the link configuration problem list and take action as described in Table 273. For other problems, continue at Transmitter status on page 8-10. Table 273 Link configuration problems Link configuration problem Invalid ODU frequency: When configuring the link, the ODU Channel Selection (see ODU Channel Selection on page 6-30) shows 0 GHz frequency range. Invalid ODU Start Tx Power: When configuring the link, the ODU Start Tx Power pulldown menu (see ODU Tx Power Configuration on page 629) shows 0.0 only. Likely cause and action This means that the MMU is not able to detect the ODU. Make sure that the ODU is connected correctly with the MMU. If problems persist, report a suspected ODU fault to Cambium. This means that the MMU is not able to detect the ODU. Make sure that the ODU is not impaired and make sure that the ODU and MMU are connected.

8-8

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Trouble establishing a wireless link

Link configuration problem Unable to get link locked: When configuring the link, the Status Panel shows an RSL level of Green, but the link wont lock.

Likely cause and action Check the Configuration Summary page (see Figure 99): Make sure that the configuration of both end matches with each other. For example, the modulation rate and channel size must be matched (both end use the same IDU operational mode), frequency configuration of both end matches with each other and the number of TDM channels configured on both ends are the same. Check the Reprogramming page (see Figure 179): Make sure that the MODES file being used (Active Image) on both ends of the link are correct and identical. Continue at Transmitter status on page 8-10.

Link is locked on only one end: One end of the link shows that it is locked, while the other end shows that it is unlocked.

View the Status Panel on the right hand side of the Web interface (see Viewing the system status on page 7-4). Check the Tx power on the locked end and verify that the ODU is transmitting at the expected Tx power. Continue at Transmitter status on page 8-10.

Link is locked, but unable to access remote MMUs management page

Check that RSTP is enabled on the NMS network (see Configuring Ethernet network management on page 6-21) of both ends of the link to avoid any Ethernet loop. Make sure that all Loopback tests are disabled by checking the Loopback configuration page.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-9

Trouble establishing a wireless link

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Link configuration problem Link is locked, but user IP traffic is not bridged

Likely cause and action Check that the VLAN tagging configuration is correct if VLAN is used (see Task 11: Configuring VLAN on page 6-73). In any ring configuration (East/West), verify that spanning tree is enabled for the payload network (see Configuring Ethernet payload on page 6-16). In an 2+0 or 2+0 XPIC configuration, avoid loops by enabling trunk mode, spanning tree, or by properly configuring port forwarding (see Configuring port based VLANs on page 6-77).

Transmitter status
Ensure that the transmitter is enabled. The status of the transmitter is indicated by the Transmitter attribute (ACTIVE, STANDBY, OFF or ON) in the Status Panel of the web interface (Figure 146 and Figure 147). The transmitter is enabled during installation (see Task 3: Configuring wireless interface on page 6-24). The transmitter may additionally be enabled, disabled, muted or unmuted using the web interface (see Disabling, enabling, muting and unmuting the ODU on page 7-21). In the Status Panel the transmitter needs to be Active and the modem locked for proper operation of an active link. If the transmitter is Active, but the modem remains Unlocked, continue at (Antenna alignment on page 8-10).

Antenna alignment
Repeat the Antenna Alignment procedure as described Aligning antennas on page 6-100. Check the receive power from the RSSI connector of the ODU. If the receive power level is very small or cannot be measured, continue at Check transmit and receive frequencies on page 8-11. If the receive power is close to the predicted power for the link then continue at Check link status on page 8-11.

8-10

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Trouble establishing a wireless link

Check transmit and receive frequencies


Check that the transmit frequency at the near end of the link is exactly equal to the receive frequency at the remote end of the link. Check that the receive frequency at the near end of the link is exactly equal to the transmit frequency at the remote end of the link. If this fails to resolve the problem, continue at Check waveguide and antennas

Check waveguide and antennas


Check the antennas, waveguides, RMKs and couplers for defects and incorrect assembly. If this fails to resolve the problem replace the near end ODU and, if necessary, replace the remote ODU.

Check link status


If the receive signal power is close to the predicted value, check that the same channel bandwidth is configured for both ends of the link.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-11

Trouble bridging Ethernet data traffic

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Trouble bridging Ethernet data traffic


Perform this task if any problems are encountered when attempting to send Ethernet data traffic over an established wireless link. The following are the most common factors that could cause this problem: Invalid local Ethernet connectivity Link is unlocked Incorrect VLAN configuration Mismatch in 2+0 East/East ODU connections Loop among the link (links)

To investigate and correct Ethernet data traffic problems, proceed as follows:: 1 2 Ensure that the IP devices that connect to the MMU payload Ethernet ports have good physical Ethernet connectivity. Ensure that the duplex and port speed configuration of the MMU payload port are compatible with the IP devices connected. If the port speed of the MMU is configured to be GigE only, while the IP device attached can only support 100 Mbps, there will not be a valid Ethernet connection in between. Ensure that the link is Locked by viewing the status panel of local unit and remote unit from the management web page. If VLAN is enabled, ensure that VLAN is properly configured on both near end and remote end units.

3 4

8-12

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Trouble bridging Ethernet data traffic

For any 2+0 configuration, ensure that there is no payload data Ethernet loop. This means that the following should be properly configured and enabled: a. port forwarding, b. RSTP or c. 2+0 trunk mode. If none of the above is configured, there will be a loop as shown:

In a 2+0 configuration, it is possible that the links are locked but the connections of the ODUs are mismatched. For example, Near End East ODU is locked with Far End West ODU. This will cause a very high traffic error rate. Avoid the following incorrect connection:

To identify this incorrect connection, check the status panel of the MMU GUI which shows the RF frequency used for EAST and WEST ODUs. If the EAST ODU Tx frequency of one end is the same as the WEST ODU Rx Frequency of the other end, there is a mismatched configuration. If the mismatched configuration is as shown in the above diagram, fix the problem by switching the IF cables at the MMU.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-13

Trouble bridging Ethernet data traffic

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Loopback test mode or BERT mode may block payload Ethernet data. When loopback test to local modem is enabled, no Ethernet data will be sent across the link. Therefore, ensure that loopback test mode to local modem is disabled. Also ensure that BERT test mode is not running.

8-14

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Trouble bridging E1/T1 traffic

Trouble bridging E1/T1 traffic


Perform this task if any problems are experienced with E1/T1 channels in a newly installed (or operational) link.

Check for proper configuration and connectivity


To confirm that the E1/T1 link is correctly configured and connected, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 4 View the Status Panel to verify that the RF link is locked. Verify that the channel map is correct. Make sure that the syntax is correct and that all channels configured during the link configuration are mapped. Check to be sure the E1/T1 cable connections between the MMU and the network equipment are connected and not damaged. Perform a loopback test to help diagnose the failure point (see Performing a loopback test on page 8-15). Local LIU loopback helps to prove that the local E1/T1 connection is good. Remote LIU loopback helps to prove that the connection from the local E1/T1 port all the way to the remote loopback point is good.

Performing a loopback test


Loopback tests are described in Loopback on page 1-62. They may only be performed by an administrator. To perform a loopback test, select menu option Analysis, Loopback. The Loopback page is displayed (Figure 184). Select loopback requirements (Table 274) and select Start. To stop a loopback test, select Stop.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-15

Trouble bridging E1/T1 traffic

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Figure 184 Loopback page

8-16

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Trouble bridging E1/T1 traffic

Table 274 Loopback attributes Attribute Loopback Type Meaning The component where Loopback should been enabled. The options are: Local LIU Local Modem Local ODU - Not supported Remote LIU

The Local Modem option will affect Ethernet traffic: the network management connection to the remote unit will be disrupted. Loopback LIU Type The LIU to be configured in Loopback when the Loopback type selected is Local LIU or Remote LIU. The options are: E1 - Enable loopback on the E1/T1 LIU. The GUI will always show E1, whether the T1/E1 interface is configured to be T1 or E1. STM1- Enable loopback on the STM1 LIU. Requires STM1 capable hardware to be installed on the MMU. Both - Enable loopback on the E1/T1 and STM1 LIU. Requires STM1 capable hardware to be installed on the MMU. Loopback ODU Type Loopback Duration Loopback Status Start Stop This option is not supported. Select the duration for which Loopback should be enabled. The loopback is disabled when the loopback duration expires. Displays the current Loopback status of the various components. Enable Loopback on the component selected. Disable Loopback on the component selected. Loopback is disabled immediately even if the Loopback duration has not expired.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-17

Trouble bridging E1/T1 traffic

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

BERT mode
Use BERT mode as a diagnostic tool to measure bit error rate over the link without external test equipment. In BERT mode, the user communicates with the MODEM directly by sending a command and receiving the response.

When BERT mode is enabled, the link will be disrupted and the remote MMU will not be accessible. As there is no separate NMS stream when operating in BERT mode, the BERT mode has to be enabled independently at both ends of the link. This requires the use of two PCs, one connected directly to the NMS port of each MMU. BERT mode may only be accessed by an administrator. To start BERT testing, proceed as follows: 1 2 3 Obtain two PCs. Connect one PC to the NMS port of one MMU, and the other PC to the NMS port of the other MMU. Select menu option Analysis, BERT Mode. The BERT mode page is displayed (Figure 185). Enable BERT mode at one MMU by selecting East Enable or West Enable. After few seconds (depending on network speed) the response from MODEM for the given command will be displayed in the text area. 4 Enabling this mode will generate random data over the link causing the other MMU to trigger the buzzer, generating noise. To silence the buzzer noise, enable BERT mode at the other MMU. Monitor the attributes (Table 275). Use the scroll bar to view all messages in the text area. Every new response message is appended to the end of the list. To reset the cumulative bits, cumulative bit errors, and bit error rate counters: a. Select Clear at both MMUs. b. After few seconds (depending on network speed) the response from MODEM for the given command will be displayed in the text area. 7 To insert an error and see whether the modem catches it, select Insert Bit Error.

5 6

To stop BERT testing, disable BERT mode at one MMU by selecting East Disable or West Disable. This will cause this MMU to generate a buzzer noise. Disable BERT mode at the other MMU. This should silence the buzzer noise.

8-18

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Trouble bridging E1/T1 traffic

Figure 185 BERT Mode page

Table 275 BERT Mode attributes Attribute Text area Cumulative Bits (*) Cumulative Bit Error (*) Bit Error Rate (*) Meaning Displays the response messages from the MODEM. Total number of bits. Total number of error bits. Percentage of error bits.

(*) These are accumulated until the BERTs are disabled, or the MMUs are power cycled, which will clear the BERT mode.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

8-19

Trouble managing remote unit

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Trouble managing remote unit


Perform this task if any problems are encountered when trying to manage the remote unit. To investigate and correct problems with remote unit management, proceed as follows:: 1 2 3 Verify that the remote unit can be reached by pinging the IP address of the remote unit. If the remote unit can be pinged, continue at Trouble connecting to the web management interface on page 8-2. If the remote unit cannot be pinged, verify that the wireless link is successfully established (locked). If the wireless link is not successfully established, continue at Trouble establishing a wireless link on page 8-8. If the wireless link is locked, ensure that no Ethernet loop is present in the network. Ensure that RSTP is turned on for network management from the local unit. Ensure that the link is not running any test mode, such as loopback test mode or BERT test mode.

8-20

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Glossary
Term ACM AES AIS APC APS ARP ATPC AWG BER BERT CEPT CER CIST CLI CPU CST DES DHCP DOW DSCP DTF EIRP EMC EMD ETSI FCC Definition Adaptive Coding/Modulation Advanced Encryption Standard Alarm Indication Signal Adaptive Power Control Automatic Protection Switch Address Resolution Protocol Automatic Transmitter Power Control American Wire Gage Bit Error Rate Bit Error Rate Test European Conference of Postal and Telecommunications Administrations Channel Error Rate Common and Internal Spanning Tree Command Line Interface Central Processing Unit Common Spanning Tree Data Encryption Standard Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol Data Orderwire Differentiated Services Code Point Distance To Fault Equivalent Isotropic Radiated Power Electromagnetic compatibility Electromagnetic discharge European Telecommunications Standards Institute Federal Communications Commission
I

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Glossary

Term FE FEC FPGA FTP GUI HSB HT HTTP HTTPS (SSL) IC ICMP ID IDU IEEE IF I/O IP ITU LACP LAN LED LIU LOS LPU LT MAC MD5 MIB MMU

Definition Fast Ethernet Forward Error Correction Field Programmable Gate Array File Transfer Protocol Graphical User Interface Hot Standby High Transmit frequency Hypertext Transfer Protocol HTTP over Secure Sockets Layer Industry Canada Internet Control Message Protocol Identity Indoor Unit Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers Intermediate Frequency Input/Output Internet Protocol International Telecommunications Union Link Aggregation Control Protocol Local Area Network Light Emitting Diode Line Interface Unit Loss Of Signal Lightning Protection Unit Low Transmit frequency Medium Access Control Layer Message Digest Algorithm Management Information Base Modular Modem Unit

II

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 Series User Guide

Term MPLS MSTP NMS NTP ODU OMK OMT PC PDH PING PTP QAM QoS QPSK RMK RF RSL RSSI RSTP SD SDH SDIDU SELV SFP SMTP SNCP SNMP SNR SNTP SSH

Definition Multi-Protocol Label Switching Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol Network Management Server Network Time Protocol Outdoor Unit Orthogonal Mounting Kit Orthogonal Mode Transducer IBM Compatible Personal Computer Plesiochronous Digital Hierarchy ICMP Echo Request Point-to-Point Quadrature Amplitude Modulation Quality of Service Quadrature Phase Shift Keying Remote Mounting Kit Radio Frequency Receive Signal Level Received Signal Strength Indication Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol Spatial Diversity Synchronous Digital Hierarchy Alternative term for MMU Safety Extra Low Voltage Small Form-factor Pluggable Simple Mail Transfer Protocol Sub-Network Connection Protection Simple Network Management Protocol Signal to Noise Ratio Simple Network Time Protocol Secure Shell

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

III

Glossary

Term STM STP TCP TDM TPID UNI UV VID VLAN VSWR XPI XPIC

Definition Synchronous Transport Module Spanning Tree Protocol Transmission Control Protocol Time Division Multiplexing Tag Protocol Identifier User-Network Interface Ultraviolet VLAN Identifier Virtual Local Area Network Voltage Standing Wave Ratio Cross-Polar Interference Cross-Polar Interference Cancellation

IV

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

Alarms
PTP 810 system alarms are described in the following pages.

phn-2779_001v000 (Jul 2012)

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Modem Fault Lower

Affected Component
Modem

Description
The specified Modem card has indicated a fault. Fault detection is via reading Modem Hardware Status from MODEM during startup and polling GPIO for MODEM fault indication. Polling interval 5 sec. The Controller Card is unable to communicate with the specified Modem card. The specified Modem card has been removed from the IDU (only if the specified Modem card has been enabled for use). Fault detection via card-detect logic. Alarm is raised then lowered.

LED to RED
Modem Lower

Alarm Code
11

Severity
Critical

Modem Comm Failure Lower Modem Card Removed Lower

Modem

Modem Lower

12

Critical

Modem

N/A

13

Major

Remote Fault East Remote Fault West T1E1 Expansion IO Test Mode Link Reconfigured

Alarms1

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Modem Card Installed Lower

Affected Component
Modem

Description
The specified Modem card has been installed into the IDU (only if the specified Modem card is not enabled for use). Fault detection via card-detect logic. Alarm is raised then lowered. The demodulation functional components of the modem have lost lock to the incoming signal. The data received through the RF link is not valid. Fault detection via modem status polling. Polling interval: 1 sec. RSSI is approaching the minimum operational level of the link as set during configuration. Fault detection via modem status polling, comparing RSSI value to threshold value in configuration table. Polling interval 5 sec. Modem synthesizer has unlocked. Fault detection via modem status polling. Polling is done in conjunction with Modem Unlock polling. The signal-to-noise ratio is below the minimum operational level of the link as set during configuration. Fault detection via modem status polling, comparing Eb/No value to threshold value in configuration table. Polling interval 5 sec. The specified Modem card has indicated a fault. Fault detection is via reading Modem Hardware Status from MODEM during startup and polling GPIO for MODEM fault indication. Polling interval 5 sec.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
14

Severity
Info

Modem Unlock Lower

Modem

N/A

N/A

Critical

RSL Low Lower

Modem

N/A

N/A

Major

Synthesizer Unlock Lower

Modem

N/A

N/A

Critical

SNR Low Lower

Modem

N/A

N/A

Major

Modem Fault Upper

Modem

Modem Upper

16

Critical

Alarms2

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Modem Comm Failure Upper Modem Card Removed Upper

Affected Component
Modem

Description
The Controller Card is unable to communicate with the specified Modem card. The specified Modem card has been removed from the IDU (only if the specified Modem card has been enabled for use). Fault detection via card-detect logic. Alarm is raised then lowered. The specified Modem card has been installed into the IDU (only if the specified Modem card is not enabled for use). Fault detection via card-detect logic. Alarm is raised then lowered. The demodulation functional components of the modem have lost lock to the incoming signal. The data received through the RF link is not valid. Fault detection via modem status polling. Polling interval 1 sec. RSSI is approaching the minimum operational level of the link as set during configuration. Fault detection via modem status polling, comparing RSSI value to threshold value in configuration table. Polling interval 5 sec. The signal-to-noise ratio is below the minimum operational level of the link as set during configuration. Fault detection via modem status polling, comparing Eb/N0 value to threshold value in configuration table. Polling interval 5 sec.

LED to RED
Modem Upper

Alarm Code
17

Severity
Critical

Modem

N/A

18

Major

Modem Card Installed Upper

Modem

N/A

19

Info

Modem Unlock Upper

Modem

N/A

N/A

Critical

RSL Low Upper

Modem

N/A

N/A

Major

SNR Low Upper

Modem

N/A

N/A

Major

Alarms3

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Synthesizer Unlock Upper

Affected Component
Modem

Description
Modem synthesizer has unlocked. Fault detection via modem status polling. Polling is done in conjunction with Modem Unlock polling. The Fan rotational speed is too low. (Controller card LED flashed red rather than orange). Fault detection via polling fan controller status. The fan number shall be included in the Alarm message. Polling interval 3 sec. The CPU has detected a fault in the controller card. (Controller card LED flashes red rather than orange). Fault detection via software. The CPU has detected a low-battery voltage condition. (Controller card LED flashes red rather than orange). Fault detection via software polling RTC via controller FPGA. The Power Supply card has indicated a fault. Fault detection via polling GPIO. Polling interval 5 sec. The specified Power Supply card has been removed from the IDU. Fault detection via card-detect logic. The Power Supply card has indicated a fault. Fault detection via polling GPIO. Polling interval 5 sec. The specified Power Supply card has been removed from the IDU. Fault detection via card-detect logic.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
N/A

Severity
Critical

Fan Failure x

Controller

Controller

21

Major

Controller Card Fault

Controller

Controller

22

Critical

Low Battery Voltage

Controller

Controller

23

Info

Power Supply Fault Lower

Power Supply

N/A

31

Critical

Power Supply Card Removed Lower

Power Supply

N/A

32

Major

Power Supply Fault Upper

Power Supply

N/A

36

Critical

Power Supply Card Removed Upper

Power Supply

N/A

37

Major

Alarms4

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Standard I/O Card Removed

Affected Component
MstIO

Description
The Standard I/O card has been removed from the IDU. Fault detect via card-detect logic. There is no cable detected at the specified Ethernet payload port on I/O card (only if Ethernet mode enabled). Fault detection via polling of Ethernet PHY. Polling interval 5 sec. The Mini I/O card has been removed from the IDU (only if Mini I/O card has been enabled for use). Fault detection via card-detect logic. The Mini I/O card has been installed into the IDU (only if Mini I/O card is noted enabled for use). Fault detection via card-detect logic. Alarm is raised then lowered. The Expansion I/O card has been removed from the IDU (only if the Expansion I/O card has been enabled for use). Fault detection via card-detect logic. The Expansion I/O card has been installed into the IDU (only if the Expansion I/O card is not enabled for use). Fault detection via carddetect logic. Alarm is raised then lowered.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
41

Severity
Critical

Ethernet Payload Disconnect Port x

MstIO

Standard I/O

42

Critical

Mini I/O Card Removed

MiniIO

Standard I/O

46

Critical

Mini I/O Card Installed

MiniIO

Standard I/O

47

Info

Expansion I/O Card Removed

ExpIO

N/A

26

Critical

Expansion I/O Card Installed

ExpIO

Expansion I/O

27

Info

Alarms5

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
T1E1 [Master, Expansion] IO x Disconnect

Affected Component
MstIO (1-42) ExpIO (1-21)

Description
There is either no cable detected at the specified E1/ T1 channel port on Standard I/O Card or there is an AIS condition detected (only for active T1/E1 channels). Fault detection via polling of LIUs on Standard I/O card and Expansion I/O Card when installed. Polling interval 2 channels per 1 sec. Report of this alarm in the GUI/Syslog/Alarm history shall indicate whether this is a disconnect or AIS condition. If both conditions are present, then the disconnect alarm shall take precedence over the AIS alarm. If the alarms masked, both disconnect and AIS conditions are masked The user has selected a T1/ E1 test mode (loopback or TX Data). This alarm shall be set when the user sets the testmode for any of the T1/E1 channels, and cleared when all T1/E1 channels are not in loopback and TX Data is normal. This alarm shall be set when the user enables either BERT, Loopback, or CW mode, and cleared when all BERT, Loopback and CW modes are disabled.

LED to RED
Turn LED orange rather than RED on Master I/O

Alarm Code
51-58 (1-16) 61-68 (17-32)

Severity
Critical

T1/E1 Test Mode

MstIO

N/A

59

Info

BERT/LB/CW Test Mode

MstIO

N/A

69

Info

Alarms6

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU Fault Lower

Affected Component
ODU

Description
The ODU has indicated a fault condition. Fault detection via polling of ODU or unsolicited message, if supported. Polling interval 5 sec. Polling done via API functional call. Report of this alarm in the GUI/Syslog/ Alarm history shall indicate the fault code from the ODU. The IDU is unable to communicate with the ODU. This could be a problem with the ODU or a problem with the cable connecting the ODU to the IDU. The ODU has indicated a fault condition or unsolicited message, if supported. Fault detection via polling of ODU. Polling interval 5 sec. Polling done via API function call. Report of this alarm in the GUI/Syslog/ Alarm history shall indicate the fault code from the ODU. The IDU is unable to communicate with the ODU. This could be a problem with the ODU or a problem with the cable connecting the ODU to the IDU. This alarm shall be set when an AL1 command is received from the active MODEM/ODU, then cleared when an AL2 command is received from the standby MODEM/ODU. Report of this alarm in the GUI/Syslog/ Alarm history shall indicate the fault code from the ODU, if received.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
71

Severity
Critical

ODU Comm Failure Lower

ODU

N/A

72

Critical

ODU Fault Upper

ODU

N/A

73

Critical

ODU Comm Failure Upper

ODU

N/A

74

Critical

Protection Switch

MODEM/ODU

N/A

75

Major

Alarms7

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
East ATPC TX at Max Power

Affected Component
ODU

Description
The IDU is unable to increase the TX Power as requested by link partner due to maximum power being reached. Maximum power is specified in the configuration table. The IDU is unable to increase the TX Power as requested by link partner due to maximum power being reached. Maximum power is specified in the configuration table. Failed to receive link heartbeat from link partner via Radio Overhead (ROH) channel. Fault detection via timeout counter, which is reset via reception of link heartbeat message. Data is not being decrypted properly due to encryption key mismatch between link partners. Fault detection via software detection of unreadable ROH messages from link partner. Only one IDU has data encryption enabled. Fault detection via software messages to/from link partner. The external Alarm 1 input has been activated. Fault detection via polling GPIO. Polling interval 1 sec. The external Alarm 2 input has been activated. Fault detection via polling GPIO. Polling interval 1 sec.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
76

Severity
Info

West ATPC TX at Max Power

ODU

N/A

78

Info

Link Fault

IDU

N/A

81

Critical

Encryption Failure

IDU

N/A

83

Critical

Encryption OneWay

IDU

N/A

84

Major

External Alarm 1

External

N/A

91

Info

External Alarm 2

External

N/A

92

Info

Alarms8

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
External Alarm 3

Affected Component
External

Description
The external Alarm 3 input has been activated. Fault detection via polling GPIO. Polling interval 1 sec. The external Alarm 4 input has been activated. Fault detection via polling GPIO. Polling interval 1 sec. The link partner IDU has indicated an alarm condition via ROH. The link partner IDU has indicated via ROH its external alarm input 1 has been activated. The link partner IDU has indicated via ROH its external alarm input 2 has been activated. The link partner IDU has indicated via ROH its external alarm input 3 has been activated. The link partner IDU has indicated via ROH its external alarm input 4 has been activated. The SDH/SONET clock has lost lock. Fault detection via polling of LIU. The SDH/SONET has a Loss of Signal Defect. Fault detection via polling of LIU. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has a B1 Defect. Fault detection via polling of RS_B1_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has a Loss of Frame Defect. Fault detection via polling of RS_LOF_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
93

Severity
Info

External Alarm 4

External

N/A

94

Info

Remote IDU Alarm Remote IDU External Alarm 1

Link Partner IDU Link Partner External

N/A

95

Major

N/A

96

Info

Remote IDU External Alarm 2

Link Partner External

N/A

97

Info

Remote IDU External Alarm 3

Link Partner External

N/A

98

Info

Remote IDU External Alarm 4

Link Partner External

N/A

99

Info

STM Loss of Clock STM Loss of Signal STM RS_B1

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

STM RS_LOF

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

Alarms9

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
STM RS_OOF

Affected Component
IDU

Description
The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has a Out of Frame Defect. Fault detection via polling of RS_OOF_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has a Trace Identifier Mismatch Defect. Fault detection via polling of RS_TIM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has detected an AIS at the Multiplexer Level. Fault detection via polling of MS_AIS_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has detected a Remote Error at the Multiplexer Level. Fault detection via polling of MS_REI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has detected an Remote Defect at the Multiplexer Level. Fault detection via polling of MS_RDI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Critical

STM RS_TIM

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

STM MS-AIS

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

STM MS-REI

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

STM MS-RDI

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms10

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
STM MS_B2

Affected Component
IDU

Description
The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has a B2 Defect at the Multiplex level. Fault detection via polling of MS_B2_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has detected an AIS at the AU Level. Fault detection via polling of AU_AIS_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux has detected an Loss of Pointer Defect at the AU Level. Fault detection via polling of AU_LOP_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux HP is Unequipped. Fault detection via polling of HP_UNEQ_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux HP has a Trace Identifier Mismatch. Fault detection via polling of HP_TM_TIM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux HP has a Remote Error Indication. Fault detection via polling of HP_REI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

STM AU-AIS

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

STM AU-LOP

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

STM HP-UNEQ

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

STM HP-TIM

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

STM HP-REI

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms11

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
STM HP-RDI

Affected Component
IDU

Description
The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux HP has a Remote Defect Indication. Fault detection via polling of HP_RDI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux HP has a Path Identifier Mismatch. Fault detection via polling of HP_PLM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux HP has a CRC Error. Fault detection via polling of HP_B3_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux TU number x has a Loss of Multiframe. Fault detection via polling of TU_LOMF_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the TU index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux TU number x has an AIS. Fault detection via polling of TU_AIS_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the TU index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

STM HP-PLM

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

STM HP_B3

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

STM TU-LOM lkm

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

STM TU-AIS lkm

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

Alarms12

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
STM TU-LOP lkm

Affected Component
IDU

Description
The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux TU number x has a Loss of Pointer Defect. Fault detection via polling of TU_LOP_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the TU index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux LP number x is Unequipped. Fault detection via polling of LP_UNEQ_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux LP number x has a Trace Identifier Mismatch. Fault detection via polling of LP_TM_TIM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux LP number x has a Remote Error Indication. Fault detection via polling of LP_REI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Critical

STM LP-UNEQ lkm

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

STM LP-TIM lkm

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

STM LP-REI lkm

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms13

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
STM LP-RDI lkm

Affected Component
IDU

Description
The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux LP number x has a Remote Defect Indication. Fault detection via polling of LP_RDI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux LP number x has a Path Identifier Mismatch. Fault detection via polling of LP_PLM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux LP number x has a Remote Fault Indication. Fault detection via polling of LP_RFI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The SDH/SONET Mux/ Demux LP number x has a CRC Error. Fault detection via polling of LP_BIP2_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. During power-up raise then lower this alarm. When a user reboots the MMU, raise then lower this alarm prior to re-booting.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

STM LP-PLM lkm

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

STM LP-RFI lkm

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

STM LP-BIP2 lkm

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

SDIDU PowerUp SDIDU Re-boot

IDU IDU

N/A N/A

Solid Solid

Info Info

Alarms14

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
NTP Update

Affected Component
IDU

Description
When the system time is updated via NTP raise then lower this alarm. The previous system time and new system time should be noted in the alarm log, snmp trap, and syslog messages. When the FPGA image(s) does not match the installed Master IO card, this alarm shall be set. When the FPGA programming fails, this alarm shall be set. It informs the user that a receive side protection switch has occurred. There are no user controls for a receive protection switch. The framer is always receiving from both east and west modems in a 1+1 configuration and may switch active receivers if the quality is better on one side versus the other.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Info

Master IO FPGA Mismatch

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

FPGA Programming Failure Receive Protection Switch

IDU

N/A

Solid

Critical

IDU

N/A

Solid

Info

Alarms15

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
East PDH Protection Switch

Affected Component
IDU

Description
When the FPGA initiates a PDH Ring Protection Switch this Alarm shall be set. The FPGA alarms bits shall be polled every 1 second, and the Alarm raised when the alarm bits are set, and cleared when the alarm bits are cleared. When the FPGA initiates a PDH Ring Protection Switch this Alarm shall be set. The FPGA alarms bits shall be polled every 1 second, and the Alarm raised when the alarm bits are set, and cleared when the alarm bits are cleared. When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 0 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

West PDH Protection Switch

IDU

N/A

Solid

Major

ODU Alarm 1

ODU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms16

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU Alarm 2

Affected Component
ODU

Description
When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 1 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history. When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 2 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

ODU Alarm 3

ODU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms17

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU Alarm 4

Affected Component
ODU

Description
When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 3 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history. When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 4 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

ODU Alarm 5

ODU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms18

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU Alarm 6

Affected Component
ODU

Description
When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 5 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history. When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 6 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

ODU Alarm 7

ODU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms19

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU Alarm 8

Affected Component
ODU

Description
When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 7 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history. When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 8 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

ODU Alarm 9

ODU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms20

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU Alarm 10

Affected Component
ODU

Description
When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 9 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history. When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 10 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

ODU Alarm 11

ODU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms21

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU Alarm 12

Affected Component
ODU

Description
When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 11 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history. When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 12 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

ODU Alarm 13

ODU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms22

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU Alarm 14

Affected Component
ODU

Description
When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 13 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history. When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 14 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

ODU Alarm 15

ODU

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms23

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU Alarm 16

Affected Component
ODU

Description
When the ODU sends a fault message, this alarm will correspond to bit 15 of the alarm message. This alarm will be set when the bit is active, and reset when the bit is inactive. The ODU fault status will be polled at 5 second intervals, as well as spontaneous ODU messages. Text describing the alarm type from the ODU library shall be added to the alarm text in the active alarms and alarm history. The SFP module has been installed into the IDU (only if GigE card is installed). Fault detection via FPGA register read. Alarm is raised then lowered. The SFP module has been removed into the IDU (only if GigE card is installed). Fault detection via FPGA register read. Alarm is raised then lowered. The SFP module fault (only if GigE card is installed). Fault detection via FPGA register read. Alarm is raised until fault condition is cleared then lowered. There is no cable detected at the SFP module (only if Ethernet mode enabled and GigE card installed). Fault detection via polling of Ethernet PHY. Polling interval 5 sec. The specified operating temperature of the MMU has exceeded the upper or lower temperature limit.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

SFP Module Installed

MstIO

MstIO

N/A

Info

SFP Module Removed

MstIO

MstIO

N/A

Info

SFP Module TX Fault

MstIO

MstIO

N/A

Major

SFP Payload Disconnect

MstIO

MstIO

N/A

Critical

SDIDU Temperature out of Range

IDU

N/A

N/A

Info

Alarms24

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
ODU East Temperature Out Of Range

Affected Component
ODU

Description
The specified operating temperature of the East ODU has exceeded the upper or lower temperature limit. The specified operating temperature of the West ODU has exceeded the upper or lower temperature limit. When the system detects that the ODU operational mode is not authorized during bootup. When the system detects that the IDU operational mode is not authorized during bootup. When the system detects that there is a mismatch between the version of the Application and ODU Library, the alarm will be activated and the modem process will exit to avoid undesired system behavior

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
N/A

Severity
Info

ODU West Temperature Out Of Range

ODU

N/A

N/A

Info

ODU MODE NOT AUTHORIZED IDU MODE NOT AUTHORIZED

IDU

NA

N/A

Critical

IDU

NA

N/A

Critical

Application And ODU Image Mismatch

IDU

Controller

N/A

Critical

Alarms25

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Adaptive Modulation Lower

Affected Component
IDU

Description
SET when an Adaptive Modulation/Coding switch occurred for the Lower Modem. The additional information with the alarm indicates the new mode when the alarm is SET and the old mode when the alarm is RESET. SET when an Adaptive Modulation/Coding switch occurred for the Upper Modem. The additional information with the alarm indicates the new mode when the alarm is SET and the old mode when the alarm is RESET. SET when the USB Key is not plugged in the Controller (only for CCM-4501). RESET when the USB Key is plugged in the Controller (only for CCM-4501). This alarm is generated when a USB key previously installed is removed. If the MMU is powered up without a USB key this alarm will not be generated. SET when the USB Key cannot be read or cannot be written or the content is not recognized ((it is not a Package File.) (Only for CCM-4501 Controller). RESET when USB Key can be read or written or the content can be recognized Or RESET if USB Key Missing alarm is SET (Only for CCM-4501 Controller).

LED to RED
Controller

Alarm Code
N/A

Severity
Critical

Adaptive Modulation Upper

IDU

Controller

N/A

Critical

USB Key Missing

IDU

Controller

N/A

Info

USB Key Fault

IDU

Controller

N/A

Major

Alarms26

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
USB SW Key Mismatch

Affected Component
IDU

Description
SET when at least one Component version present in the USB Key is different from the version in the active bank of the related plugged unit or there is at least one unit whose component is not stored in the USB Key (Only for CCM-4501 Controller). RESET when all Component versions present in the USB Key are the same as the version in the active bank of the related plugged unit or there is at least one unit whose component is not stored in the USB Key or RESET if USB Key Missing alarm is SET or USB Key Fault alarm is SET(Only for CCM-4501 Controller). SET during the transferring of the software components contained in the USB Key to the system units (Only for CCM-4501 Controller). RESET when copying is completed or USB Key Missing alarm is SET (Only for CCM-4501 Controller). The Expansion STM MSP Signal degrades alarm for the front panel ports. SET when fault occurs in working path and RESET when it gets cleared. The Expansion STM MSP Signal Failure alarm for the front panel ports. SET when fault occurs in working path and RESET when it gets cleared.

LED to RED
Controller

Alarm Code
N/A

Severity
Major

USB Copy inprogress

IDU

Controller

N/A

Info

Exp STM MSP SD EXx(x=1,2)

ExpIO

ExpIO

N/A

Critical

Exp STM MSP SF Port EXx(x=1,2)

ExpIO

ExpIO

N/A

Critical

Alarms27

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Exp STM SNCP SD EXx(x=A,B,C and D)

Affected Component
ExpIO

Description
The Expansion STM SNCP Signal degrades alarm for the channels present in the STM ADM Core. SET when fault occurs in working channels and RESET when it gets cleared. The Expansion STM SNCP Signal Failure alarm for the channels present in the STM ADM Core. SET when fault occurs in working channels and RESET when it gets cleared. The Expansion SDH/ SONET clock has lost lock. Fault detection via polling of LIU. The Expansion SDH/ SONET has a Loss of Signal Defect. Fault detection via polling of LIU. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has a B1 Defect in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of RS_B1_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has a Loss of Frame Defect in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of RS_LOF_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
ExpIO

Alarm Code
N/A

Severity
Critical

Exp STM SNCP SF EXx(x=A,B,C and D)

ExpIO

ExpIO

N/A

Critical

Expx STM Loss of Clock (x=Front Panel 1 and 2) Expx STM RS_LOS (x= Front Panel 1 and 2) Exp STM RS_B1 EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Exp STM RS_LOF EXx(x= ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

Alarms28

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Exp STM RS_OOF EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

Affected Component
ExpIO

Description
The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has a Out of Frame Defect in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of RS_OOF_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has a Trace Identifier Mismatch Defect in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of RS_TIM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has detected an AIS at the Multiplexer Level in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of MS_AIS_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has detected a Remote Error at the Multiplexer Level in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of MS_REI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has detected an Remote Defect at the Multiplexer Level in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of MS_RDI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Critical

Exp STM RS_TIM EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Exp STM MSAIS EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

Exp STM MSREI EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Exp STM MSRDI EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms29

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Exp STM MS_B2 EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

Affected Component
ExpIO

Description
The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has a B2 Defect at the Multiplex level in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of MS_B2_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has detected an AIS at the AU Level in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of AU_AIS_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux has detected an Loss of Pointer Defect at the AU Level in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of AU_LOP_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux HP is Unequipped in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of HP_UNEQ_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux HP has a Trace Identifier Mismatch in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of HP_TM_TIM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

Exp STM AUAIS EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

Exp STM AULOP EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

Exp STM HPUNEQ EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Exp STM HPTIM EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms30

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Exp STM HPREI EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

Affected Component
ExpIO

Description
The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux HP has a Remote Error Indication in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of HP_REI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux HP has a Remote Defect Indication in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of HP_RDI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux HP has a Path Identifier Mismatch in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of HP_PLM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux HP has a CRC Error in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of HP_B3_T bit in STM-1 Core. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux TU has a Loss of Multiframe in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of TU_LOMF_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the TU index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

Exp STM HPRDI EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Exp STM HPPLM EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

Exp STM HP_B3 EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D)

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Exp STM TULOM EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

Alarms31

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Exp STM TUAIS EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

Affected Component
ExpIO

Description
The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux TU has an AIS in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of TU_AIS_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the TU index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux TU has a Loss of Pointer Defect in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of TU_LOP_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the TU index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux LP is Unequipped in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of LP_UNEQ_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux LP has a Trace Identifier Mismatch in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of LP_TM_TIM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Critical

Exp STM TULOP EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

Exp STM LPUNEQ EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Exp STM LPTIM EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Alarms32

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Exp STM LPREI EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

Affected Component
ExpIO

Description
The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux LP has a Remote Error Indication in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of LP_REI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux LP has a Remote Defect Indication in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of LP_RDI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux LP has a Path Identifier Mismatch in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of LP_PLM_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux LP has a Remote Fault Indication in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of LP_RFI_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

Exp STM LPRDI EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Major

Exp STM LPPLM EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

Exp STM LP-RFI EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

ExpIO

N/A

Solid

Critical

Alarms33

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Exp STM LPBIP2 EXx(x=ADM Core A,B,C, and D) lkm

Affected Component
ExpIO

Description
The Expansion SDH/ SONET Mux/Demux LP has a CRC Error in the STM ADM Core. Fault detection via polling of LP_BIP2_T bit in STM-1 Core. Where lkm is the LP index as LKM numbering. Alternate detection via Interrupt enabled in STM-1 core. The XPIC signal-to-cross polarization interference ratio is below the minimum operational level of the link as set during configuration. Lower is an indication of the modem card present in the lower position of the MMU chassis. Fault detection via modem status polling, comparing user configured threshold value with threshold value in configuration table. Polling interval 5 sec. The XPIC signal-to- cross polarization interference ratio is below the minimum operational level of the link as set during configuration. Upper is an indication of the modem card present in the upper position of the MMU chassis. Fault detection via modem status polling, comparing user configured threshold value with threshold value in configuration table. Polling interval 5 sec.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
Solid

Severity
Major

Signal/XPI Threshold Low Lower

Modem

N/A

N/A

Major

Signal/XPI Threshold Low Upper

Modem

N/A

N/A

Major

Alarms34

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
XPIC Unlock Lower

Affected Component
Modem

Description
XPIC is not providing cancellation, that is, XPIC has lost phase lock with the XPI signal. If this alarm is triggered when the Signal/XPI ratio is greater than 25 dB, the cross-polar interfering signal is too low to need to be cancelled and will not affect the operation of the link. Under this condition the alarm should be treated as informational only. Cancelling of the XPI signal usually occurs when the Signal/XPI ratio is between 10 and 25 dB. However, if the signals are impaired, for example due to high phase noise, then the alarm could be triggered, indicating a problem on the link. Equally, when the Signal/XPI ratio is below 10 dB, there is unlikely to be sufficient discrimination for effective cancellation and the alarm indicates a problem on the link. The Signal/XPI ratio is included in the Signal/Noise graph. Upper / Lower is an indication of the modem card location in the MMU chassis. Fault detection is done via modem status polling. XPIC Loss of Link status of the modem card has unlocked indicating that the inter-modem hi-speed interface has been disconnected. Lower is an indication of the modem card present in the lower position of the MMU chassis.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
N/A

Severity
Major

XPIC Unlock Upper

Modem

N/A

N/A

Major

XPIC Cable Disconnect Lower

Modem

N/A

N/A

Major

Alarms35

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
XPIC Cable Disconnect Upper

Affected Component
Modem

Description
XPIC Loss of Link status of the modem card has unlocked indicating that the inter-modem hi-speed interface has been disconnected. Upper is an indication of the modem card present in the upper position of the MMU chassis. 2xSTM1-Primary Synchronization Reference Failure Indicator for Expansion IO Card.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
N/A

Severity
Major

Exp Primary Sync Reference Unlocked

ExpIO

N/A

N/A

INFO

Alarms36

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Exp Secondary Sync Reference Unlocked Exp Tertiary Sync Reference Unlocked Unified Modem Fault1 Lower

Affected Component
ExpIO

Description
2xSTM1-Secondary Synchronization Reference Failure Indicator for Expansion IO Card. 2xSTM1-Tertiary Synchronization Reference Failure Indicator for Expansion IO Card. The specified Lower Modem card has indicated a security fault. Fault detection is via reading Modem Hardware Status from MODEM during start-up. Lower is an indication of the modem card present in the lower position of the MMU chassis. The specified Upper Modem card has indicated a security fault. Fault detection is via reading Modem Hardware Status from MODEM during start-up. Upper is an indication of the modem card present in the upper position of the MMU chassis. The specified Lower Modem card has indicated a security fault. Fault detection is via reading Modem Hardware Status from MODEM during start-up. Lower is an indication of the modem card present in the lower position of the MMU chassis.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
N/A

Severity
INFO

ExpIO

N/A

N/A

INFO

Modem

N/A

N/A

CRITICAL

Unified Modem Fault1 Upper

Modem

N/A

N/A

CRITICAL

Unified Modem Fault2 Lower

Modem

N/A

N/A

CRITICAL

Alarms37

PTP 810 MMU Alarms

Alarm
Unified Modem Fault2 Upper

Affected Component
Modem

Description
The specified Upper Modem card has indicated a security fault. Fault detection is via reading Modem Hardware Status from MODEM during start-up. Upper is an indication of the modem card present in the upper position of the MMU chassis.

LED to RED
N/A

Alarm Code
N/A

Severity
CRITICAL

Alarms38

Potrebbero piacerti anche